Order no. 65155605 13 Part no. 2425842200 Edition C 2014
B-Class Electric Drive Operator's Manual
É2425842200tËÍ
2425842200
B-Class Electric Drive
Operator's Manual
Symbols
Registered trademarks:
RBluetooth®
is a registered trademark of
Bluetooth SIG Inc.
RDTS is a registered trademark of DTS, Inc.
RDolby and MLP are registered trademarks
of DOLBY Laboratories.
RBabySmart™, ESP® and PRE-SAFE® are
registered trademarks of Daimler AG.
RHomeLink® is a registered trademark of
Johnson Controls.
RiPod® and iTunes® are registered trademarks of Apple Inc.
RMicrosoft® and Windows media® are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation.
RSIRIUS is a registered trademark of Sirius
XM Radio Inc.
RHD Radio is a registered trademark of iBiquity Digital Corporation.
RGracenote® is a registered trademark of
Gracenote, Inc.
RZAGATSurvey® and related brands are registered trademarks of ZagatSurvey, LLC.
In this Operator's Manual you will find the following symbols:
This symbol indicates an instruction
that must be followed.
Several of these symbols in succesX
sion indicate an instruction with several steps.
This symbol tells you where you can
(Y
page) find more information about a topic.
This symbol indicates a warning or an
YY
instruction that is continued on the
next page.
Dis‐ This font indicates a display in the
play multifunction display/COMAND display.
X
Parts of the software in the vehicle are protected by copyright © 2005
The FreeType Project
http://www.freetype.org. All rights
reserved.
Publication details
Internet
Further information about Mercedes-Benz
vehicles and about Daimler AG can be found
on the following websites:
http://www.mbusa.com (USA only)
http://www.mercedes-benz.ca (Canada
only)
http://www.mercedes-benz.ca
Editorial office
©Daimler
AG: Not to be reprinted, translated
or otherwise reproduced, in whole or in part,
without written permission from Daimler AG.
Vehicle manufacturer
Daimler AG
Mercedesstraße 137
70327 Stuttgart
Germany
G WARNING
Warning notes make you aware of dangers
which could pose a threat to your health or
life, or to the health and life of others.
H Environmental note
Environmental notes provide you with information on environmentally aware actions or
disposal.
! Notes on material damage alert you to
dangers that could lead to damage to your
vehicle.
i Practical tips or further information that
could be helpful to you.
As at 26.11.2013
Welcome to the world of Mercedes-Benz
We urge you to read this Operator's Manual
carefully and familiarize yourself with the
vehicle before driving. For your own safety
and a longer vehicle life, follow the instructions and warning notices in this manual.
Ignoring them could result in damage to the
vehicle or personal injury to you or others.
Vehicle damage caused by failure to follow
instructions is not covered by the MercedesBenz Limited Warranty.
The equipment or product designation of your
vehicle may vary depending on:
Rmodel
Rorder
Rcountry
specification
Ravailability
Mercedes-Benz therefore reserves the right
to introduce changes in the following areas:
Rdesign
Requipment
Rtechnical
features
The equipment in your vehicle may therefore
differ from that shown in the descriptions and
illustrations.
The following are integral components of the
vehicle:
ROperator's
Manual
Booklet
REquipment-dependent supplements
Keep these documents in the vehicle at all
times. If you sell the vehicle, always pass all
documents on to the new owner.
The technical documentation team at
Daimler AG wishes you safe and pleasant
motoring.
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
A Daimler Company
RMaintenance
2425842200 É2425842200tËÍ
Contents
Index ....................................................... 4
At a glance ........................................... 29
Introduction ......................................... 19
Safety ................................................... 39
Opening and closing ........................... 71
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors .... 85
Lights and windshield wipers ............ 97
Climate control ................................. 113
Driving and parking .......................... 125
On-board computer and displays .... 171
Stowage and features ...................... 227
Maintenance and care ...................... 251
Breakdown Assistance ..................... 263
Wheels and tires ............................... 277
Technical data ................................... 307
3
4
Index
1, 2, 3 ...
12 V socket
see Sockets
A
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Display message ............................ 191
Function/notes ................................ 63
Important safety notes .................... 63
Warning lamp ................................. 218
Accident
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 56
Activating/deactivating cooling
with air dehumidification ................. 116
Active Parking Assist
Canceling ....................................... 163
Detecting parking spaces .............. 160
Display message ............................ 210
Exiting a parking space .................. 162
Function/notes ............................. 159
Important safety notes .................. 159
Parking .......................................... 161
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ................................. 68
Adaptive Brake Assist
Display message ............................ 200
Function/notes ................................ 65
Additional speedometer ................... 187
Air bags
Deployment ..................................... 54
Display message ............................ 203
Front air bag (driver, front
passenger) ....................................... 47
Important safety notes .................... 46
Introduction ..................................... 46
Knee bag .......................................... 48
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator
lamps ............................................... 41
Side impact air bag .......................... 48
Window curtain air bag .................... 48
Air-conditioning system
see Climate control
Air vents
Important safety notes .................. 123
Setting ........................................... 123
Setting the center air vents ........... 123
Setting the side air vents ............... 123
see Climate control
Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Ambient lighting
Setting the brightness (on-board
computer) ...................................... 188
Antenna ................................................ 23
Anti-lock braking system
see ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
Anti-Theft Alarm system
see ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Ashtray ............................................... 236
Assistance display (on-board computer) .................................................. 183
Assistance menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 183
ASSYST PLUS
Displaying a service message ........ 255
Hiding a service message .............. 255
Notes ............................................. 254
Resetting the service interval display ................................................ 255
Service message ............................ 254
Special service requirements ......... 255
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system)
Activating/deactivating ................... 69
Function ........................................... 69
Switching off the alarm .................... 69
ATTENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating ................. 184
Display message ............................ 208
Function/notes ............................. 166
Audio menu (on-board computer) .... 180
Audio system
see separate operating instructions
Authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
see Qualified specialist workshop
Authorized workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
AUTO lights
Display message ............................ 207
see Lights
Automatic car wash (care) ............... 256
Automatic headlamp mode ................ 98
Index
B
Backup lamp
Changing bulbs .............................. 106
Display message ............................ 206
Bag hook ............................................ 232
BAS (Brake Assist System) ................. 63
Battery
Display message ............................ 215
Battery (SmartKey)
Checking .......................................... 74
Important safety notes .................... 74
Replacing ......................................... 74
Battery (vehicle)
Charging ........................................ 268
Display message ............................ 207
Important safety notes .................. 265
Jump starting ................................. 269
Belt
see Seat belts
Blind Spot Assist
Activating/deactivating ................. 184
Display message ............................ 209
Notes/function .............................. 167
Brake Assist
see BAS (Brake Assist System)
Brake fluid
Display message ............................ 199
Notes ............................................. 309
Brake lamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 106
Display message ............................ 205
Brakes
ABS .................................................. 63
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 65
BAS .................................................. 63
Brake fluid (notes) ......................... 309
Display message ............................ 191
HOLD function ............................... 154
Important safety notes .................. 148
Maintenance .................................. 150
Parking brake ................................ 145
Riding tips ...................................... 148
Warning lamp ................................. 218
Brake system
Driving safety systems ..................... 68
Breakdown
Towing away .................................. 271
see Flat tire
Brightness control (instrument
cluster lighting) ................................... 31
Bulbs
see Replacing bulbs
C
Calling up a malfunction
see Display messages
Car
see Vehicle
Care
Carpets ..........................................
Car wash ........................................
Display ...........................................
Exterior lights ................................
Gear or selector lever ....................
Interior ...........................................
Matte finish ...................................
Notes .............................................
Paint ..............................................
Plastic trim ....................................
Power washer ................................
Rear view camera ..........................
Roof lining ......................................
Seat belt ........................................
Seat cover .....................................
Sensors .........................................
Steering wheel ...............................
Trim pieces ....................................
Washing by hand ...........................
Wheels ...........................................
Windows ........................................
Wiper blades ..................................
Wooden trim ..................................
Cargo compartment cover ...............
Cargo compartment enlargement ...
Important safety notes ..................
Cargo compartment floor
Height adjustment .........................
Important safety notes ..................
Opening/closing ............................
Stowage well (under) .....................
Cargo tie down rings .........................
262
256
260
259
261
260
258
256
257
260
257
260
262
262
261
259
261
261
256
258
258
259
261
232
230
230
234
233
233
233
231
5
6
Index
Center console
Lower section .................................. 35
Upper section .................................. 34
Central locking
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 188
Locking/unlocking (SmartKey) ........ 72
Changing bulbs
Brake lamps ................................... 106
High-beam headlamps ................... 105
Low-beam headlamps .................... 104
Parking lamps ................................ 105
Rear fog lamp ................................ 106
Reversing lamps ............................ 106
Standing lamps (front) ................... 105
Tail lamps ...................................... 106
Turn signals (front) ......................... 105
Turn signals (rear) .......................... 106
Charge level display .......................... 174
Charging
see Charging the high-voltage battery
Charging cable
Connecting .................................... 139
Controls ......................................... 138
Important safety notes .................. 137
Removing ....................................... 140
Storing ........................................... 138
Warming up ................................... 137
Charging the high-voltage battery
(important safety notes) ................... 134
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes .................... 61
Rear doors ....................................... 62
Children
In the vehicle ................................... 56
Restraint systems ............................ 57
Special seat belt retractor ............... 57
Child seat
Forward-facing restraint system ...... 60
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat
anchors ............................................ 58
On the front-passenger seat ............ 60
Rearward-facing restraint system .... 60
Top Tether ....................................... 59
Cigarette lighter ................................ 236
Climate control
Automatic climate control (dualzone) .............................................. 115
Auxiliary climate control (onboard computer) ............................ 186
Controlling automatically ............... 117
Convenience opening/closing
(air-recirculation mode) ................. 120
Cooling with air dehumidification .. 116
Defrosting the windows ................. 119
Defrosting the windshield .............. 118
Immediate pre-entry climate control ................................................. 122
Important safety notes .................. 114
Indicator lamp ................................ 117
Maximum cooling .......................... 119
Notes on using dual-zone automatic climate control ..................... 115
Overview of systems ...................... 114
Pre-entry climate control at
departure time ............................... 122
Pre-entry climate control at time
of departure (on-board computer) .. 186
Pre-entry climate control via key ... 121
Pre-entry climate control via key
(on-board computer) ...................... 186
Problems with cooling with air
dehumidification ............................ 117
Problem with the rear window
defroster ........................................ 120
Refrigerant ..................................... 311
Refrigerant filling capacity ............. 311
Setting the air distribution ............. 117
Setting the airflow ......................... 118
Setting the air vents ...................... 123
Setting the temperature ................ 117
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ............................................ 120
Switching on/off ........................... 116
Switching the rear window
defroster on/off ............................ 119
Switching the ZONE function on/
off .................................................. 118
Cockpit ................................................. 30
see Instrument cluster
Index
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
Activating/deactivating the distance warning function .................. 184
Display message ............................ 191
Operation/notes .............................. 64
Combination switch .......................... 100
Compass
Calibrating ..................................... 249
Calling up ....................................... 248
Setting ........................................... 249
Consumption statistics (on-board
computer) .......................................... 177
Convenience closing feature .............. 82
Convenience opening/closing (airrecirculation mode) ........................... 120
Convenience opening feature ............ 82
Coolant
Service product ............................. 309
Coolant (engine)
Checking the level ......................... 253
Cooling
see Climate control
Copyright ............................................. 27
Cornering light function
Display message ............................ 204
Crash-responsive emergency lighting ....................................................... 102
Cruise control
Activation conditions ..................... 153
Cruise control lever ....................... 152
Deactivating ................................... 154
Display message ............................ 210
Driving system ............................... 152
Important safety notes .................. 152
Setting a speed .............................. 153
Storing and maintaining current
speed ............................................. 153
Cup holder
Center console .............................. 235
Important safety notes .................. 234
see Cup holder
Customer Assistance Center
(CAC) ..................................................... 25
Customer Relations Department ....... 25
D
Dashboard
see Cockpit
Data
see Technical data
Daytime running lamps
Display message ............................ 206
Switching on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 187
Switching on/off (switch) ................ 98
Declarations of conformity ................. 24
Delayed switch-off
Interior lighting .............................. 188
Departure time
Setting (on-board computer) .......... 185
Diagnostics connection ...................... 24
Digital speedometer ......................... 177
DIRECT SELECT lever
Transmission ................................. 129
Display
High-voltage battery charge level
(instrument cluster) ....................... 174
Display (cleaning instructions) ........ 260
Display messages
ASSYST PLUS ................................ 254
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 190
Drive system .................................. 207
Driving systems ............................. 208
General notes ................................ 190
Hiding (on-board computer) ........... 190
Lights ............................................. 204
Safety systems .............................. 191
SmartKey ....................................... 215
Tires ............................................... 211
Vehicle ........................................... 212
Distance recorder ............................. 176
see Odometer
see Trip odometer
Distance warning function
Activating/deactivating ................. 184
Function/notes ................................ 64
Warning lamp ................................. 225
Door control panel .............................. 37
7
8
Index
Doors
Automatic locking (on-board computer) ............................................. 188
Automatic locking (switch) ............... 78
Central locking/unlocking
(SmartKey) ....................................... 72
Display message ............................ 214
Emergency locking ........................... 79
Emergency unlocking ....................... 79
Important safety notes .................... 77
Opening (from inside) ...................... 77
Drinking and driving ......................... 147
Driver's door
see Doors
Drive system
Jump-starting ................................. 269
Starting with the SmartKey ............ 127
Switching off .................................. 145
Driving abroad
Mercedes-Benz Service ................. 256
Driving on flooded roads .................. 151
Driving safety systems
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) ....... 63
ADAPTIVE BRAKE ............................. 68
Adaptive Brake Assist ...................... 65
BAS (Brake Assist System) .............. 63
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST .... 64
Distance warning function ............... 64
Electronic brake force distribution .................................................. 66
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program) ............................................... 66
ETS (Electronic Traction System) ..... 66
Important safety information ........... 63
Overview .......................................... 62
RBS .................................................. 68
STEER CONTROL ............................. 68
Driving systems
Active Parking Assist ..................... 159
ATTENTION ASSIST ........................ 166
Blind Spot Assist ............................ 167
Cruise control ................................ 152
Display message ............................ 208
HOLD function ............................... 154
PARKTRONIC ................................. 155
Rear view camera .......................... 163
Driving tips
Brakes ...........................................
Break-in period ..............................
Checking brake lining thickness ....
Downhill gradient ...........................
Drinking and driving .......................
Driving in winter .............................
Driving on flooded roads ................
Driving on wet roads ......................
Energy ...........................................
General ..........................................
Hydroplaning .................................
Icy road surfaces ...........................
Limited braking efficiency on salted roads .......................................
Snow chains ..................................
Wet road surface ...........................
DVD audio (on-board computer) ......
DVD video (on-board computer) ......
148
126
150
149
147
152
151
151
147
147
151
152
149
280
149
181
181
E
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
Display message ............................ 195
Function/notes ................................ 66
E‑CELL display ................................... 173
ECO display
Function/notes ............................. 148
On-board computer ....................... 177
Electric motor number ...................... 308
Electronic Stability Program
see ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Emergency
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 56
Emergency release
Driver's door .................................... 79
Vehicle ............................................. 79
Emergency Tensioning Devices
Activation ......................................... 54
Emergency unlocking
Tailgate ............................................ 80
Energy
Driving tips .................................... 147
Environmental protection
Note ................................................. 19
Index
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
Characteristics ................................. 67
Deactivating/activating ................. 183
Deactivating/activating (notes) ....... 67
Display message ............................ 191
ETS .................................................. 66
Function/notes ................................ 66
General notes .................................. 66
Important safety information ........... 67
Warning lamp ................................. 221
ETS (Electronic Traction System) ....... 66
Exterior lighting
Setting options ................................ 98
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting ......................................... 93
Dipping (automatic) ......................... 93
Out of position (troubleshooting) ..... 93
Storing settings (memory function) ................................................. 95
Storing the parking position ............. 94
F
Flat tire
MOExtended tires ..........................
Preparing the vehicle .....................
Floormats ...........................................
Fuses
Allocation chart .............................
Before changing .............................
Fuse box in the engine compartment ..............................................
Fuse box in the front-passenger
footwell ..........................................
Important safety notes ..................
264
264
249
275
274
275
275
274
G
Garage door opener
Clearing the memory ..................... 248
Important safety notes .................. 245
Opening/closing the garage door .. 248
Programming (button in the rearview mirror) ................................... 245
Gear or selector lever (cleaning
guidelines) ......................................... 261
Genuine parts ...................................... 19
Glove box ........................................... 229
H
Handbrake
see Parking brake
Hazard warning lamps ...................... 100
Display message ............................ 215
Headlamps
Cleaning system (notes) ................ 310
Fogging up ..................................... 101
see Automatic headlamp mode
Head restraints
Adjusting ......................................... 89
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 90
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 89
Adjusting (rear) ................................ 90
Installing/removing (rear) ................ 90
Heating
see Climate control
High-beam headlamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 105
Display message ............................ 205
Switching on/off ........................... 100
High voltage
see Safety notes
High-voltage battery
Battery care ................................... 136
Charging (charging station) ............ 140
Charging (mains socket) ................ 137
Charging cable warming ................ 137
Cruise range .................................. 136
Discharged battery ........................ 135
Display message ............................ 208
Energy consumption ...................... 136
General notes ................................ 135
Method of operation ...................... 135
Outside temperatures .................... 135
Overvoltage protection .................. 137
Problems with the charging process ................................................. 142
Reserve, warning lamp ................... 224
Terms of use .................................. 137
High-voltage disconnect device ......... 23
Hill start assist .................................. 128
HOLD function
Activating ....................................... 155
Deactivating ................................... 155
9
10
Index
Display message ............................ 209
Function/notes ............................. 154
Hood
Closing ........................................... 253
Display message ............................ 214
Important safety notes .................. 252
Opening ......................................... 252
Horn ...................................................... 30
Hydroplaning ..................................... 151
I
Ignition lock
see Key positions
Immobilizer .......................................... 69
Indicator lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
Indicators
see Turn signals
Instrument cluster
Charge level display ......................... 31
Overview .......................................... 31
Power display ................................ 173
Settings ......................................... 187
Warning and indicator lamps ........... 32
Instrument cluster lighting .............. 172
Interior lighting ................................. 101
Automatic control .......................... 102
Delayed switch-off (on-board
computer) ...................................... 188
Emergency lighting ........................ 102
Manual control ............................... 102
Overview ........................................ 101
Reading lamp ................................. 101
Setting the brightness of the
ambient lighting (on-board computer) ............................................. 188
Internet connection
Via mobile service module ............. 144
J
Jack
Storage location ............................ 264
Using ............................................. 300
K
Kickdown
Driving tips .................................... 131
Knee bag .............................................. 48
L
Lamps
see Warning and indicator lamps
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat
anchors ................................................ 58
License plate lamp (display message) ................................................... 205
Lights
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off ....... 188
Automatic headlamp mode .............. 98
Display message ............................ 204
Hazard warning lamps ................... 100
High beam flasher .......................... 100
High-beam headlamps ................... 100
Light switch ..................................... 98
Low-beam headlamps ...................... 99
Parking lamps .................................. 99
Rear fog lamp .................................. 99
Setting the brightness of the
ambient lighting (on-board computer) ............................................. 188
Standing lamps .............................. 100
Switching the daytime running
lamps on/off (on-board computer) ............................................. 187
Switching the daytime running
lamps on/off (switch) ...................... 98
Turn signals ................................... 100
see Interior lighting
see Lights
see Replacing bulbs
Light sensor (display message) ....... 207
Loading guidelines ............................ 228
Locking
see Central locking
Locking (doors)
Automatic ........................................ 78
Emergency locking ........................... 79
From inside (central locking button) .................................................. 78
Index
Locking centrally
see Central locking
Locking verification signal (onboard computer) ............................... 188
Low-beam headlamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 104
Display message ............................ 204
Switching on/off .............................. 99
Lumbar support
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support .................................................. 91
M
M+S tires ............................................ 280
Maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Malfunction message
see Display messages
Matte finish (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 258
Maximum charge current
Setting (charging cable) ................. 138
mbrace
Call priority .................................... 241
Display message ............................ 199
Downloading destinations
(COMAND) ..................................... 241
Downloading routes ....................... 244
Emergency call .............................. 238
General notes ................................ 237
Geo fencing ................................... 245
Locating a stolen vehicle ............... 243
MB info call button ........................ 240
Remote fault diagnosis .................. 243
Remote vehicle locking .................. 243
Roadside Assistance button .......... 240
Search & Send ............................... 242
Self-test ......................................... 238
Speed alert .................................... 244
System .......................................... 238
Triggering the vehicle alarm ........... 245
Vehicle remote unlocking .............. 243
Mechanical key
Function/notes ................................ 73
Locking vehicle ................................ 79
Unlocking the driver's door .............. 79
Memory card (audio) ......................... 181
Memory function ................................. 95
Message memory (on-board computer) .................................................. 190
Messages
see Display messages
Mirrors
see Exterior mirrors
see Rear-view mirror
see Vanity mirror (in the sun visor)
Mobile phone
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 181
Modifying the programming
(SmartKey) ........................................... 73
MOExtended tires .............................. 264
Mounting wheels
Lowering the vehicle ...................... 303
Mounting a new wheel ................... 302
Preparing the vehicle ..................... 300
Raising the vehicle ......................... 300
Removing a wheel .......................... 302
Securing the vehicle against rolling away ........................................ 300
MP3
Operation ....................................... 181
see separate operating instructions
Multifunction display
Function/notes ............................. 176
Permanent display ......................... 187
Multifunction steering wheel
Operating the on-board computer .. 174
Overview .......................................... 33
N
Navigation
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 179
see separate operating instructions
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle ....................................................... 126
O
Occupant Classification System
(OCS)
Conditions ....................................... 49
Faults ............................................... 53
11
12
Index
Operation ......................................... 49
System self-test ............................... 51
Occupant safety
Automatic measures after an accident ................................................. 56
Children in the vehicle ..................... 56
Important safety notes .................... 41
Pets in the vehicle ........................... 62
OCS
Conditions ....................................... 49
Faults ............................................... 53
Operation ......................................... 49
System self-test ............................... 51
On-board computer
Assistance menu ........................... 183
Audio menu ................................... 180
Displaying a service message ........ 255
Display messages .......................... 190
E‑CELL menu ................................. 185
Factory settings submenu ............. 189
Important safety notes .................. 172
Instrument cluster submenu .......... 187
Lighting submenu .......................... 187
Menu overview .............................. 176
Message memory .......................... 190
Navigation menu ............................ 179
Operation ....................................... 174
Service menu ................................. 184
Settings menu ............................... 185
Standard display ............................ 176
Telephone menu ............................ 181
Trip menu ...................................... 176
Vehicle submenu ........................... 188
Video DVD operation ..................... 181
On-board computer (multifunction
steering wheel)
Range ............................................ 178
Online access .................................... 143
Opening and closing the side trim
panels ................................................. 105
Operating safety
Declaration of conformity ................ 24
Operating system
see On-board computer
Operator's Manual
Vehicle equipment ........................... 20
Outside temperature display ........... 173
Overhead control panel ...................... 36
Override feature
Rear side windows ........................... 62
P
Paint code number ............................ 308
Paintwork (cleaning instructions) ... 257
Panic alarm .......................................... 40
Parking ............................................... 144
Important safety notes .................. 144
Parking brake ................................ 145
Position of exterior mirror, frontpassenger side ................................. 94
Rear view camera .......................... 163
see Active Parking Assist
see PARKTRONIC
Parking aid
Active Parking Assist ..................... 159
see Exterior mirrors
see PARKTRONIC
Parking assistance
see PARKTRONIC
Parking brake
Display message ............................ 196
Electric parking brake .................... 145
Warning lamp ................................. 223
see Parking brake
Parking lamps
Switching on/off .............................. 99
Parking lamps (changing bulbs) ...... 105
PARKTRONIC
Deactivating/activating ................. 157
Driving system ............................... 155
Function/notes ............................. 155
Important safety notes .................. 155
Problem (malfunction) ................... 159
Range of the sensors ..................... 156
Warning display ............................. 157
PASSENGER AIR BAG
Indicator lamps ................................ 41
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
Problems (malfunction) .................. 203
Pets in the vehicle ............................... 62
Plastic trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 260
Power display .................................... 173
Index
Power washers .................................. 257
Power windows
see Side windows
Program selector button .................. 131
Pulling away ...................................... 128
Q
Qualified specialist workshop ........... 24
R
Radar sensor system
Activating/deactivating ................. 188
Display message ............................ 209
Radio
Selecting a station ......................... 180
see separate operating instructions
Radio-wave reception/transmission in the vehicle
Declaration of conformity ................ 24
Range
Calling up (on-board computer,
luxury multifunction steering
wheel) ............................................ 178
RANGE PLUS ................................. 136
RANGE PLUS
Range ............................................ 136
RBS
see Recuperative braking system
(RBS) ................................................ 68
Reading lamp ..................................... 101
READY indicator ................................ 172
Rear fog lamp
Changing bulbs .............................. 106
Display message ............................ 206
Switching on/off .............................. 99
Rear lamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 106
see Lights
Rear seat
Folding the backrest forwards/
back (vehicles without the EASYVARIO-PLUS system) ..................... 231
Rear view camera
Cleaning instructions ..................... 260
Function/notes ............................. 163
Switching on/off ........................... 164
Rear-view mirror
Anti-glare (manual) .......................... 93
Dipping (automatic) ......................... 93
Rear window defroster
Problem (malfunction) ................... 120
Switching on/off ........................... 119
Rear window wiper
Replacing the wiper blade .............. 110
Switching on/off ........................... 109
Recuperative braking system (rbs) ... 68
Refrigerant (air-conditioning system)
Important safety notes .................. 311
Remote control
Garage door opener ....................... 245
Programming (garage door
opener) .......................................... 245
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes .................. 102
Overview of bulb types .................. 103
Removing/replacing the cover
(front wheel arch) .......................... 104
Reporting safety defects .................... 25
Reserve
High-voltage battery ...................... 224
Restraint system
Display message ............................ 200
Introduction ..................................... 40
Warning lamp ................................. 224
Warning lamp (function) ................... 41
Reverse gear
Engaging ........................................ 130
Reversing feature
Side windows ................................... 81
Roadside Assistance (breakdown) .... 21
Roof lining and carpets (cleaning
guidelines) ......................................... 262
Roof load (maximum) ........................ 311
Route (navigation)
see Route guidance (navigation)
Route guidance (navigation) ............ 179
13
14
Index
S
Safety
Children in the vehicle ..................... 56
Child restraint systems .................... 57
Occupant Classification System
(OCS) ............................................... 49
Safety notes ......................................... 21
Safety system
see Driving safety systems
Seat belts
Adjusting the height ......................... 44
center rear-compartment seat ......... 45
Cleaning ......................................... 262
Correct usage .................................. 43
Fastening ......................................... 44
Important safety guidelines ............. 42
Introduction ..................................... 42
Releasing ......................................... 45
Warning lamp ................................. 216
Warning lamp (function) ................... 45
Seats
Adjusting (electrically) ..................... 89
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 88
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support .................................................. 91
Adjusting the head restraint ............ 89
Cleaning the cover ......................... 261
Correct driver's seat position ........... 86
Folding the backrest (rear compartment) forwards/back (vehicles without the EASY-VARIOPLUS system) ................................ 231
Important safety notes .................... 87
Seat heating problem ...................... 92
Storing settings (memory function) ................................................. 95
Switching seat heating on/off ......... 91
Selector lever
see DIRECT SELECT lever
Sensors (cleaning instructions) ....... 259
Service Center
see Qualified specialist workshop
Service menu (on-board computer) .................................................. 184
Service products
Brake fluid ..................................... 309
Important safety notes .................. 309
Refrigerant (air-conditioning system) ............................................... 311
Washer fluid ................................... 310
Settings
Factory (on-board computer) ......... 189
On-board computer ....................... 185
Setting the air distribution ............... 117
Setting the airflow ............................ 118
Setting the maximum charge current (Control system) ........................ 186
Side impact air bag ............................. 48
Side marker lamp (display message) ................................................... 206
Side windows
Cleaning ......................................... 258
Convenience closing feature ............ 82
Convenience opening feature .......... 82
Important safety information ........... 81
Opening/closing .............................. 81
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 84
Resetting ......................................... 83
SmartKey
Changing the battery ....................... 74
Changing the programming ............. 73
Checking the battery ....................... 74
Convenience closing feature ............ 82
Convenience opening feature .......... 82
Display message ............................ 215
Door central locking/unlocking ....... 72
Important safety notes .................... 72
Loss ................................................. 76
Mechanical key ................................ 73
Positions (ignition lock) ................. 127
Problem (malfunction) ..................... 76
SmartKey positions (ignition lock) .. 127
Snow chains ...................................... 280
Sockets
General notes ................................ 237
Luggage compartment ................... 237
Rear compartment ......................... 237
Specialist workshop ............................ 24
Special seat belt retractor .................. 57
Speed, controlling
see Cruise control
Speedometer
Activating/deactivating the additional speedometer ........................ 187
Index
Digital ............................................ 177
In the Instrument cluster ................. 31
Selecting the unit of measurement .............................................. 187
see Instrument cluster
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
see Restraint system
Standing lamps
Changing bulbs .............................. 105
Display message ............................ 206
Switching on/off ........................... 100
Starting (vehicle) ............................... 127
STEER CONTROL .................................. 68
Steering (display message) .............. 214
Steering wheel
Adjusting (manually) ........................ 92
Buttons (on-board computer) ......... 174
Cleaning ......................................... 261
Important safety notes .................... 92
Paddle shifters ............................... 131
Steering wheel paddle shifters ........ 131
Stowage areas ................................... 228
Stowage compartments
Armrest (front) ............................... 229
Armrest (under) ............................. 229
Center console (rear) ..................... 230
Cup holders ................................... 234
Glove box ....................................... 229
Important safety information ......... 228
Stowage net ................................... 230
Under driver's seat/frontpassenger seat .............................. 230
Stowage net ....................................... 230
Summer tires ..................................... 280
Sun visor ............................................ 235
Switching air-recirculation mode
on/off ................................................. 120
Switching off the alarm (ATA) ............ 69
T
Tailgate
Display message ............................ 213
Emergency unlocking ....................... 80
Important safety notes .................... 79
Opening/closing (from outside) ....... 80
Opening dimensions ...................... 311
Tail lamps
Display message ............................ 205
see Lights
Technical data
Capacities ...................................... 309
Information .................................... 308
Tires/wheels ................................. 303
Vehicle data ................................... 311
Telephone
Accepting a call ............................. 182
Display message ............................ 214
Menu (on-board computer) ............ 181
Number from the phone book ........ 182
Redialing ........................................ 183
Rejecting/ending a call ................. 182
Temperature
Outside temperature ...................... 173
Setting (climate control) ................ 117
Theft deterrent systems
ATA (Anti-Theft Alarm system) ......... 69
Immobilizer ...................................... 69
Time
see separate operating instructions
Tire pressure
Calling up (on-board computer) ..... 284
Checking manually ........................ 284
Display message ............................ 211
Important safety notes .................. 284
Maximum ....................................... 284
Notes ............................................. 283
Recommended ............................... 281
see Tire pressure
Tire pressure monitor
Checking the tire pressure electronically ........................................ 286
Function/notes ............................. 284
General notes ................................ 284
Important safety notes .................. 285
Restarting ...................................... 287
Warning lamp ................................. 226
Warning message .......................... 286
Tires
Aspect ratio (definition) ................. 298
Average weight of the vehicle
occupants (definition) .................... 296
15
16
Index
Bar (definition) ...............................
Changing a wheel ..........................
Characteristics ..............................
Checking ........................................
Curb weight (definition) .................
Definition of terms .........................
Direction of rotation ......................
Display message ............................
Distribution of the vehicle occupants (definition) ............................
DOT, Tire Identification Number
(TIN) ...............................................
DOT (Department of Transportation) (definition) .............................
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
(definition) .....................................
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) (definition) ...........................................
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) (definition) ..............................
Important safety notes ..................
Increased vehicle weight due to
optional equipment (definition) ......
Kilopascal (kPa) (definition) ...........
Labeling (overview) ........................
Load bearing index (definition) ......
Load index .....................................
Load index (definition) ...................
M+S tires .......................................
Maximum loaded vehicle weight
(definition) .....................................
Maximum load on a tire (definition) ...............................................
Maximum permissible tire pressure (definition) .............................
Maximum tire load .........................
Maximum tire load (definition) .......
Optional equipment weight (definition) ............................................
PSI (pounds per square inch) (definition) ...........................................
Replacing .......................................
Service life .....................................
Sidewall (definition) .......................
Speed rating (definition) ................
Storing ...........................................
Structure and characteristics
(definition) .....................................
296
299
296
279
298
296
299
211
299
295
296
297
297
297
278
297
297
293
299
295
297
280
297
298
298
291
298
298
298
299
280
298
297
300
296
Summer tires ................................. 280
Temperature .................................. 292
TIN (Tire Identification Number)
(definition) ..................................... 298
Tire bead (definition) ...................... 298
Tire pressure (definition) ................ 298
Tire pressures (recommended) ...... 297
Tire size (data) ............................... 303
Tire size designation, load-bearing
capacity, speed rating .................... 293
Tire tread ....................................... 279
Tire tread (definition) ..................... 298
Total load limit (definition) ............. 299
Traction ......................................... 292
Traction (definition) ....................... 299
Tread wear ..................................... 292
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards ...................................... 291
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards (definition) .................... 297
Wear indicator (definition) ............. 299
Wheel rim (definition) .................... 297
see Flat tire
Top Tether ............................................ 59
Towing away
Important safety guidelines ........... 271
Installing the towing eye ................ 272
Removing the towing eye ............... 273
With both axles on the ground ....... 273
With the rear axle raised ................ 273
Tow-starting
Installing the towing eye ................ 272
Removing the towing eye ............... 273
Trailer hitch ......................................... 23
Trailer tow hitch .................................. 23
Transmission
DIRECT SELECT lever ..................... 129
Display message ............................ 212
Drive program ................................ 134
Driving tips .................................... 131
Engaging the drive position ............ 130
Engaging the park position ............ 129
Holding the vehicle stationary on
uphill gradients .............................. 131
Kickdown ....................................... 131
Overview ........................................ 128
Index
Program selector button ................
Shifting to neutral ..........................
Transmission position display .........
Transmission position display
(DIRECT SELECT lever) ......................
Transmission positions ....................
Trim pieces (cleaning instructions) ..................................................
Trip computer (on-board computer) ..................................................
Trip odometer
Calling up .......................................
Resetting (on-board computer) ......
see Trip odometer
Trunk
see Tailgate
Turn signals
Changing bulbs (front) ...................
Changing bulbs (rear) ....................
Display message ............................
Switching on/off ...........................
Type identification plate
see Vehicle identification plate
131
130
129
129
130
261
177
176
177
105
106
204
100
U
Unlocking
Emergency unlocking ....................... 79
From inside the vehicle (central
unlocking button) ............................. 78
V
Vanity mirror (in the sun visor) ........ 236
Vehicle
Correct use ...................................... 25
Data acquisition ............................... 26
Equipment ....................................... 20
Individual settings .......................... 185
Limited Warranty ............................. 25
Loading .......................................... 288
Locking (in an emergency) ............... 79
Locking (SmartKey) .......................... 72
Lowering ........................................ 303
Maintenance .................................... 21
Parking for a long period ................ 147
Raising ........................................... 300
Reporting problems ......................... 25
Securing from rolling away ............ 300
Starting .......................................... 127
Towing (front axle raised) .............. 273
Towing away .................................. 271
Tow-starting ................................... 271
Transporting .................................. 274
Unlocking (in an emergency) ........... 79
Unlocking (SmartKey) ...................... 72
Vehicle data ................................... 311
Vehicle data ....................................... 311
Vehicle dimensions ........................... 311
Vehicle emergency locking ................ 79
Vehicle Homepage
Data protection .............................. 143
Functions ....................................... 144
General information ....................... 143
Internet connection ....................... 144
Vehicle identification number
see VIN
Vehicle identification plate .............. 308
Vehicle maintenance
see ASSYST PLUS
Vehicle tool kit .................................. 264
Video (DVD) ........................................ 181
VIN ...................................................... 308
W
Warning and indicator lamps
ABS ................................................ 218
Brakes ........................................... 218
Distance warning ........................... 225
ESP® .............................................. 221
ESP® OFF ....................................... 222
Overview .......................................... 32
PASSENGER AIR BAG ...................... 41
RBS (Recuperative Brake System) ............................................... 218
Restraint system ............................ 224
Seat belt ........................................ 216
Tire pressure monitor .................... 226
Warranty .............................................. 20
Washer fluid
Display message ............................ 214
Wheel bolt tightening torque ........... 303
Wheel chock ...................................... 300
17
18
Index
Wheels
Changing a wheel .......................... 299
Checking ........................................ 279
Cleaning ......................................... 258
Important safety notes .................. 278
Interchanging/changing ................ 299
Mounting a new wheel ................... 302
Mounting a wheel .......................... 300
Removing a wheel .......................... 302
Storing ........................................... 300
Tightening torque ........................... 303
Wheel size/tire size ....................... 303
Window curtain air bag
Display message ............................ 201
Operation ......................................... 48
Windows
see Side windows
Windshield
Defrosting ...................................... 118
see Windshield
Windshield washer system
Adding washer fluid ....................... 254
Notes ............................................. 310
Windshield wipers
Display message ............................ 214
Problem (malfunction) ................... 111
Rear window wiper ........................ 109
Replacing the wiper blades ............ 109
Switching on/off ........................... 108
Winter driving
Slippery road surfaces ................... 152
Snow chains .................................. 280
Winter operation
General notes ................................ 280
Winter tires
M+S tires ....................................... 280
Wiper blades
Cleaning ......................................... 259
Important safety notes .................. 109
Replacing (rear window) ................ 110
Replacing (windshield) ................... 109
Wooden trim (cleaning instructions) .................................................. 261
Workshop
see Qualified specialist workshop
Z
ZONE function
Switching on/off ........................... 118
Introduction
Protection of the environment
Note
H Environmental note
Daimler's declared policy is one of comprehensive environmental protection.
The objectives are for the natural resources
that form the basis of our existence on this
planet to be used sparingly and in a manner
that takes the requirements of both nature
and humanity into account.
You too can help to protect the environment
by operating your vehicle in an environmentally responsible manner.
Energy consumption and the rate of engine,
transmission, brake and tire wear depend on
the following factors:
Roperating
conditions of your vehicle
personal driving style
You can influence both factors. You should
bear the following in mind:
Operating conditions:
Ryour
Ralways
make sure that the tire pressures
are correct.
Rdo not carry any unnecessary weight.
Rkeep an eye on the vehicle's energy consumption.
Rremove roof racks once you no longer need
them.
Ra regularly serviced vehicle will contribute
to environmental protection. You should
therefore adhere to the service intervals.
Ralways have service work carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Personal driving style:
Rdrive carefully and maintain a safe distance
from the vehicle in front.
frequent, sudden acceleration and
braking.
Ravoid
H Environmental note
Have a defective high-voltage battery disposed of in an environmentally-responsible
manner. Contact a qualified specialist workshop which has the necessary specialist
knowledge and tools to carry out the work
required. Mercedes-Benz recommends that
you use an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
for this purpose.
Environmental concerns and recommendations
When prompted to dispose of materials by
this Operator's Manual, always try to re-use
or recycle them first. Observe the relevant
environmental rules and regulations when
disposing of materials. In this way you will
help to protect the environment.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
H Environmental note
Daimler AG also supplies reconditioned major
assemblies and parts which are of the same
quality as new parts. They are covered by the
same Limited Warranty entitlements as new
parts.
! Air bags and Emergency Tensioning Devi-
ces, as well as control units and sensors for
these restraint systems, may be installed in
the following areas of your vehicle:
Rdoors
Rdoor
pillars
sills
Rseats
Rcockpit
Rinstrument cluster
Rcenter console
Do not install accessories such as audio
systems in these areas. Do not carry out
repairs or welding. You could impair the
operating efficiency of the restraint systems.
Have aftermarket accessories installed at a
qualified specialist workshop.
Rdoor
Z
19
20
Introduction
You could jeopardize the operating safety of
your vehicle if you use parts, tires and wheels
as well as accessories relevant to safety
which have not been approved by Mercedes.
This could lead to malfunctions in safety-relevant systems, e.g. the brake system. Use
only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts or parts of
equal quality. Only use tires, wheels and
accessories that have been specifically
approved for your vehicle.
Genuine Mercedes-Benz parts are subject to
strict quality control. Every part has been specifically developed, manufactured or selected
for and adapted to Mercedes-Benz vehicles.
Only genuine Mercedes-Benz parts should
therefore be used.
More than 300,000 different genuine
Mercedes-Benz parts are available for
Mercedes-Benz models.
All authorized Mercedes-Benz Centers maintain a supply of genuine Mercedes-Benz parts
for necessary service and repair work. In addition, strategically located parts delivery centers provide quick and reliable parts service.
Always specify the vehicle identification number (VIN) when ordering genuine MercedesBenz parts (Y page 308).
Operator's Manual
Vehicle equipment
This Operator's Manual describes all models
and all standard and optional equipment of
your vehicle available at the time of going to
print. Country-specific differences are possible. Bear in mind that your vehicle may not
feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and functions. The equipment in your vehicle may
therefore differ from that shown in the
descriptions and illustrations.
The original purchase agreement lists all systems installed in your vehicle.
Should you have any questions concerning
equipment and operation, please consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
The Operator's Manual and Maintenance
Booklet are important documents and should
be kept in the vehicle.
Service and vehicle operation
Warranty
The Limited Warranty for your vehicle applies
in accordance with the warranty terms and
conditions in the Service and Warranty Information Booklet.
Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center will
exchange or repair any defective parts originally installed in the vehicle in accordance
with the terms of the following warranties:
RNew
Vehicle Limited Warranty
warranty enforcement laws (Lemon
Laws)
Replacement parts and accessories are covered by the Mercedes-Benz Parts and Accessories warranties. These are available at any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
RState
i Should you lose your Service and War-
ranty Information booklet, have an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center arrange for a
replacement. The new Service and Warranty Information booklet will be mailed to
you.
Service and literature
The Limited Warranty for your vehicle applies
in accordance with the warranty terms and
conditions in the Service and Warranty Booklet. Your authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
will exchange or repair any defective parts
originally installed in the vehicle in accordance with the terms of the following warranties:
RNew
Vehicle Limited Warranty
Connecticut, Maine, Massachusetts, New York, Pennsylvania, Rhode
RCalifornia,
Introduction
Island and Vermont Emission Control Systems Warranty
RState warranty enforcement laws (lemon
laws)
Maintenance
The Service and Warranty Booklet describes
all the necessary maintenance work which
should be done at regular intervals.
Always have the Service and Warranty Booklet with you when you bring the vehicle to an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The service advisor will record every service for you
in the Service and Warranty Booklet.
Roadside Assistance
The Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance
Program offers technical help in the event of a
breakdown. Calls to the toll-free Roadside
Assistance Hotline are answered by our
agents 24 hours a day, 365 days a year.
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372)
(USA)
1-800-387-0100 (Canada)
For additional information, refer to the
Mercedes-Benz Roadside Assistance Program brochure (USA) or the "Roadside Assistance" section in the Service and Warranty
Booklet (Canada). You will find both in the
vehicle document wallet.
Change of address or change of ownership
In the event of a change of address, please
send us the "Notification of Address Change"
in the Service and Warranty Booklet or simply
call the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance
Center (USA) at the hotline number
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or
Customer Service Center (Canada) at
1-800-387-0100. This will assist us in con-
tacting you in a timely manner should the
need arise.
If you sell your Mercedes, please leave all literature in the vehicle so that it is available to
the next owner.
If you have purchased a used car, please send
us the "Notification of Used Car Purchase" in
the Service and Warranty Booklet or simply
call the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance
Center (USA) at the hotline number
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372) or
Customer Service (Canada) at
1-800-387-0100.
Vehicle operation outside Canada
When you are abroad with your vehicle,
observe the following points:
Rservice
facilities or replacement parts may
not be readily available.
Some Mercedes-Benz models are available
for delivery in Europe through our European
Delivery Program. For details, consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or write to
one of the following addresses.
In the USA
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
European Delivery Department
One Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
In Canada
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
European Delivery Department
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
Operating safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not have the prescribed service/
maintenance work or any required repairs
Z
21
22
Introduction
carried out, this can result in malfunctions or
system failures. There is a risk of an accident.
Always have the prescribed service/maintenance work as well as any required repairs
carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
Modifications to electronic components, their
software as well as wiring can impair their
function and/or the function of other networked components. In particular, systems
relevant to safety could also be affected. As a
result, these may no longer function as intended and/or jeopardize the operating safety of
the vehicle. There is an increased risk of an
accident and injury.
Never tamper with the wiring as well as electronic components or their software. You
should have all work to electrical and electronic equipment carried out at a qualified
specialist workshop.
If you make changes to electronic components, their software or wiring, the general
operating permit for your vehicle may be rendered invalid.
! There is a risk of damage to the vehicle if:
Rthe vehicle becomes stuck, e.g. on a high
curb or an unpaved road
Ryou drive too fast over an obstacle, e.g. a
curb or a hole in the road
heavy object strikes the undercarriage
or parts of the chassis
In situations like this, the body, the undercarriage, chassis parts, wheels or tires
Ra
could be damaged without the damage
being visible. Components damaged in this
way can unexpectedly fail or, in the case of
an accident, no longer withstand the strain
they are designed to.
In such situations, have the vehicle
checked and repaired immediately at a
qualified specialist workshop. If on continuing your journey you notice that driving
safety is impaired, pull over and stop the
vehicle immediately, paying attention to
road and traffic conditions. In such cases,
visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Danger of electric shock
All of the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system components are marked with yellow
warning stickers which warn you about high
voltages. The cables of the vehicle's highvoltage electrical system are orange.
G DANGER
The vehicle's high voltage electrical system is
under high voltage. If you modify components
in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
or touch damaged components, you may be
electrocuted. The components in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system may be
damaged in an accident, although the damage
is not visible. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Following an accident, do not touch any highvoltage components and never modify the
vehicle's high-voltage electrical system. Have
the vehicle towed away after an accident and
the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
checked by a qualified specialist workshop.
Introduction
When towing a vehicle after an accident, be
sure to observe the following sections:
The charging process is interrupted automatically if:
RTransporting
Ra
the vehicle (Y page 274)
RTowing the vehicle with the front axle raised
(Y page 273)
a vehicle with both axles on the
ground (Y page 273)
Read the safety instructions on towing and
tow-starting (Y page 271).
The ignition must be switched off when carrying out general tasks, such as changing
bulbs or checking the coolant level.
RTowing
serious electrical insulation malfunction
is detected in the vehicle's high-voltage
electrical system.
Ran electrical connection in the vehicle's
high-voltage electrical system is disconnected.
High-voltage switch-off device
Automatic switching off of the vehicle's
high-voltage electrical system
If the restraint systems are activated during
an accident, the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system is automatically deactivated.
This is to ensure that you do not come into
contact with high voltage.
Automatic protection from switching
on of the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
Your vehicle is equipped with a high-voltage
switch-off device : which can be used to
switch off the vehicle's high-voltage electrical
system.
The vehicle's high-voltage electrical system is
not activated when the vehicle is started if:
! The high-voltage system must only be
Ra
serious electrical insulation malfunction
is detected in the vehicle's high-voltage
electrical system.
Ran electrical connection in the vehicle's
high-voltage electrical system is disconnected.
Automatic switching off of the charging
process
The charging process is deactivated automatically if:
Rthe
high-voltage battery is fully charged.
switched off at vehicle standstill by specially trained service engineers. Otherwise
the high-voltage system may be damaged.
Mobile phone antenna
! It is not permitted to retrofit a mobile
phone antenna.
Trailer tow hitch
! Retrofitting a trailer tow hitch is not permissible.
Warning
Vehicles with an electric motor generate
much less driving noise than vehicles with
internal combustion engines. As a result,
when maneuvering or driving at low speeds
for example, your vehicle is not heard by other
Z
23
24
Introduction
road users until it is very close, or may not
even be heard at all. This is particularly the
case if other road users have not yet seen
your vehicle but are instead relying on hearing. Drive with particular care, allowing for the
possibility that other road users may behave
unpredictably.
The vehicle is equipped with a sound generator. At low speeds, an electric vehicle makes
less noise than a vehicle with a combustion
engine. The sound generator is activated so
that other road users can hear your vehicle
better. The sound generator is activated at
speeds of under 20 mph (30 km/h) and
switches off automatically at higher speeds.
Declarations of conformity
Vehicle components which receive
and/or transmit radio waves
USA: "The wireless devices of this vehicle
comply with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the two following two conditions: 1) These devices may not cause
harmful interference, and 2) These devices
must accept any interference received,
including interference that may cause undesired operation. Changes or modifications not
expressly approved by the party responsible
for compliance could void the user’s authority
to operate the equipment."
Canada: "The wireless devices of this vehicle
comply with Industry Canada license-exempt
RSS standard(s). Operation is subject to the
following two conditions: (1) These devices
may not cause interference, and (2) These
devices must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired
operation of the device."
Diagnostics connection
G WARNING
If you connect equipment to the diagnostics
connection in the vehicle, it may affect the
operation of the vehicle systems. As a result,
the operating safety of the vehicle could be
affected. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not connect any equipment to a diagnostics connection in the vehicle.
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell can restrict the
pedal travel or obstruct a depressed pedal.
The operating and road safety of the vehicle is
jeopardized. There is a risk of an accident.
Make sure that all objects in the vehicle are
stowed correctly, and that they cannot enter
the driver's footwell. Install the floormats
securely and as specified in order to ensure
sufficient clearance for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place floormats on
top of one another.
! If equipment on the diagnostics connection is used, the starter battery may discharge.
The diagnostics connection is only intended
for the connection of diagnostic equipment at
a qualified specialist workshop.
Routine checks and maintenance service
Bear in mind that you are legally obliged to
carry out daily checks and regular inspections
at your own responsibility. You can find further information about the individual inspection steps in the Maintenance Booklet.
Qualified specialist workshop
An authorized Mercedes-Benz Center is a
qualified specialist workshop. It has the necessary specialist knowledge, tools and qualifications to correctly carry out the work
required on your vehicle. This is especially the
case for work relevant to safety.
Observe the notes in the Maintenance Booklet.
Introduction
Always have the following work carried out at
an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center:
relevant to safety
and maintenance work
Rrepair work
Ralterations, installation work and modifications
Rwork on electronic components
Rwork on the drive system
98 Vanderhoof Avenue
Toronto, Ontario M4G 4C9
Rwork
Rservice
Correct use
If you remove any warning stickers, you or
others could fail to recognize certain dangers.
Leave warning stickers in position.
Observe the following information when driving your vehicle:
Rthe
safety notes in this manual
Technical Data section in this manual
Rtraffic rules and regulations
Rlaws and safety standards pertaining to
motor vehicles
Rthe
Problems with your vehicle
If you should experience a problem with your
vehicle, particularly one that you believe may
affect its safe operation, we urge you to contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center
immediately to have the problem diagnosed
and rectified. If the problem is not resolved to
your satisfaction, please discuss the problem
again with the Mercedes-Benz Center or, if
necessary, contact us at one of the following
addresses.
In the USA
Customer Assistance Center
Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
One Mercedes Drive
Montvale, NJ 07645-0350
In Canada
Customer Relations Department
Mercedes-Benz Canada, Inc.
Reporting safety defects
USA only:
The following text is reproduced as required
of all manufacturers under Title 49, Code of
U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575 pursuant
to the National Traffic and Motor Vehicle
Safety Act of 1966.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect
which could cause a crash or could cause
injury or death, you should immediately
inform the National Highway Traffic Safety
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may
open an investigation, and if it finds that a
safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it
may order a recall and remedy campaign.
However, NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you, your
dealer, or Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle
Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236
(TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://
www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington, DC 20590.
You can also obtain other information about
motor vehicle safety from
http://www.safercar.gov
Limited Warranty
! Follow the instructions in this manual
about the proper operation of your vehicle
as well as about possible vehicle damage.
Damage to your vehicle that arises from
culpable contraventions against these
instructions is not covered either by the
Mercedes-Benz Limited Warranty or by the
New or Used-Vehicle Warranty.
Z
25
26
Introduction
Data stored in the vehicle
Data recording
This vehicle is capable of recording diagnostic
information relating to vehicle operation, malfunctions, and user settings. This may include
information about the performance or status
of various systems, including but not limited
to, engine, throttle, steering or brake systems, that is stored and can be read out with
suitable devices, particularly when the vehicle is serviced. The data obtained is used to
properly diagnose and service your vehicle or
to further optimize and develop vehicle functions.
COMAND/mbrace
If the vehicle is equipped with COMAND or
mbrace, additional data about the vehicle’s
operation, the use of the vehicle in certain
situations, and the location of the vehicle may
be compiled through COMAND or the mbrace
system.
For additional information please refer to the
COMAND User Manual and/or the mbrace
Terms and Conditions.
Event data recorders
This vehicle is equipped with an event data
recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR
is to record data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s systems performed
in certain crash or near crash-like situations,
such as during air bag deployment or when
hitting a road obstacle. The EDR is designed
to record data related to vehicle dynamics
and safety systems for a short period of time,
typically 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record
such data as:
Rhow
various systems in your vehicle are
operating
Rwhether or not the driver and passenger
seat belts are fastened
Rhow far (if at all) the driver is depressing the
accelerator and/or brake pedal and
fast the vehicle is traveling
This data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which
crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data is
recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial
crash situation occurs; no data is recorded by
the EDR under normal driving conditions and
no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age,
and crash location) are recorded. However,
other parties, such as law enforcement, can
combine the EDR data with the type of personal identification data routinely acquired
during a crash investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special
equipment is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the
vehicle manufacturer, other parties that have
the special equipment, such as law enforcement, can read the information by accessing
the vehicle or the EDR.
EDR data may be used in civil and criminal
matters as a tool in accident reconstruction,
accident claims, and vehicle safety. Since the
Crash Data Retrieval CDR tool that is used to
extract data from the EDR is commercially
available, Mercedes-Benz USA, LLC
("MBUSA") expressly disclaims any and all liability arising from the extraction of this information by unauthorized Mercedes-Benz personnel.
MBUSA will not share EDR data with others
without the consent of the vehicle owners or,
if the vehicle is leased, without the consent of
the lessee. Exceptions to this representation
include responses to subpoenas by law
enforcement; by federal, state or local government; in connection with or arising out of
litigation involving MBUSA or its subsidiaries
and affiliates; or, as required by law.
Warning: The EDR is a component of the Supplemental Restraint System ("SRS") Module.
Tampering with, altering, modifying or removing the EDR component may result in a malfunction of the SRS Module and other systems.
Rhow
Introduction
State laws or regulations regarding EDRs that
conflict with federal regulation are pre-empted. This means that in the event of such conflict, the federal regulation governs. As of
February 2013, 13 states have enacted laws
relating to EDRs.
Information on copyright
General information
Information on license for free and opensource software used in your vehicle and its
electronic components is available on the following website:
http://www.mercedes-benz.com/
opensource
Z
27
28
29
Cockpit ................................................. 30
Multifunction steering wheel ............. 33
Center console .................................... 34
Overhead control panel ...................... 36
Door control panel .............................. 37
At a glance
Instrument cluster .............................. 31
30
Cockpit
At a glance
Cockpit
Function
Page
:
Steering wheel paddle
shifters
131
;
Combination switch
100
=
Instrument cluster
31
?
Horn
A
DIRECT SELECT lever
129
B
PARKTRONIC warning display
C
Overhead control panel
Function
Page
D
Climate control systems
114
E
Ignition lock
127
F
Adjusts the steering wheel
G
Cruise control lever
152
H
Electric parking brake
145
I
Light switch
98
155
J
Diagnostics connection
24
36
K
Opens the hood
92
252
Instrument cluster
31
Instrument cluster
Function
At a glance
Displays and controls
Page
:
Speedometer
;
Multifunction display
176
=
Power display
173
?
E-CELL display
173
Function
A
B
Page
Display for the condition of
charge of the high-voltage
battery
174
Instrument cluster lighting
172
32
Instrument cluster
At a glance
Warning and indicator lamps
Function
Page
:
L Low-beam headlamps
99
;
T Parking lamps
99
=
K High-beam headlamps
100
?
÷ ESP®
221
A
! Electric parking brake
(red)
223
! Electric parking brake
(yellow)
223
C
· Distance warning
D
E
B
Function
Page
F
ü Seat belt
216
G
é RBS (Recuperative
Brake System)
218
H
R Rear fog lamp
99
I
; Drive system
207
J
h Tire pressure monitor
226
High-voltage battery reserve
208
L
å ESP® OFF
221
225
M
! ABS
218
#! Turn signals
100
N
$ Brakes
218
6 Restraint system
224
K
Multifunction steering wheel
33
At a glance
Multifunction steering wheel
Function
:
Multifunction display
;
Audio/COMAND display
(see the separate operating
instructions)
=
?
Switches on the Voice Control System (see the separate operating instructions)
?
~
Rejects or ends a call
Exits phone book/redial
memory
6
Makes or accepts a call
Switches to the redial memory
WX
Adjusts the volume
8
Mute
Page
176
Function
A
B
181
=;
Selects a menu
9:
Selects a submenu or
scrolls through lists
a
Confirms your selection
Hides display messages
%
Back
Switches off the Voice Control System (see the separate operating instructions)
Page
174
174
174
190
174
34
Center console
At a glance
Center console
Center console, upper section
Function
Page
:
Audio system/COMAND; see the separate operating
instructions
;
c Seat heating
91
=
c PARKTRONIC
155
?
RANGE PLUS
136
A
£ Hazard warning lamps
100
B
4 PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
C
Û Drive program
134
D
& Immediate pre-entry climate control
122
49
Center console
35
At a glance
Center console, lower section
Function
Page
:
Ashtray
Cigarette lighter
Socket
Stowage compartment
236
236
237
228
;
Stowage compartment
228
=
Cup holder
234
?
Stowage compartment
228
A
Audio/COMAND controller; see the separate operating
instructions
36
Overhead control panel
At a glance
Overhead control panel
Function
:
Page
u Switches the rear
compartment interior lighting on/off
102
;
p Switches the righthand reading lamp on/off
101
=
| Switches the front
interior lighting/automatic
interior lighting control off
102
?
ï MB Info call button
(mbrace system)
240
A
Rear-view mirror
93
Function
Page
B
Buttons for the garage door
opener
248
C
G SOS button (mbrace
system)
238
D
F Roadside Assistance
call button (mbrace system)
240
E
c Switches the front
interior lighting on
102
F
p Switches the lefthand reading lamp on/off
101
Door control panel
37
At a glance
Door control panel
Function
Page
Function
Page
:
Opens the door
77
A
;
% & Unlocks/locks
the vehicle
7Z\ Adjusts the
exterior mirrors electrically
93
78
B
=
r45= Saves
the seat and exterior mirror
settings
W Opens and closes the
side windows
81
95
C
Adjusts the seats electrically
89
n Activates/deactivates the override feature
for the rear power side windows
62
?
38
39
Useful information .............................. 40
Panic alarm .......................................... 40
Occupant safety .................................. 40
Pets in the vehicle .............................. 62
Driving safety systems ....................... 62
Theft deterrent locking system ......... 69
Safety
Children in the vehicle ........................ 56
Occupant safety
40
Useful information
i This Operator's Manual describes all
Safety
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Panic alarm
To activate: press ! button : for at
least one second.
An alarm sounds and the exterior lighting
flashes.
X To deactivate: press ! button :
again.
or
X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
X
Occupant safety
Restraint system: introduction
The restraint system reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts
of the vehicle's interior in the event of an
accident. The restraint system can also
reduce the forces to which vehicle occupants
are subjected during an accident.
The restraint system comprises:
RSeat
belt system
bags
RChild restraint system
RChild seat securing systems
The components of the restraint system work
in conjunction with each other. They can only
deploy their protective function if, at all times,
all vehicle occupants:
RAir
Rhave
fastened their seat belts correctly
(Y page 43)
Rhave adjusted their seat and head restraint
properly (Y page 87).
As the driver, you also have to make sure that
the steering wheel is adjusted correctly.
Observe the information relating to the correct driver's seat position (Y page 86).
You also have to make sure that an air bag can
inflate properly if deployed (Y page 46).
An air bag supplements a correctly worn seat
belt. As an additional safety device, the air
bag increases the level of protection for vehicle occupants in the event of an accident. For
example, if, in the event of an accident, the
protection offered by the seat belt is sufficient, the air bags are not deployed. When an
accident occurs, only the air bags that
increase protection in that particular accident
situation are deployed. However, seat belts
and air bags generally do not protect against
objects penetrating the vehicle from the outside.
Information on restraint system operation
can be found under "Triggering of the Emergency Tensioning Device and air bags"
(Y page 54).
For more information about children traveling
with you in the vehicle and on child restraint
systems, see "Children in the vehicle"
(Y page 56).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Modifications to the restraint system may
cause it to no longer work as intended. The
restraint system may then not perform its
intended protective function and may fail in an
accident or trigger unexpectedly, for example.
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Never modify parts of the restraint system.
Never tamper with the wiring, the electronic
components or their software.
If it is necessary to modify an air bag system to
accommodate a person with disabilities, contact an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for
details. USA only: for further information contact our Customer Assistance Center at
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1‑800‑367‑6372).
gered at all in the event of an accident with a
high rate of vehicle deceleration. This could
affect Emergency Tensioning Devices or air
bags, for example. The vehicle's high-voltage
electrical system may also not be deactivated
as intended in the event of an accident. You
could suffer an electric shock if you touch the
damaged components of the vehicle's highvoltage electrical system. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Have the restraint system checked and
repaired immediately at a qualified specialist
workshop. Immediately switch off the ignition
and remove the SmartKey from the ignition
lock after an accident.
PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamp
Restraint system warning lamp
The functions of the restraint system are
checked after the ignition is switched on and
at regular intervals while the drive system is
running. Therefore, malfunctions can be
detected in good time.
The 6 restraint system warning lamp in
the instrument cluster lights up when the ignition is switched on. It goes out no later than a
few seconds after the drive system is started.
The components of the restraint system are in
operational readiness.
A malfunction has occurred if the 6
restraint system warning lamp:
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp :
and PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp ; are part of the Occupant Classification System (OCS).
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front air bag.
Rdoes
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF : lights up: the
not light up after the ignition is
switched on
Rdoes not go out after a few seconds with
the drive system running
Rlights up again while the drive system is
running
G DANGER
If the restraint system is malfunctioning, individual restraint system components may be
triggered unintentionally or might not be trig-
front-passenger front air bag is deactivated. It will then not be deployed in the event
of an accident.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG ON ; lights up: the
front-passenger front air bag is enabled. If,
in the event of an accident, all deployment
criteria are met, the front-passenger front
air bag is deployed.
Z
41
Safety
Occupant safety
42
Occupant safety
Safety
Depending on the person in the frontpassenger seat, the front-passenger front air
bag must either be disabled or enabled; see
the following points. You must make sure of
this both before and during a journey.
RChildren
in a child restraint system:
whether the front-passenger front air bag is
enabled or deactivated depends on the
installed child restraint system, and the age
and size of the child. Therefore, be sure to
observe the notes on the "Occupant Classification System (OCS)" (Y page 49) and
on "Children in the vehicle" (Y page 56).
There you will also find instructions on rearward and forward-facing child restraint systems on the front-passenger seat.
RAll other persons: depending on the classification of the person in the frontpassenger seat, the front-passenger front
air bag is enabled or deactivated
(Y page 49). Be sure to observe the notes
on "Seat belts“ (Y page 42) and "Air bags"
(Y page 46). There you can also find information on the correct seat position.
Seat belts
Introduction
Seat belts are the most effective means of
restricting the movement of vehicle occupants in the event of an accident or the vehicle rolling over. This reduces the risk of vehicle occupants coming into contact with parts
of the vehicle interior or being ejected from
the vehicle. Furthermore, the seat belt helps
to keep the vehicle occupant in the best position in relation to the air bag.
The seat belt system comprises:
RSeat
belts
REmergency
Tensioning Devices for the
front seat belts and the outer seat belts in
the rear
RSeat belt force limiters for the front seat
belts and the outer seat belts in the rear
If the seat belt is pulled out of the belt outlet
quickly or with a jerky movement, the belt
retractor locks. The belt strap cannot be
extracted any further.
The Emergency Tensioning Device tightens
the seat belt in an accident, pulling the belt
close against the body. However it does not
pull the vehicle occupant back in the direction
of the backrest.
The Emergency Tensioning Device does not
correct an incorrect seat position or the routing of an incorrectly fastened seat belt.
When triggered, seat belt force limiters help
to reduce the force exerted by the seat belt on
the vehicle occupant.
The seat belt force limiters for the front seats
are synchronized with the front air bags,
which absorb part of the deceleration force.
This can reduce the force exerted on the vehicle occupants during an accident.
! If the front-passenger seat is unoccupied,
do not insert the belt tongue into the buckle
of the front-passenger seat. This may otherwise lead to the triggering of the Emergency Tensioning Device in the event of an
accident, which will then need to be
replaced.
Important safety notes
The use of seat belts and child restraint systems is required by law in:
Rall
50 states
U.S. territories
Rthe District of Columbia
Rall Canadian provinces
Even where this is not required by law, all
vehicle occupants should correctly fasten
their seat belts before starting the journey.
Rthe
G WARNING
If the seat belt is incorrectly fastened, it cannot protect as intended. Furthermore, an
incorrectly fastened seat belt can cause additional injury, for example, in an accident, during braking or when abruptly changing direc-
tion. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants are
seated properly with a correctly fastened seat
belt.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seat belt is routed
across the center of your shoulder.
G WARNING
Persons under 5 ft (1.50 m) in height cannot
fasten the seat belt correctly without an additional suitable restraint system. If the seat
belt is incorrectly fastened, it cannot protect
as intended. Furthermore, an incorrectly fastened seat belt can cause additional injury, for
example, in an accident, during braking or an
abrupt change of direction. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
For this reason, always secure persons under
5 ft (1.50 m) in height in suitable restraint
systems.
If a child younger than 12 years and under 5 ft
(1.50 m) in height is traveling in the vehicle:
Ralways
secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for this Mercedes-Benz
vehicle. The child restraint system must be
appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child
Ralways observe the instructions and safety
notes in the "Children in the vehicle" section of this Operator's Manual
(Y page 56) in addition to the child
restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and
safety notes on the "Occupant classification system (OCS)" (Y page 49)
G WARNING
The seat belts may not perform their intended
protective function if:
Rthey
are damaged, modified, extremely
dirty, bleach or dyed
Rthe seat belt buckle is damaged or
extremely dirty
Rthe Emergency Tensioning Devices, belt
anchorages or inertia reels have been modified
Seat belts may sustain non-visible damage in
an accident, e.g. due to glass splinters. Modified or damaged seat belts may tear or fail,
e.g. in an accident. Modified Emergency Tensioning Devices could accidentally trigger or
fail to deploy when necessary. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Never modify the seat belts, Emergency Tensioning Devices, belt anchorages or inertia
reels. Make sure that the seat belts are
undamaged, not worn out and clean. Following an accident, have the seat belts checked
immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Only use seat belts that have been approved
for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz. Any such
modifications could invalidate the vehicle's
general operating permit.
Proper use of the seat belts
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 42).
All vehicle occupants must be wearing the
seat belt correctly before beginning the journey. Also make sure that all vehicle occupants are always wearing the seat belt correctly while the vehicle is in motion.
Z
43
Safety
Occupant safety
44
Occupant safety
When fastening the seat belt, always make
sure that:
Safety
Rthe
seat belt tongue is only inserted to the
belt buckle belonging to that seat.
Rthe seat belt is tight across your body.
Avoid wearing bulky clothing, e.g. a winter
coat.
Rthe seat belt is not twisted.
Only then can the forces which occur be
distributed over the area of the belt.
Rthe shoulder section of the belt is always
routed across the center of your shoulder.
The shoulder section of the belt must not
come into contact with your neck or be
routed under your arm. Where possible,
adjust the seat belt to the appropriate
height.
Rthe lap belt passes tightly and as low down
as possible across your lap.
The lap belt must always be routed across
your hip joints and not across your abdomen. This applies particularly to pregnant
women. If necessary, push the lap belt
down to your hip joint and pull it tight using
the shoulder section of the belt.
Rthe seat belt is not routed across sharp,
pointed or fragile objects.
If you have such items located on or in your
clothing, e.g. pens, keys or eyeglasses,
store these in a suitable place.
Ronly one person is using a seat belt at a
time.
Infants and children must never travel sitting on the lap of a vehicle occupant. In the
event of an accident, they could be crushed
between the vehicle occupant and seat
belt.
Robjects are never secured with a seat belt if
the seat belt is also being used by one of the
vehicle's occupants.
Seat belts are only intended to secure and
restrain vehicle occupants. Always observe
the "Loading guidelines" for securing objects,
luggage or loads (Y page 228).
Fastening and adjusting the seat belts
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 42) and the notes on correct use of
seat belts (Y page 43).
If the center rear seat belt is being used, also
observe the information about the seat belt
for the center rear seat (Y page 45).
Adjust the seat (Y page 86).
The seat backrest must be in an almost
vertical position.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from belt outlet
=.
X Engage seat belt tongue ; in belt
buckle :.
X If necessary, pull upwards on the shoulder
section of the seat belt to tighten the belt
across your body.
X
Occupant safety
45
The shoulder section of the seat belt must
always be routed across the center of the
shoulder. Adjust the belt outlet if necessary.
To raise: slide the belt outlet upwards.
The belt outlet will engage in various positions.
X To lower: hold belt outlet release : and
slide the belt outlet downwards.
X Let go of belt outlet release : in the
desired position and make sure that the
belt outlet engages.
All seat belts except the driver's seat belt are
equipped with a special seat belt retractor to
securely fasten child restraint systems in the
vehicle. Further information can be found
under "Special seat belt retractor"
(Y page 57).
Seat belt for the center rear seat
If the left-hand rear seat backrest is folded
down and back up again, the rear center seat
belt may lock. The seat belt can then not be
pulled out.
X To release the rear center seat belt: pull
the seat belt out approximately 1 in
(25 mm) at the belt outlet on the backrest
and then release it again.
The seat belt is retracted and released.
Releasing seat belts
! Make sure that the seat belt is fully rolled
up. Otherwise, the seat belt or belt tongue
will be trapped in the door or in the seat
mechanism. This could damage the door,
the door trim panel and the seat belt. Damaged seat belts can no longer fulfill their
protective function and must be replaced.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Safety
X
X
Press release button :, hold belt
tongue ; firmly and guide it back towards
belt outlet =.
Belt warning for the driver and front
passenger
The 7 seat belt warning lamp in the instrument cluster is a reminder that all occupants
must fasten their seat belts. It may light up
continuously or flash. In addition, there may
be a warning tone.
Regardless of whether the driver's seat belt
has already been fastened, the 7 seat belt
warning lamp lights up for six seconds each
time the drive system is started. If the front
doors are closed and the driver or frontpassenger seat belt has not been fastened,
the 7 seat belt warning lamp lights up
again after the six seconds. As soon as the
driver's and front-passenger seat belts are
fastened or a front door is opened again, the
7 seat belt warning lamp goes out.
If the driver's seat belt is not fastened after
the drive system is started, an additional
warning tone will sound. The warning tone
switches off after six seconds or once the
driver's seat belt is fastened.
If the vehicle's speed exceeds 15 mph
(25 km/h) once and the driver's and frontpassenger seat belts are not fastened, a
Z
Safety
46
Occupant safety
warning tone sounds. The warning tone
sounds with increasing intensity for
60 seconds or until the driver or front
passenger have fastened their seat belts.
If the driver or front passenger unfasten their
seat belts during the journey, the seat belt
warning is activated again.
i For more information on the 7 seat
belt warning lamp, see "Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster, seat
belts" (Y page 216).
To avoid hazardous situations, always make
sure that all of the vehicle's occupants:
Rhave
fastened their seat belts correctly,
including pregnant women
Rare sitting correctly and maintain the greatest possible distance to the air bags
Rfollow the following instructions
Always make sure that there are no objects
between the air bag and the vehicle's occupants.
RAdjust
Air bags
Introduction
The installation point of an air bag can be recognized by the AIR BAG symbol.
An air bag complements the correctly fastened seat belt. It is no substitute for the seat
belt. The air bag provides additional protection in applicable accident situations.
Not all air bags are deployed in an accident.
The different air bag systems function independently from one another (Y page 54).
However, no system available today can completely eliminate injuries and fatalities.
It is also not possible to rule out a risk of injury
caused by an air bag due to the high speed at
which the air bag must be deployed.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you do not sit in the correct seat position,
the air bag cannot protect as intended and
could even cause additional injury when
deployed. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
the seats properly before beginning
your journey. Always make sure that the
seat is in an almost upright position. The
center of the head restraint must support
the head at about eye level.
RMove the driver's and front-passenger
seats as far back as possible. The driver's
seat position must allow the vehicle to be
driven safely.
ROnly hold the steering wheel on the outside. This allows the air bag to be fully
deployed.
RAlways lean against the backrest while driving. Do not lean forwards or lean against
the door or side window. You may otherwise be in the deployment area of the air
bags.
RAlways keep your feet in the footwell in
front of the seat. Do not put your feet on the
dashboard, for example. Your feet may otherwise be in the deployment area of the air
bag.
RFor this reason, always secure persons less
than 5 ft (1.50 m) tall in suitable restraint
systems. Up to this height, the seat belt
cannot be worn correctly.
If a child is traveling in your vehicle, also
observe the following notes:
RAlways
secure children under 12 years of
age and less than 5 ft (1.50 m) in height in
suitable child restraint systems.
RChild restraint systems should be installed
on the rear seats.
ROnly
secure a child in a rearward-facing
child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat when the front-passenger
front air bag is deactivated. If the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is
permanently lit, the front-passenger front
air bag is deactivated (Y page 41).
RAlways observe the instructions and safety
notes on the "Occupant Classification System (OCS)" (Y page 49) and on "Children
in the vehicle" (Y page 56) in addition to
the child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions.
Objects in the vehicle interior may prevent the air bag from functioning correctly. Before starting your journey and to
avoid risks resulting from the speed of the air
bag as it deploys, make sure that:
are no people, animals or objects
between the vehicle occupants and an air
bag.
Rthere are no objects between the seat, door
and B-pillar.
Rno hard objects, e.g. coat hangers, hang on
the grab handles or coat hooks.
Rno accessories, such as cup holders, are
attached to the vehicle within the deployment area of an air bag, e.g. to doors, side
windows, rear side trim or side walls.
Rno heavy, sharp-edged or fragile objects
are in the pockets of your clothing. Store
such objects in a suitable place.
function of the sensors being impaired. The air
bags might therefore not function properly
any more. Consequently, the air bags cannot
protect vehicle occupants as they are
designed to do. There is an increased risk of
injury.
Never modify the doors or parts of the doors.
Always have work on the doors or door paneling carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
Front air bags
Rthere
G WARNING
If you modify the air bag cover or affix objects
such as stickers to it, the air bag can no longer
function correctly. There is an increased risk
of injury.
Never modify an air bag cover or affix objects
to it.
G WARNING
Sensors to control the air bags are located in
the doors. Modifications or work not performed correctly to the doors or door paneling, as well as damaged doors, can lead to the
Driver's air bag : deploys in front of the
steering wheel; front-passenger front air
bag ; deploys in front of and above the glove
box.
When deployed, the front air bags offer additional head and thorax protection for the
occupants in the front seats.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps
inform you about the status of the frontpassenger front air bag (Y page 41).
Front-passenger front air bag ; will only
deploy if:
Rthe
system, based on the OCS weight sensor readings, detects that the frontpassenger seat is occupied (Y page 49).
The PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp is lit (Y page 49)
Rthe restraint system control unit predicts a
high accident severity
Z
47
Safety
Occupant safety
48
Occupant safety
Driver's knee bag
When deployed, the side impact air bag offers
additional thorax and pelvis protection. However, it does not protect the:
Rhead
Safety
Rneck
Driver's knee bag : deploys under the steering column. The driver's knee bag is triggered
together with the front air bag.
The driver's knee bag offers additional thigh,
knee and lower leg protection for the occupant in the driver's seat.
Side impact air bags
G WARNING
Unsuitable seat covers could restrict or even
prevent the deployment of the air bags integrated into the seats. Consequently, the air
bags cannot protect vehicle occupants as
they are designed to do. In addition, the function of the Occupant Classification System
(OCS) could be restricted. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
You should only use seat covers that have
been approved for the respective seat by
Mercedes-Benz.
Side impact air bags : deploy next to the
outer bolsters of the seat backrests.
Rarms
In the event of a side impact, the side impact
air bag is deployed on the side on which the
impact occurs.
The side impact air bag on the frontpassenger side (front) deploys in the following situations:
Rthe
OCS system detects that the frontpassenger seat is occupied or
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle of the front-passenger seat
If the belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle, the side impact air bag on the frontpassenger side deploys if an appropriate accident situation occurs. In this case, deployment is independent of whether the frontpassenger seat is occupied or not.
Window curtain air bags
Window curtain air bags : are integrated
into the side of the roof frame and deployed in
the area from the A-pillar to the C-pillar.
When deployed, the window curtain air bag
enhances the level of protection for the head.
However, it does not protect the chest or
arms.
In the event of a side impact, the window curtain air bag is deployed on the side on which
the impact occurs.
If the system determines that they can offer
additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt, a window curtain air bag may be
deployed in other accident situations
(Y page 54).
Occupant Classification System
(OCS)
Introduction
The Occupant Classification System (OCS)
categorizes the person in the front-passenger
seat. Depending on that result, the frontpassenger front air bag is either enabled or
deactivated.
The system does not deactivate:
backrest of the forwards-facing child restraint
system must, as far as possible, be resting on
the backrest of the front-passenger seat.
The child restraint system must not touch the
roof or be put under strain by the head
restraint. Adjust the angle of the seat backrest and the head restraint position accordingly.
Only then can OCS be guaranteed to function
correctly. Always observe the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions.
Occupant Classification System operation (OCS)
Rthe
side impact air bag
window curtain air bag
Rthe Emergency Tensioning Devices
Rthe
Prerequisites
To be classified correctly, the front passenger
must sit:
Rwith
the seat belt fastened correctly
an almost upright position with their
back against the seat backrest
Rwith their feet resting on the floor, if possible
If the front passenger does not observe these
conditions, OCS may produce a false classification, e.g. because the front passenger:
Rin
Rtransfers
their weight by supporting themselves on a vehicle armrest
Rsits in such a way that their weight is raised
from the seat cushion
If it is absolutely necessary to install a child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat,
be sure to observe the correct positioning of
the child restraint system. Never place
objects under or behind the child restraint
system, e.g. cushions. The entire base of the
child restraint system must always rest on the
seat cushion of the front-passenger seat. The
: PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
; PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp
The indicator lamps inform you whether the
front-passenger front air bag is deactivated or
enabled.
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock.
The system carries out self-diagnostics.
The PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps
must light up simultaneously for approximately six seconds.
The indicator lamps display the status of the
front-passenger front air bag.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG OFF : lights up: the
front-passenger front air bag is deactiva-
Z
49
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
50
Occupant safety
ted. It will then not be deployed in the event
of an accident.
RPASSENGER AIR BAG ON ; lights up: the
front-passenger front air bag is enabled. If,
in the event of an accident, all deployment
criteria are met, the front-passenger front
air bag is deployed.
If the status of the front-passenger front air
bag changes while the vehicle is in motion, an
air bag display message appears in the instrument cluster (Y page 203). When the frontpassenger seat is occupied, always pay attention to the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON and
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamps. Be
aware of the status of the front-passenger
front air bag both before and during the journey.
G WARNING
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit, the front-passenger front air bag is
disabled. It will not be deployed in the event of
an accident and cannot perform its intended
protective function. A person in the frontpassenger seat could then, for example, come
into contact with the vehicle's interior, especially if the person is sitting too close to the
dashboard. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and the frontpassenger front air bag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
back as far back as possible.
Rthe person is seated correctly.
Make sure, both before and during the journey, that the status of the front-passenger
front air bag is correct.
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a rearward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat
and the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp is lit up, the front-passenger front air bag
may deploy in an accident. The child could be
struck by the air bag. This poses an increased
risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Make sure that the front-passenger front air
bag has been disabled. The PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp must be lit.
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains off and/or the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp lights up, do not install
a rearward-facing child restraint system on
the front-passenger seat. You can find more
information on OCS under "Problems with the
Occupant Classification System"
(Y page 53).
G WARNING
If you secure a child in a forward-facing child
restraint system on the front-passenger seat
and you position the front-passenger seat too
close to the dashboard, in the event of an
accident, the child could:
Rcome
into contact with the vehicle's interior if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit, for example
Rbe struck by the air bag if the PASSENGER
AIR BAG ON is lit up
This poses an increased risk of injury or even
fatal injury.
Move the front-passenger seat as far back as
possible. Always make sure that the shoulder
belt strap is correctly routed from the vehicle
belt outlet to the shoulder belt guide on the
child restraint system. The shoulder belt strap
must be routed forwards and downwards
from the vehicle belt outlet. If necessary,
adjust the vehicle belt outlet and the frontpassenger seat accordingly. Always observe
the child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions.
If OCS determines that:
Rthe front-passenger seat is unoccupied, the
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp
lights up after the system self-test and
remains lit. This indicates that the frontpassenger front air bag is deactivated.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
child of up to 12 months old in a standard
child restraint system, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator lamp lights up after the
system self-test and remains lit. This indicates that the front-passenger front air bag
is deactivated.
But in the case of a 12-month-old child in a
standard child restraint system, the
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON can light up permanently after the system self-test. This
indicates that the front-passenger front air
bag is activated. The result of the classification is dependent on, among other factors, the child restraint system and the
child's stature. It is recommended that you
install the restraint system on a suitable
rear seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by a
person of smaller stature (e.g. a teenager
or small adult), either the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON or PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp lights up and remains lit after
the system self-test depending on the
result of the classification.
- If the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator
lamp lights up, move the front-passenger
seat as far back as possible. Alternatively, a person of smaller stature can sit
on a rear seat.
- If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp is lit, a person of smaller stature
should not use the front-passenger seat.
Rthe front-passenger seat is occupied by an
adult or a person of a stature corresponding to that of an adult, the PASSENGER AIR
BAG ON indicator lamp lights up after the
system self-test and remains lit. This indicates that the front-passenger front air bag
is activated.
If children are traveling in the vehicle, be sure
to observe the notes on "Children in the vehicle" (Y page 56).
When OCS is malfunctioning, the red 6
restraint system warning lamp in the instrument cluster and the PASSENGER AIR BAG
OFF indicator lamp light up simultaneously.
The front-passenger front air bag is deactivated in this case and does not deploy during an
accident. Have the system checked by qualified technicians as soon as possible. Consult
an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center. The
front-passenger seat should only be repaired
at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
If the front-passenger seat, the seat cover or
the seat cushion is damaged, have the necessary repair work carried out at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use seat accessories
that have been approved by Mercedes-Benz.
If the driver's air bag deploys, this does not
mean that the front-passenger front air bag
will also deploy. The Occupant Classification
System (OCS) categorizes the occupant in the
front-passenger seat. Depending on that
result, the front-passenger front air bag is
either enabled or deactivated.
System self-test
G DANGER
If both the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF and
PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamps do
not light up during the system self-test, the
system is malfunctioning. The frontpassenger front air bag might be triggered
unintentionally or might not be triggered at all
in the event of an accident with high deceleration. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
In this case the front-passenger seat may not
be used. Do not install a child restraint system
on the front-passenger seat. Have the Occupant Classification System (OCS) checked
and repaired immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
51
Safety
Occupant safety
Safety
52
Occupant safety
G DANGER
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit after the system self-test, the
front-passenger front air bag is disabled. It will
not be deployed in the event of an accident. In
this case, the front-passenger front air bag
cannot perform its intended protective function, e.g. when a person is seated in the frontpassenger seat.
That person could, for example, come into
contact with the vehicle's interior, especially
if the person is sitting too close to the dashboard. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
When the front-passenger seat is occupied,
always ensure that:
Rthe classification of the person in the front-
passenger seat is correct and the frontpassenger front air bag is enabled or disabled in accordance with the person in the
front-passenger seat
Rthe person is seated properly with a correctly fastened seatbelt
Rthe front-passenger seat has been moved
back as far back as possible
If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit when it should not, the frontpassenger seat may not be used. Do not
install a child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat. Have the Occupant Classification System (OCS) checked and repaired
immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
Objects between the seat surface and the
child restraint system could affect OCS operation. This could result in the front-passenger
air bag not functioning as intended during an
accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Do not place any objects between the seat
surface and the child restraint system. The
entire base of the child restraint system must
always rest on the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. The backrest of the forwards-
facing child restraint system must, as far as
possible, be resting on the backrest of the
front-passenger seat. Always comply with the
child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
After the system self-test, the PASSENGER
AIR BAG OFF or PASSENGER AIR BAG ON
indicator lamp display the status of the frontpassenger front air bag (Y page 49).
For more information about the OCS, see
"Problems with the Occupant Classification
System" (Y page 53).
Occupant safety
53
Problems with the Occupant Classification System (OCS)
Be sure to observe the notes on "System self-test" (Y page 51).
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The PASSENGER AIR
The classification of the person on the front-passenger seat is
BAG OFF indicator
incorrect.
lamp lights up and
X Make sure the conditions for a correct classification of the perremains lit, even
son on the front-passenger seat are met (Y page 49).
though the frontX If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains lit, the
passenger seat is occufront-passenger seat may not be used.
pied by an adult or a
X Have OCS checked as soon as possible at an authorized
person of a stature corMercedes-Benz Center.
responding to that of an
adult.
The PASSENGER AIR
BAG OFF indicator
lamp does not light up
and/or does not stay
on.
The front-passenger
seat is:
OCS is malfunctioning.
X Make sure there is nothing between the seat cushion and the
child seat.
X Make sure that the entire base of the child restraint system rests
on the seat cushion of the front-passenger seat. The backrest of
the forward-facing child restraint system must lie as flat as possible against the backrest of the front-passenger seat. If necessary, adjust the position of the front-passenger seat.
Runoccupied
X When installing the child restraint system, make sure that the
Roccupied by the
seat belt is tight. Do not pull the seat belt tight using the frontweight of a child up
passenger seat adjustment. This could result in the seat belt and
to 12 months old in a
the child restraint system being pulled too tightly.
child restraint system
X Check for correct installation of the child restraint system.
X Make sure that no objects are applying additional weight onto
the seat.
X If the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp remains off and/
or the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp lights up, do not
install a child restraint system on the front-passenger seat. It is
recommended that you install the restraint system on a suitable
rear seat.
X Have OCS checked as soon as possible at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Z
Safety
Problem
54
Occupant safety
Deployment of Emergency Tensioning
Devices and air bags
Safety
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The air bag parts are hot after an air bag has
been deployed. There is a risk of injury.
Do not touch the air bag parts. Have a
deployed air bag replaced at a qualified specialist workshop as soon as possible.
G WARNING
A deployed air bag no longer offers any protection and cannot provide the intended protection in an accident. There is an increased
risk of injury.
Have the vehicle towed to a qualified specialist workshop in order to have a deployed air
bag replaced.
It is important for your safety and that of your
passenger to have deployed air bags replaced
and to have any malfunctioning air bags
repaired. This will help to make sure the air
bags continue to perform their protective
function for the vehicle occupants in the
event of a crash.
G WARNING
Pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning Devices
that have been deployed are no longer operational and are unable to perform their intended protective function. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Therefore, have pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning Devices which have been triggered
immediately replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
If Emergency Tensioning Devices or air bags
are deployed, you will hear a bang, and a small
amount of powder may also be released. The
6 restraint system warning lamp lights up.
Only in rare cases will the bang affect your
hearing. The powder that is released generally does not constitute a health hazard, but it
may cause short-term breathing difficulties in
people with asthma or other respiratory problems. To avoid this, you may wish to get out of
the vehicle or open the windows as soon as it
is safe to do so.
Air bags and pyrotechnic Emergency Tensioning Devices (ETDs) contain perchlorate material, which may require special handling and
regard for the environment. National guidelines must be observed during disposal. In
California, see www.dtsc.ca.gov/
HazardousWaste/Perchlorate/
index.cfm.
Method of operation
During the first stage of a collision, the
restraint system control unit evaluates important physical data relating to vehicle deceleration or acceleration, such as:
Rduration
Rdirection
Rintensity
Based on the evaluation of this data, the
restraint system control unit deploys the
Emergency Tensioning Devices during a frontal or rear collision.
An Emergency Tensioning Device can only be
deployed, if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on
Rthe components of the restraint system are
operational; see "Restraint system warning
lamp" (Y page 41)
Rthe belt tongue is engaged in the buckle on
the respective front-passenger seat
The Emergency Tensioning Devices in the
rear compartment are deployed independently of the lock status of the seat belts.
If the restraint system control unit detects a
more severe accident, further components of
the restraint system are activated independently of each other in certain frontal collision
situations:
RFront
air bags and driver's knee bag
RWindow curtain air bag, if the system deter-
mines that deployment can offer additional
protection to that provided by the seat belt
The front-passenger front air bag is activated
or deactivated depending on the person on
the front-passenger seat. The frontpassenger front air bag can only deploy in an
accident if the PASSENGER AIR BAG ON indicator lamp is lit. Observe the information on
the PASSENGER AIR BAG indicator lamps
(Y page 41).
Your vehicle has two-stage front air bags.
During the first deployment stage, the front
air bag is filled with propellant gas to reduce
the risk of injuries. The front air bag is fully
deployed with the maximum amount of propellant gas if a second deployment threshold
is reached within a few milliseconds.
The deployment threshold of the Emergency
Tensioning Devices and the air bag are determined by evaluating the rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration which occurs at various points in the vehicle. This process is preemptive in nature. Deployment should take
place in good time at the start of the collision.
The rate of vehicle deceleration or acceleration and the direction of the force are essentially determined by:
Rthe
distribution of forces during the collision
Rthe collision angle
Rthe deformation characteristics of the vehicle
Rthe characteristics of the object with which
the vehicle has collided
Factors which can only be seen and measured
after a collision has occurred do not play a
decisive role in the deployment of an air bag,
nor do they provide an indication of air bag
deployment.
The vehicle can be deformed considerably,
without an air bag being deployed. This is the
case if only parts which are relatively easily
deformed are affected and the rate of deceleration is not high. Conversely, air bags may
be deployed even though the vehicle suffers
only minor deformation. This is the case if, for
example, very rigid vehicle parts such as longitudinal body members are hit, and sufficient
deceleration occurs as a result.
If the restraint system control unit detects a
side impact or that the vehicle is rolling over,
the relevant restraint system components are
activated independently of one another
depending on the apparent type of accident.
If the system determines a need for additional
protection for the vehicle occupants, the
Emergency Tensioning Devices are deployed.
RSide
impact air bag on the side of impact,
independently of the Emergency Tensioning Device and the use of the seat belt on
the driver's seat
The side impact air bag on the frontpassenger side deploys under the following
conditions:
- the OCS system detects that the frontpassenger seat is occupied or
- the belt tongue is engaged in the belt
buckle of the front-passenger seat
RWindow curtain air bag on the side of
impact, independently of the use of the
seat belt and independently of whether the
front-passenger seat is occupied
RWindow curtain air bags on the driver's and
front-passenger side in certain situations
when the vehicle rolls over, if the system
determines that deployment can offer additional protection to that provided by the
seat belt
i Not all air bags are deployed in an accident. The different air bag systems work
independently of each other.
Z
55
Safety
Occupant safety
56
Children in the vehicle
Safety
How the air bag system works is determined by the severity of the accident detected, especially the vehicle deceleration or
acceleration and the apparent type of accident:
Rfrontal
collision
impact
Rrollover
Rside
the child restraint system manufacturer's
installation instructions
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and
safety notes on the "Occupant classification system (OCS)" (Y page 49)
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen
Automatic measures after an accident
Immediately after an accident, the following
measures are implemented, depending on
the type and severity of the impact:
Rthe
hazard warning lamps are activated
Rthe emergency lighting is activated
Rthe vehicle doors are unlocked
Rthe front side windows are lowered
Rthe drive system is deactivated
Rvehicles with mbrace: automatic emergency call
Children in the vehicle
Important safety notes
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you install a child restraint system on a
rear seat. Children are generally better protected there.
If a child younger than 12 years and under 5 ft
(1.50 m) in height is traveling in the vehicle:
Ralways
secure the child in a child restraint
system suitable for Mercedes-Benz vehicles. The child restraint system must be
appropriate to the age, weight and size of
the child
Rbe sure to observe the instructions and
safety notes in this section in addition to
the doors, thus endangering other
people or road users.
Rget out and disrupt traffic.
Roperate the vehicle's equipment.
Additionally, children could set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake.
Rshift the transmission out of park position P
Rstart
the vehicle's drive system.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children or animals unattended in the
vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of
reach of children.
G WARNING
If persons, particularly children are subjected
to prolonged exposure to extreme heat or
cold, there is a risk of injury, possibly even
fatal. Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is subjected to
direct sunlight, parts may get very hot. Children may burn themselves on these parts,
particularly on the metal parts of the child
restraint system. There is a risk of injury.
If you leave the vehicle, taking the child with
you, always ensure that the child restraint
system is not exposed to direct sunlight. Protect it with a blanket, for example. If the child
restraint system has been exposed to direct
sunlight, let it cool down before securing the
Children in the vehicle
Always ensure that all vehicle occupants have
their seat belts fastened correctly and are sitting properly. Particular attention must be
paid to children.
Observe the safety notes on the seat belt
(Y page 42) and the notes on correct use of
seat belts (Y page 43).
A booster seat may be necessary to achieve
proper seat belt positioning for children over
41 lbs (18 kg) or until they reach a height
where a lap/shoulder belt can be fastened
properly without a booster seat.
Special seat belt retractor
G WARNING
If the seat belt is released while driving, the
child restraint system will no longer be
secured properly. The special seat belt retractor is disabled and the inertia real draws in a
portion of the seat belt. The seat belt cannot
be immediately refastened. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions. Reactivate
the special seat belt retractor and secure the
child restraint system properly.
All seat belts except the driver's seat belt are
equipped with a special seat belt retractor.
When activated, the special seat belt retractor ensures that the seat belt will not slacken
once the child restraint system has been
secured.
Installing a child restraint system:
Always comply with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
X Pull the seat belt smoothly from the belt
outlet.
X Engage the seat belt tongue in the belt
buckle.
X
Activating the special seat belt retractor:
Pull the seat belt out fully and let the inertia
reel retract it again.
While the seat belt is retracting, you should
hear a ratcheting sound. The special seat
belt retractor is activated.
X Push the child seat restraint system down
so that the seat belt is tight and does not
loosen.
X
Removing a child restraint system/deactivating the special seat belt retractor:
Always comply with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
X Press the release button on the belt buckle,
hold the belt tongue firmly and guide it back
towards the belt outlet.
The special seat belt retractor is deactivated.
X
Child restraint system
The use of seat belts and child restraint systems is required by law in:
Rall
50 states
U.S. territories
Rthe District of Columbia
Rall Canadian provinces
You can obtain further information about the
correct child restraint system from any
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Rthe
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is installed incorrectly on a suitable seat, it cannot protect as
intended. The child cannot then be restrained
in the event of an accident, heavy braking or
sudden changes of direction. There is an
increased risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Make sure that you observe the child restraint
system manufacturer's installation instructions and the notes on use. Please ensure,
that the base of the child restraint system is
always resting completely on the seat cushZ
Safety
child in it. Never leave children unattended in
the vehicle.
57
Safety
58
Children in the vehicle
ion. Never place objects, e.g. cushions, under
or behind the child restraint system. Only use
child restraint systems with the original cover
designed for them. Only replace damaged
covers with genuine covers.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is installed incorrectly or is not secured, it can come loose in
the event of an accident, heavy braking or a
sudden change in direction. The child
restraint system could be thrown about, striking vehicle occupants. There is an increased
risk of injury, possibly even fatal.
Always install child restraint systems properly, even if they are not being used. Make
sure that you observe the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions.
You will find further information on stowing
objects, luggage or loads under "Loading
guidelines" (Y page 228).
i If it is absolutely necessary to carry a child
on the front-passenger seat, be sure to
observe the information on the "Occupant
Classification System (OCS)" (Y page 49).
There you will also find information on
deactivating the front-passenger front air
bag.
All child restraint systems must meet the following standards:
RU.S.
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards 213 and 225
RCanadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards
213 and 210.2
Confirmation that the child restraint system
corresponds to the standards can be found
on an instruction label on the child restraint
system. This confirmation can also be found
in the installation instructions that are included with the child restraint system.
Observe the warning labels in the vehicle interior and on the child restraint system.
G WARNING
Child restraint systems or their securing systems which have been damaged or subjected
to a load in an accident can no longer protect
as intended. The child cannot then be
restrained in the event of an accident, heavy
braking or sudden changes of direction. There
is an increased risk of injury, possibly even
fatal.
Replace child restraint systems which have
been damaged or subjected to a load in an
accident as soon as possible. Have the securing systems on the child restraint system
checked at a qualified specialist workshop,
before you install a child restraint system
again.
Securing systems for the child restraint system are:
Rthe
seat belt system
ISOFIX (LATCH-type) securing rings
Rthe Top Tether anchorages
Rthe
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat securing system
G WARNING
LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint systems
do not offer sufficient protective effect for
children whose weight is greater than 48 lbs
(22 kg) who are secured using the safety belt
integrated in the child restraint system. In the
event of an accident, a child might not be
restrained correctly. This poses an increased
risk of injury or even fatal injury.
If the child weighs more than 48 lbs (22 kg),
only use LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child restraint
systems with which the child is also secured
with the vehicle seat belt. Also secure the
child restraint system with the Top Tether
belt, if available.
Always comply with the manufacturer's
installation and operating instructions for the
child restraint system used.
Children in the vehicle
! When installing the child restraint system,
make sure that the seat belt for the middle
seat does not get trapped. The seat belt
could otherwise be damaged.
: LATCH-type (ISOFIX) securing rings
X
Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system on both LATCH-type (ISOFIX) securing rings :.
ISOFIX is a standardized securing system for
specially designed child restraint systems on
the rear seats. LATCH-type (ISOFIX) securing
rings : for two LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint systems are installed on the left and
right rear seats.
Non-LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seats may
also be used and can be installed using the
vehicle's seat belt system. Install child seats
according to the manufacturer's instructions.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the rear seat backrests are not locked, they
could fold forwards in the event of an accident, heavy braking or sudden changes of
direction. As a result, child restraint systems
cannot perform their intended protective
function. Rear seat backrests that are not
locked can also cause additional injuries, e.g.
in the event of an accident. This poses an
increased risk of injury or even fatal injury.
Always lock rear seat backrests after installing a Top Tether belt. Observe the lock verification indicator. Adjust the rear seat backrests so that they are in an upright position.
If the rear backrest is not engaged and
locked, the red lock verification indicator will
be visible (Y page 230).
Top Tether anchorages
The Top Tether anchorages are located on the
rear side of the rear seat backrests.
Top Tether
Introduction
Top Tether provides an additional connection
between a child restraint system, secured
with a LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child seat mount,
and the rear seat. This helps reduce the risk of
injury even further. If the child restraint system is equipped with a Top Tether belt, this
should always be used.
Z
Safety
Before every trip, make sure that the LATCHtype (ISOFIX) child restraint system is
engaged correctly in both LATCH-type (ISOFIX) securing rings
59
Children in the vehicle
60
Move head restraint : upwards.
Release rear seat backrest = and fold it
forwards (Y page 230).
X Route Top Tether belt B under head
restraint : between the two head restraint
bars.
X Hook Top Tether hook A of Top Tether belt
B into Top Tether anchorage ?.
Make sure that:
X
Safety
X
RTop
Tether hook A is hooked into Top
Tether anchorage ? as shown.
RTop Tether belt B is not twisted.
RTop Tether belt B is routed between rear
seat backrest = and cargo compartment cover ; if cargo compartment
cover ; is installed.
RTop Tether belt B is routed between the
rear seat backrest = and the cargo net if
the cargo net is installed.
X Swing back rear seat backrest = until it
engages.
The red lock verification indicator is no longer visible.
X Install the LATCH-type (ISOFIX) child
restraint system with Top Tether. Always
comply with the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation instructions
when doing so.
X Tension Top Tether belt B. Always comply
with the child restraint system manufacturer's installation instructions when doing so.
X Move head restraint : back down again
slightly if necessary (Y page 90). Make
sure that you do not interfere with the correct routing of Top Tether belt B.
Child restraint system on the frontpassenger seat
General notes
Accident statistics show that children
secured in the rear seats are safer than children secured in the front-passenger seat. For
this reason, Mercedes-Benz strongly advises
that you install a child restraint system on a
rear seat.
If it is absolutely necessary to install a child
restraint system to the front-passenger seat,
be sure to observe the instructions and safety
notes on the "Occupant classification system
(OCS)" (Y page 49).
You can thus avoid the risks that could arise
as a result of:
Ran
incorrectly categorized person in the
front-passenger seat
Rthe unintentional deactivation of the frontpassenger front air bag
Rthe unsuitable positioning of the child
restraint system, e.g. too close to the dashboard
Rearward-facing child restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to install a rearward-facing child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat, always make sure that
the front-passenger front air bag is deactivated. Only if the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF
indicator lamp is permanently lit (Y page 41)
is the front-passenger front air bag deactivated.
Always observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation and operating
instructions.
Forward-facing child restraint system
If it is absolutely necessary to install a
forward-facing child restraint system on the
front-passenger seat, always move the frontpassenger seat as far back as possible. The
entire base of the child restraint system must
always rest on the seat cushion of the frontpassenger seat. The backrest of the child
restraint system must, as far as possible, lie
flat against the backrest of the frontpassenger seat. The child restraint system
must not touch the roof or be put under strain
by the head restraint. Adjust the angle of the
seat backrest and the head restraint position
accordingly. Always make sure that the shoul-
Children in the vehicle
Child-proof locks
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are traveling in the vehicle, they
could:
Ropen doors, thus endangering other people
or road users
Rexit the vehicle and be caught by oncoming
traffic
Roperate vehicle equipment and become
trapped
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Always activate the child-proof locks and
override feature if children are traveling in the
vehicle. When leaving the vehicle, always take
the key with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unattended in the vehicle.
Override feature for:
RRear
RRear
Additionally, children could set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake.
Rshift the transmission out of park position P
Rstart the vehicle's drive system.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children or animals unattended in the
vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of
reach of children.
G WARNING
If persons, particularly children are subjected
to prolonged exposure to extreme heat or
cold, there is a risk of injury, possibly even
fatal. Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
G WARNING
If the child restraint system is subjected to
direct sunlight, parts may get very hot. Children may burn themselves on these parts,
particularly on the metal parts of the child
restraint system. There is a risk of injury.
If you leave the vehicle, taking the child with
you, always ensure that the child restraint
system is not exposed to direct sunlight. Protect it with a blanket, for example. If the child
restraint system has been exposed to direct
sunlight, let it cool down before securing the
child in it. Never leave children unattended in
the vehicle.
doors (Y page 62)
side windows (Y page 62)
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen
the doors, thus endangering other
people or road users.
Rget out and disrupt traffic.
Roperate the vehicle's equipment.
Z
Safety
der belt strap is correctly routed from the
vehicle belt sash guide to the shoulder belt
guide on the child restraint system. The shoulder belt strap must be routed forwards and
downwards from the vehicle belt sash guide.
If necessary, adjust the vehicle belt sash
guide and the front-passenger seat accordingly.
Always observe the child restraint system
manufacturer's installation and operating
instructions.
61
Driving safety systems
62
Child-proof locks for the rear doors
Pets in the vehicle
Safety
G WARNING
If you leave animals unattended or unsecured
in the vehicle, they could press buttons or
switches, for example.
As a result, they could:
Ractivate
You secure each door individually with the
child-proof locks on the rear doors. A door
secured with a child-proof lock cannot be
opened from inside the vehicle. When the
vehicle is unlocked, the door can be opened
from the outside.
X To activate: press the child-proof lock
lever up in the direction of arrow :.
X Make sure that the child-proof locks are
working properly.
X To deactivate: press the child-proof lock
lever down in the direction of arrow ;.
Override feature for the rear side windows
vehicle equipment and become
trapped, for example
Ractivate or deactivate systems, thereby
endangering other road users
Unsecured animals could also be flung around
the vehicle in the event of an accident or sudden steering or braking, thereby injuring vehicle occupants. There is a risk of an accident
and injury.
Never leave animals unattended in the vehicle. Always secure animals properly during
the journey, e.g. use a suitable animal transport box.
Driving safety systems
Overview of driving safety systems
In this section, you will find information about
the following driving safety systems:
RABS
X
To activate/deactivate: press button :.
If indicator lamp is lit, operation of the rear
side windows is disabled. Operation is only
possible using the switches in the driver's
door. If the indicator lamp is off, operation
is possible using the switches in the rear
compartment.
(Anti-lock Braking System)
(Y page 63)
RBAS (Brake Assist System) (Y page 63)
RRBS (Recuperative Brake System)
(Y page 68)
RCOLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST (Adaptive
Brake Assist and distance warning signal)
(Y page 64)
RESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
(Y page 66)
REBD (Electronic Brake force Distribution)
(Y page 66)
RADAPTIVE BRAKE (Y page 68)
RSTEER CONTROL (Y page 68)
Important safety notes
If you fail to adapt your driving style or
become distracted, the driving safety systems can neither reduce the risk of accident
nor override the laws of physics. Driving
safety systems are merely aids designed to
assist driving. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed
and for braking in good time. Always adapt
your driving style to suit the prevailing road,
weather and traffic conditions and maintain a
safe distance from the vehicle in front. Drive
carefully.
i The driving safety systems described only
work as effectively as possible when there
is adequate contact between the tires and
the road surface. Pay particular attention to
the information regarding tires, recommended minimum tire tread depths etc. in the
"Wheels and tires" section (Y page 278).
In wintry driving conditions, always use
winter tires (M+S tires) and if necessary,
snow chains. Only in this way will the driving safety systems described in this section
work as effectively as possible.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System)
General information
ABS regulates brake pressure in such a way
that the wheels do not lock when you brake.
This allows you to continue steering the vehicle when braking.
The ! ABS warning lamp in the instrument
cluster lights up when the ignition is switched
on. It goes out if the drive system is running.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 63).
G WARNING
If ABS is faulty, the wheels could lock when
braking. The steerability and braking charac-
teristics may be severely impaired. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. There is an increased danger of skidding and accidents.
Drive on carefully. Have ABS checked immediately at a qualified specialist workshop.
When ABS is malfunctioning, other systems,
including driving safety systems, will also
become inoperative. Observe the information
on the ABS warning lamp (Y page 218) and
display messages which may be shown in the
instrument cluster (Y page 191).
ABS works from a speed of about 5 mph
(8 km/h), regardless of road-surface conditions. ABS works on slippery roads, even if
you only brake gently.
Braking
If ABS intervenes: continue to depress the
brake pedal vigorously until the braking situation is over.
X To make a full brake application:
depress the brake pedal with full force.
X
If ABS intervenes when braking, you will feel a
pulsing in the brake pedal.
The pulsating brake pedal can be an indication of hazardous road conditions, and functions as a reminder to take extra care while
driving.
BAS (Brake Assist System)
General information
BAS operates in emergency braking situations. If you depress the brake pedal quickly,
BAS automatically boosts the braking force,
thus shortening the stopping distance.
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 63).
Z
63
Safety
Driving safety systems
Driving safety systems
Safety
64
G WARNING
If BAS is malfunctioning, the braking distance
in an emergency braking situation is
increased. There is a risk of an accident.
In an emergency braking situation, depress
the brake pedal with full force. ABS prevents
the wheels from locking.
Braking
X
Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed until
the emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
The brakes will function as usual once you
release the brake pedal. BAS is deactivated.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST
General notes
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST comprises
Adaptive Brake Assist and the distance warning signal, which are described in the following.
Distance warning function
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section for driving safety systems (Y page 63).
G WARNING
The distance warning function does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rwhen cornering
Thus, the distance warning function cannot
provide a warning in all critical situations.
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
G WARNING
The distance warning function cannot always
clearly identify objects and complex traffic
situations.
In such cases, the distance warning function
may:
Rgive
an unnecessary warning
give a warning
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and do not rely solely on the distance
warning function.
Rnot
Function
X To activate/deactivate: activate or deactivate the distance warning function in the
on-board computer (Y page 184).
If the distance warning function is activated,
the multifunction display does not display a
symbol.
When the distance warning function is deactivated, the æ symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphics
display.
The distance warning function can help you to
minimize the risk of a front-end collision with
a vehicle ahead or reduce the effects of such
a collision. If the distance warning function
detects that there is a risk of a collision, you
will be warned visually and acoustically. The
distance warning function cannot prevent a
collision without your intervention.
Starting at a speed of around 4 mph (7 km/h),
the distance warning function warns you if
you rapidly approach a vehicle in front. An
intermittent warning tone will then sound,
and the · distance warning lamp will light
up in the instrument cluster.
X Brake immediately in order to increase the
distance from the vehicle in front.
or
X Take evasive action provided it is safe to do
so.
Driving safety systems
Rdirt
on the sensors or anything else covering the sensors
Rthere is snow or heavy rain
Rthere is interference by other radar sources
Rthere are strong radar reflections, for
example in parking garages
Ra narrow vehicle traveling in front, e.g. a
motorbike
Ra vehicle traveling in front on a different line
relative to the center of your vehicle
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at low speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Adaptive Brake Assist
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion for driving safety systems (Y page 63).
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist cannot always clearly
identify objects and complex traffic situations.
In such cases, Adaptive Brake Assist can:
Rintervene
unnecessarily
intervene
There is a risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake. Terminate the
intervention in a non-critical driving situation.
Rnot
G WARNING
Adaptive Brake Assist does not react:
Rto
people or animals
oncoming vehicles
Rto crossing traffic
Rto stationary obstacles
Rwhen cornering
As a result, the Adaptive Brake Assist may not
intervene in all critical conditions. There is a
risk of an accident.
Always pay careful attention to the traffic situation and be ready to brake.
Rto
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions may also cause Brake Assist to intervene.
Adaptive Brake Assist provides braking assistance in hazardous situations at speeds
above 4 mph (7 km/h). It uses radar sensor
technology to assess the traffic situation.
With the help of Adaptive Brake Assist, the
distance warning signal can detect obstacles
that are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time.
As soon as a risk of a collision is detected,
Adaptive Brake Assist calculates the braking
force necessary to avoid the collision. If you
apply the brakes forcefully, Adaptive Brake
Assist will automatically increase the braking
force to a level suitable for the traffic conditions.
X Keep the brake pedal depressed until the
emergency braking situation is over.
ABS prevents the wheels from locking.
Z
Safety
Due to the nature of the system, particularly
complicated but non-critical driving conditions may also cause the system to display a
warning.
With the help of the radar sensor system, the
distance warning function can detect obstacles that are in the path of your vehicle for an
extended period of time.
Up to a speed of around 40 mph (70 km/h),
the distance warning function can also react
to stationary obstacles, such as stopped or
parked vehicles.
If you approach an obstacle and the distance
warning function detects a risk of a collision,
the system will initially alert you both visually
and acoustically.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if:
65
66
Driving safety systems
The brakes will work normally again if:
Important safety notes
Ryou
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
release the brake pedal.
Rthere is no longer any danger of a collision.
Safety
Rthere
is no longer an obstacle detected in
front of your vehicle.
Adaptive Brake Assist is then deactivated.
Up to a speed of approximately 155 mph
(250 km/h), Adaptive Brake Assist is capable
of reacting to moving objects that have
already been detected as such at least once
over the period of observation. Adaptive
Brake Assist does not react to stationary
obstacles.
If Adaptive Brake Assist is not available due to
a malfunction in the radar sensor system, the
brake system remains available with full
brake boosting effect and BAS.
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if there is:
Rthere is dirt on the sensors or anything else
covering the sensors
is snow or heavy rain
Rthere is interference by other radar sources
Rthere are strong radar reflections, for
example in parking garages
Ra narrow vehicle traveling in front, e.g. a
motorbike
Ra vehicle traveling in front on a different line
relative to the center of your vehicle
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Rthere
EBD (electronic brake force distribution)
General information
EBD monitors and controls the brake pressure on the rear wheels to improve driving
stability while braking.
tion for driving safety systems (Y page 63).
G WARNING
If EBD is malfunctioning, the rear wheels can
lock, e.g. under full braking. This increases the
risk of skidding and an accident.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
to the different handling characteristics. Have
the brake system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Observe information regarding indicator and
warning lamps (Y page 218) as well as display messages (Y page 195).
ESP® (Electronic Stability Program)
General notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 63).
ESP® monitors driving stability and traction,
i.e. power transmission between the tires and
the road surface.
If ESP® detects that the vehicle is deviating
from the direction desired by the driver, one
or more wheels are braked to stabilize the
vehicle. The drive system output is also modified to keep the vehicle on the desired course
within physical limits. ESP® assists the driver
when pulling away on wet or slippery roads.
ESP® can also stabilize the vehicle during
braking.
ETS/4ETS (Electronic Traction System)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 63).
ETS traction control is part of ESP®.
ETS brakes the drive wheels individually if
they spin. This enables you to pull away and
accelerate on slippery surfaces, for example
if the road surface is slippery on one side. In
Driving safety systems
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If ESP® is malfunctioning, ESP® is unable to
stabilize the vehicle. Additionally, further driving safety systems are deactivated. This
increases the risk of skidding and an accident.
ESP®
Drive on carefully. Have
checked at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! When testing the electric parking brake
on a braking dynamometer, switch off the
ignition. Application of the brakes by ESP®
may otherwise destroy the brake system.
When towing your vehicle with the front axle
raised, observe the notes on ESP®
(Y page 273).
ESP® is deactivated if the å ESP® OFF
warning lamp in the instrument cluster lights
up continuously when the drive system is running.
If the ÷ ESP® warning lamp and the å
ESP® OFF warning lamp are lit continuously,
ESP® is not available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 221) and display messages which
may be shown in the instrument cluster
(Y page 191).
i Only use wheels with the recommended
tire sizes. Only then will ESP® function
properly.
Characteristics of ESP®
General information
If the ÷ ESP warning lamp goes out before
beginning the journey, ESP® is automatically
active.
If ESP® intervenes, the ÷ ESP® warning
lamp flashes in the instrument cluster.
If ESP® intervenes:
Do not deactivate ESP® under any circumstances.
X Only depress the accelerator pedal as far as
necessary when pulling away.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the prevailing road and weather conditions.
X
Deactivating/activating ESP®
Important safety notes
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section (Y page 63).
You can select between the following states
of ESP®:
RESP®
RESP®
is activated.
is deactivated.
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilizes the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
Rin
i Activate ESP® as soon as the situations
described above no longer apply. ESP® will
otherwise not be able to stabilize the vehicle if the vehicle starts to skid or a wheel
starts to spin.
! Avoid spinning the driven wheels for an
extended period with ESP® deactivated.
You could otherwise damage the drivetrain.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
You can deactivate or activate ESP® via the
on-board computer.
Z
Safety
addition, more drive torque is transferred to
the wheel or wheels with traction.
ETS remains active when you deactivate
ESP®.
67
Driving safety systems
Safety
68
X
To deactivate: (Y page 183).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
This steering assistance is provided in particular if:
X
To activate: (Y page 183).
The å ESP® OFF warning lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
a wet or slippery road surface when you
brake.
Rthe vehicle starts to skid.
Rboth right wheels or both left wheels are on
Characteristics when ESP® is deactivated
Important safety notes
If ESP® is deactivated and one or more wheels
If ESP® is malfunctioning, you will not receive
steering support from STEER CONTROL.
Power steering will, however, continue to
function.
start to spin, the ÷ ESP® warning lamp in
the instrument cluster flashes. In such situations, ESP® will not stabilize the vehicle.
If you deactivate ESP®:
RESP®
no longer improves driving stability.
drive system's torque is no longer limited and the driven wheels are able to spin.
The spinning of the wheels results in a cutting action for better traction on loose surfaces.
Rtraction control is still activated.
RESP® still provides support when you
brake.
Rthe
ADAPTIVE BRAKE
ADAPTIVE BRAKE enhances braking safety
and offers increased braking comfort. In addition to the braking function, ADAPTIVE BRAKE
also has the HOLD function (Y page 154) and
hill start assist (Y page 128). For further
information, see "Driving tips" (Y page 148).
STEER CONTROL
General information
STEER CONTROL helps you by transmitting a
noticeable steering force to the steering
wheel in the direction required for vehicle
stabilization.
RBS (Recuperative Brake System)
i Observe the "Important safety notes" sec-
tion for driving safety systems (Y page 63).
RBS converts the kinetic energy when braking
into electrical current. The electric motor is
used as an alternator during braking. The converted energy is then stored in the high-voltage battery.
If the warning light in the instrument cluster is
lit up, there is a motor malfunction or a brake
malfunction.
G WARNING
In the event of malfunctions in the RBS, the
following may occur:
Rthe braking performance of the electric
motor may be either reduced or not effective
Rbrake pedal resistance may be lower than
usual
Rpedal travel may be longer than usual
If you do not make an additional effort to apply
the brake yourself, the braking effect may not
be sufficient. There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of this malfunction, continue to
depress the brake pedal. The brake system is
still fully functional.
Theft deterrent locking system
Immobilizer
The immobilizer prevents your vehicle from
being started without the correct SmartKey.
X To activate: remove the SmartKey from
the ignition lock.
X To deactivate: switch on the ignition.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Anyone can start the drive system if a valid key
has been left inside the vehicle.
i The immobilizer is always deactivated
when you start the drive system.
If the drive system cannot be started when
the starter battery is fully charged, the
immobilizer may be faulty. The READY display in the multifunction display does not
appear. Contact an authorized MercedesBenz Center or call 1-800-FOR-MERCedes
(in the USA) or 1-800-387-0100 (in Canada).
ATA (anti-theft alarm system)
X
To disarm: unlock the vehicle with the
SmartKey.
or
X
Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
A visual and an audible alarm are triggered if
the alarm system is armed and you open:
Rthe
vehicle with the mechanical key
door
Rthe tailgate
Rthe hood
X To stop the alarm: insert the SmartKey
into the ignition lock.
The alarm is switched off.
or
X Press the % or & button on the
SmartKey.
The alarm is switched off.
Ra
The alarm is not switched off, even if you
close the open door that triggered it, for
example.
i If the alarm stays on for more than
30 seconds, the mbrace emergency call
system automatically sends a message to
the Customer Assistance Center by text
message or data connection. The emergency call system sends the message provided that:
Ryou
have subscribed to the mbrace service.
Rthe mbrace service has been activated
properly.
Rthe necessary mobile phone network is
available.
X
To arm: lock the vehicle with the SmartKey.
Indicator lamp : flashes. The alarm system is armed after approximately
15 seconds.
Z
Safety
Theft deterrent locking system
69
70
71
Useful information .............................. 72
SmartKey ............................................. 72
Doors .................................................... 77
Cargo compartment ............................ 79
Opening and closing
Side windows ...................................... 81
72
SmartKey
Useful information
Opening and closing
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
G WARNING
If you attach heavy or large objects to the
SmartKey, the SmartKey could be unintentionally turned in the ignition lock. This could
cause the engine to be switched off. There is a
risk of an accident.
Do not attach any heavy or large objects to the
SmartKey. Remove any bulky key rings before
inserting the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
! Keep the SmartKey away from strong
magnetic fields. Otherwise, the remote
control function could be affected.
Strong magnetic fields can occur in the
vicinity of powerful electrical installations.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
SmartKey
Do not keep the SmartKey:
Important safety notes
Rwith
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen
the doors, thus endangering other
people or road users.
Rget out and disrupt traffic.
Roperate the vehicle's equipment.
Additionally, children could set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
electronic devices, e.g. a mobile
phone or another SmartKey
Rwith metallic objects, e.g. coins or metal
foil
Rinside metallic objects, e.g. a metal case
SmartKey functions
the parking brake.
Rshift the transmission out of park position P
Rstart the vehicle's drive system.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children or animals unattended in the
vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of
reach of children.
G WARNING
If persons, particularly children are subjected
to prolonged exposure to extreme heat or
cold, there is a risk of injury, possibly even
fatal. Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
: & To lock the vehicle
; % To unlock the vehicle
X
To unlock centrally: press button ;.
If you do not open the vehicle within approximately 40 seconds of unlocking:
Rthe
vehicle is locked again.
Rthe theft deterrent locking system is armed
again.
X To lock centrally: press button :.
SmartKey
Rthe
doors
Rthe tailgate
Rthe charge socket flap
The turn signals flash once when unlocking
and three times when locking.
i You can also set an audible signal to confirm that the vehicle has been locked. The
audible signal can be activated and deactivated using the on-board computer
(Y page 188).
Changing the settings of the locking
system
You can change the settings of the locking
system. Then only the driver's door is
unlocked when you unlock the vehicle. This is
useful if you frequently travel on your own.
To change the setting: simultaneously
press the % and & buttons for
approximately 6 seconds until the battery
check lamp (Y page 74) flashes twice.
i If the setting of the locking system is
changed within the signal range of the vehicle, pressing the & or % button:
X
Rlocks
Mechanical key
General notes
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the SmartKey, use the mechanical key.
If you use the mechanical key to unlock and
open the driver's door, the anti-theft alarm
system will be triggered (Y page 69).
There are several ways to turn off the alarm:
X
Press the % or & button on the
SmartKey.
or
X
Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
If you unlock the vehicle using the mechanical
key, the charge socket flap will not be
unlocked automatically.
X To unlock the charge socket flap: insert
the SmartKey into the ignition lock.
Removing the mechanical key
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
The SmartKey now functions as follows:
To unlock the driver's door: press the
% button once.
X To unlock centrally: press the % button twice.
X To lock centrally: press the & button.
X To restore the factory settings: simultaneously press the % and & buttons
for approximately 6 seconds until the battery check lamp flashes twice
(Y page 74).
X
X
Push release catch : in the direction of
the arrow and at the same time remove
mechanical key ; from the SmartKey.
For further information about:
Runlocking
the driver's door (Y page 79)
the cargo compartment
(Y page 80)
Rlocking the vehicle (Y page 79)
Runlocking
Z
Opening and closing
The SmartKey centrally locks/unlocks:
73
SmartKey
74
SmartKey battery
i If the SmartKey battery is checked within
the signal reception range of the vehicle,
pressing the & or % button:
Opening and closing
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Batteries contain toxic and corrosive substances. If batteries are swallowed, it can result in
severe health problems. There is a risk of fatal
injury.
Keep batteries out of the reach of children. If
a battery is swallowed, seek medical attention
immediately.
The SmartKey batteries contain perchlorate
material, which may require special handling
and regard for the environment. National
guidelines must be observed during disposal.
In California, see www.dtsc.ca.gov/
HazardousWaste/Perchlorate/
index.cfm.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the batteries replaced at a qualified specialist
workshop.
Rlocks
or
Runlocks
the vehicle
i You can get a battery at any qualified specialist workshop.
Replacing the battery
You will need a CR 2025 3 V cell battery.
X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73).
Checking the battery
Press mechanical key ; into the opening
in the SmartKey in the direction of the
arrow until battery tray cover : opens.
When doing so, do not hold cover : shut.
X Remove battery tray cover :.
X
Press the & or % button.
The battery is working properly if battery
check lamp : lights up briefly.
The battery is discharged if battery check
lamp : does not light up briefly.
X Change the battery (Y page 74).
X
Repeatedly tap the SmartKey against your
palm until battery = falls out.
X Insert the new battery with the positive terminal facing upwards. Use a lint-free cloth
to do so.
X
SmartKey
Make sure that the surface of the battery is
free of lint, grease and other contaminants.
X Insert the front tabs of battery tray cover :
and then press to close it.
X Insert the mechanical key into the SmartKey.
X Check the function of all SmartKey buttons
on the vehicle.
75
Opening and closing
X
Z
76
SmartKey
Problems with the SmartKey
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
You cannot lock or
unlock the vehicle
using the SmartKey.
The SmartKey battery is discharged or nearly discharged.
X Try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control
function of the SmartKey. Point the tip of the SmartKey at the
driver's door handle from close range and press the % or
& button.
Opening and closing
Problem
If this does not work:
Check the SmartKey battery and replace it if necessary
(Y page 74).
X Unlock (Y page 79) or lock (Y page 79) the vehicle using the
mechanical key.
X
There is interference from a powerful source of radio waves.
Try again to lock/unlock the vehicle using the remote control
function of the SmartKey. Point the tip of the key at the driver's
door handle from close range and press the % / & button.
X
The SmartKey is faulty.
X Unlock (Y page 79) or lock (Y page 79) the vehicle using the
mechanical key.
X Have the SmartKey checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
You have lost a SmartKey.
Have the SmartKey deactivated at a qualified specialist workshop.
X Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
You have lost the
mechanical key.
X
X
Report the loss immediately to the vehicle insurers.
X If necessary, have the locks changed as well.
Doors
Problem
77
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
If this does not work:
Check the starter battery and charge it if necessary
(Y page 265).
or
X Jump-start the vehicle (Y page 269).
or
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The drive system can- The steering lock is mechanically blocked.
not be started using the X Remove the SmartKey and reinsert it into the ignition lock. While
key.
doing this, turn the steering wheel in both directions.
Doors
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen
the doors, thus endangering other
people or road users.
Rget out and disrupt traffic.
Roperate the vehicle's equipment.
Additionally, children could set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
cold, there is a risk of injury, possibly even
fatal. Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
You should preferably place luggage or loads
in the cargo compartment. Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 228).
Unlocking and opening doors from
the inside
the parking brake.
Rshift the transmission out of park position P
Rstart the vehicle's drive system.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children or animals unattended in the
vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of
reach of children.
G WARNING
If persons, particularly children are subjected
to prolonged exposure to extreme heat or
X
To unlock a front door: pull door handle ;.
Locking knob : pops up.
The door is unlocked and can be opened.
Z
Opening and closing
The drive system can- The on-board voltage is too low.
not be started using the X Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g. seat heating or interior
key.
lighting, and try to start the drive system again.
Doors
Opening and closing
78
X
To open a front door: pull door handle ;.
X
To unlock a rear door: pull up locking
knob :.
The door is unlocked and can be opened.
X
To open a rear door: pull door handle ;.
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked. You can open the
rear doors from inside the vehicle unless they
are secured by the child-proof lock
(Y page 62).
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the SmartKey, opening a door from the inside
will trigger the anti-theft alarm system.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 69).
Centrally locking and unlocking the
vehicle from the inside
rear doors from inside the vehicle unless they
are secured by the child-proof lock
(Y page 62).
If the vehicle has previously been locked with
the SmartKey, opening a door from the inside
will trigger the anti-theft alarm system.
Switch off the alarm (Y page 69).
If the vehicle has been locked using the locking button for the central locking, or has been
locked automatically, and a door is opened
from the inside:
Rthe
vehicle will be fully unlocked if it had
previously been fully unlocked
Ronly the door which has been opened form
the inside is unlocked if only the driver's
door had been previously unlocked
Automatic locking feature
You can centrally lock or unlock the vehicle
from the inside. This can be useful if you wish
to lock the vehicle before pulling away, for
example.
To deactivate: press and hold button :
for about 5 seconds until a tone sounds.
X To activate: press and hold button ; for
about 5 seconds until a tone sounds.
X
X
X
To unlock: press button :.
To lock: press button ;.
The vehicle locks when all the doors and
the tailgate are closed.
This does not lock or unlock the charge
socket flap.
You cannot unlock the vehicle centrally from
the inside if the vehicle has been locked with
the SmartKey.
You can open a door from inside the vehicle
even if it has been locked. You can open the
i If you press one of the two buttons and do
not hear a tone, the relevant setting has
already been selected.
The vehicle is locked automatically when the
ignition is switched on and the wheels are
turning.
You could therefore lock yourself out if:
Rthe
vehicle is being pushed.
vehicle is being towed.
Rthe vehicle is on a roller dynamometer.
Rthe
Cargo compartment
Unlocking the driver's door (mechanical key)
If the vehicle can no longer be unlocked with
the SmartKey, use the mechanical key.
If you use the mechanical key to unlock and
open the driver's door, the anti-theft alarm
system will be triggered (Y page 69).
X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73).
X Insert the mechanical key into the lock of
the driver's door as far as it will go.
Check whether the locking knobs on the
front-passenger door and the rear doors
are still visible. Press down the locking
knobs manually, if necessary (Y page 77).
X Close the driver's door.
X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73).
X Insert the mechanical key into the lock of
the driver's door as far as it will go.
X
Turn the mechanical key clockwise as far as
it will go to position 1.
X Turn the mechanical key back and remove
it.
X Make sure that the doors and the tailgate
are locked.
X Insert the mechanical key into the SmartKey.
X
Turn the mechanical key counter-clockwise
as far as it will go to position 1.
The door is unlocked.
X Turn the mechanical key back and remove
it.
X Insert the mechanical key into the SmartKey.
X
i If you lock the vehicle as described above,
the charge socket flap is not locked. The
anti-theft alarm system is not armed.
Cargo compartment
Important safety notes
Locking the vehicle (mechanical key)
If the vehicle can no longer be locked with the
SmartKey, use the mechanical key.
X Open the driver's door.
X Close the front-passenger door, the rear
doors and the tailgate.
X Press the locking button (Y page 78).
G WARNING
If persons, particularly children are subjected
to prolonged exposure to extreme heat or
cold, there is a risk of injury, possibly even
fatal. Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
! The tailgate swings upwards and to the
rear when opened. Therefore, make sure
Z
Opening and closing
You can also switch the automatic locking
function on and off using the on-board computer (Y page 188).
79
Cargo compartment
80
that there is sufficient clearance above and
behind the tailgate.
Closing
i The opening dimensions of the tailgate
Opening and closing
can be found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 311).
You should preferably place luggage or loads
in the cargo compartment. Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 228).
Do not leave the SmartKey in the cargo compartment. You could otherwise lock yourself
out.
The tailgate can be:
Ropened
and closed manually from outside
Runlocked from inside with the mechanical
key
Opening/closing from outside
Opening
X
Press the % button on the SmartKey.
Pull the tailgate down using handle :.
Allow the tailgate to drop into the lock.
X If necessary, lock the vehicle with the &
button on the SmartKey.
X
X
Tailgate emergency release
If the tailgate can no longer be opened from
outside the vehicle, use the emergency
release on the inside of the tailgate.
! The tailgate swings upwards and to the
rear when opened. Therefore, make sure
that there is sufficient clearance above and
behind the tailgate.
i The opening dimensions of the tailgate
can be found in the "Vehicle data" section
(Y page 311).
X
X
Pull handle :.
Raise the tailgate.
You can reach the emergency release via the
cargo compartment. Fold the rear backrests
forward (Y page 231).
X Take the mechanical key out of the SmartKey (Y page 73).
Side windows
81
The side windows are equipped with an automatic reversing feature. If a solid object
blocks or restricts a side window during the
closing process, the side window opens again
automatically. However, the automatic
reversing feature is only an aid and does not
relieve you of the responsibility of paying
attention when closing a side window.
Insert mechanical key ; fully into opening : in the paneling.
X Turn mechanical key ; 90° clockwise.
X Push mechanical key ; in the direction of
the arrow and open the tailgate.
X
i When you lock the vehicle (Y page 79),
the cargo compartment is also locked.
Side windows
Important safety notes
G WARNING
While closing the side windows, body parts in
the closing area could become trapped. There
is a risk of injury.
When closing make sure that no parts of the
body are in the closing area. If somebody
becomes trapped, release the switch or press
the switch to open the side window again.
G WARNING
If children operate the side windows they
could become trapped, particularly if they are
left unsupervised. There is a risk of injury.
Activate the override feature for the rear side
windows. When leaving the vehicle, always
take the SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never leave children unsupervised in the
vehicle.
G WARNING
The reversing feature does not react:
Rto soft, light and thin objects, e.g. small fin-
gers
Rover
the last 1/6 in(4 mm) of the closing
movement
Rduring resetting
Rwhen closing the side window again manually immediately after automatic reversing
This means that the reversing feature cannot
prevent someone being trapped in these situations. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that no body parts are in close
proximity during the closing procedure. If
someone becomes trapped, press the switch
to open the side window again.
Opening and closing the side windows
The switches for all side windows are located
on the driver's door. There is also a switch on
each door for the corresponding side window.
The switches on the driver's door take precedence.
Z
Opening and closing
Side window reversing feature
Side windows
82
Convenience opening
You can ventilate the vehicle before you start
driving. To do this, the SmartKey is used to
carry out the following functions simultaneously:
Opening and closing
Runlock
Ropen
the vehicle
the side windows
i The convenience opening feature can
:
;
=
?
Front left
Front right
Rear right
Rear left
i When the override feature for the side
windows is activated (Y page 62), the side
windows cannot be operated from the rear.
Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock.
X To open: press the corresponding switch.
X To open fully: press the corresponding
switch beyond the point of resistance.
Automatic operation is started.
X To close: pull the corresponding switch.
X To close fully: pull the corresponding
switch beyond the pressure point. Automatic operation is started.
X To interrupt automatic operation:
press/pull the corresponding switch again.
i If you press/pull the switch beyond the
point of resistance, automatic operation is
started in the corresponding direction. You
can stop automatic operation by pressing/
pulling the switch again.
X
i You can continue to operate the side win-
dows after switching off the drive system or
removing the key. This function remains
active for 5 minutes or until the driver's or
front-passenger door is opened.
only be operated using the SmartKey. The
SmartKey must be close to the driver's
door handle.
Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's
door handle.
X Press and hold the % button until the
side windows are in the desired position.
X To interrupt convenience opening:
release the % button.
X
Convenience closing feature
G WARNING
When using the convenience closing feature,
parts of the body could be trapped in the closing area when a side window is being closed.
There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. Make sure that no body parts are in
close proximity during the closing procedure.
When you lock the vehicle, you can simultaneously:
Rclose
the side windows
i The SmartKey must be close to the driver's door handle.
Point the tip of the SmartKey at the driver's
door handle.
X Press and hold the & button until the
side windows are fully closed.
X
Side windows
83
Make sure that all the side windows are
closed.
X To interrupt convenience closing:
release the & button.
X
Opening and closing
Resetting the side windows
You must reset each side window if:
Rthe
side window opens again slightly after
being closed fully.
Rthe side window can no longer be fully
opened or closed.
X Close all the doors.
X Turn the key to position 1 or 2 in the ignition
lock.
X Pull the corresponding switch on the door
control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 81).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
If the side window opens again slightly:
Immediately pull the corresponding switch
on the door control panel until the side window is completely closed (Y page 81).
X Hold the switch for an additional second.
X If the respective side window remains
closed after the button is released, then it
has been set correctly. If this is not the
case, repeat the steps above again.
X
Z
84
Side windows
Problems with the side windows
Opening and closing
G WARNING
If you close a side window again immediately after it has been blocked or reset, the side window
closes with increased or maximum force. The reversing feature is then not active. Parts of the
body could be trapped in the closing area in the process. This poses an increased risk of injury or
even fatal injury.
Make sure that no parts of the body are in the closing area. To stop the closing process, release
the switch or push the switch again to reopen the side window.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
A side window cannot
be closed because it is
blocked by objects, e.g.
leaves in the window
guide.
Remove the objects.
X Close the side window.
X
A side window cannot If a side window is obstructed during closing and reopens again
be closed and you can- slightly:
not see the cause.
X Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed with increased force.
If a side window is obstructed again during closing and reopens
again slightly:
X
Immediately after the window blocks, pull the corresponding
switch again until the side window has closed.
The side window is closed without the anti-entrapment feature.
85
Useful information .............................. 86
Correct driver's seat position ............ 86
Seats .................................................... 87
Steering wheel .................................... 92
Mirrors ................................................. 93
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Memory functions ............................... 95
86
Correct driver's seat position
Useful information
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Correct driver's seat position
G WARNING
You could lose control of your vehicle if you do
the following while driving:
Radjust
the driver's seat, head restraint,
steering wheel or mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirror and fasten your seat belt
before starting the engine.
X
Make sure that seat = is adjusted properly.
Manual seat adjustment (Y page 88)
Electrical seat adjustment (Y page 89)
When adjusting the seat, make sure that:
Ryou
are as far away from the driver's air
bag as possible.
Ryou are sitting in a normal upright position.
Ryou can fasten the seat belt properly.
Ryou have moved the backrest to an
almost vertical position.
Ryou have set the seat cushion angle so
that your thighs are gently supported.
Ryou can depress the pedals properly.
X Check whether the head restraint is adjusted properly (Y page 89).
When doing so, make sure that you have
adjusted the head restraint so that the back
of your head is supported at eye level by the
center of the head restraint.
Observe the safety guidelines on steering
wheel adjustment (Y page 92).
X Make sure that steering wheel : is adjusted properly.
Adjusting the steering wheel
(Y page 92)
When adjusting the steering wheel, make
sure that:
Ryou can hold the steering wheel with your
arms slightly bent.
can move your legs freely.
Ryou can see all the displays in the instrument cluster clearly.
Ryou
Observe the safety guidelines for seat belts
(Y page 42).
X Check whether you have fastened seat
belt ; properly (Y page 44).
Observe the safety guidelines on seat adjustment (Y page 87).
Seats
Rfit
snugly across your body
Rbe routed across the middle of your
shoulder
Rbe routed in your pelvic area across the
hip joints
X Before starting off, adjust the rear-view mirror and the exterior mirrors (Y page 93) in
such a way that you have a good view of
road and traffic conditions.
X Vehicles with a memory function: save
the seat and exterior mirror settings
(Y page 95).
Seats
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Children could become trapped if they adjust
the seats, particularly when unattended.
There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.
The seats can still be adjusted when there is
no SmartKey in the ignition lock.
G WARNING
You could lose control of your vehicle if you do
the following while driving:
Radjust
the driver's seat, head restraint,
steering wheel or mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirror and fasten your seat belt
before starting the engine.
ment buttons and become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While moving the seats, make sure that your
hands or other body parts do not get under the
lever assembly of the seat adjustment system.
G WARNING
When you adjust a seat, you or other vehicle
occupants could become trapped, e.g. on the
seat guide rail. There is a risk of injury.
Make sure when adjusting a seat that no one
has any body parts in the sweep of the seat.
G WARNING
The seat belt does not offer the intended level
of protection if you have not moved the backrest to an almost vertical position. When braking or in the event of an accident, you could
slide underneath the seat belt and sustain
abdomen or neck injuries, for example. This
poses an increased risk of injury or even fatal
injury.
Adjust the seat properly before beginning
your journey. Always ensure that the backrest
is in an almost vertical position and that the
shoulder section of your seat belt is routed
across the center of your shoulder.
G WARNING
If head restraints are not installed and adjusted correctly, they cannot provide protection
as intended. There is an increased risk of
injury in the head and neck area, e.g. in the
event of an accident or when braking.
Always drive with the head restraints installed. Before driving off, make sure for every
vehicle occupant that the center of the head
restraint supports the back of the head at
about eye level.
G WARNING
If you adjust the seat height carelessly, you or
other vehicle occupants could be trapped and
thereby injured. Children in particular could
accidentally press the electrical seat adjustZ
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
The seat belt should:
87
Seats
88
! To avoid damage to the seats and the seat
heating, observe the following information:
Rkeep
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
liquids from spilling on the seats. If
liquid is spilled on the seats, dry them as
soon as possible.
Rif the seat covers are damp or wet, do not
switch on the seat heating. The seat
heating should also not be used to dry
the seats.
Rclean the seat covers as recommended;
see the "Interior care" section.
Rdo not transport heavy loads on the
seats. Do not place sharp objects on the
seat cushions, e.g. knives, nails or tools.
The seats should only be occupied by
passengers, if possible.
Rwhen the seat heating is in operation, do
not cover the seats with insulating materials, e.g. blankets, coats, bags, seat covers, child seats or booster seats.
Adjusting the seats manually
! Make sure that there are no objects in the
footwell under or behind the seats when
moving the seats back. There is a risk that
the seats and/or the objects could be damaged.
i The head restraints in the front and rear
seats can be removed.1
For more information, contact a qualified
specialist workshop.
i Further related subjects:
Rcargo
compartment enlargement (folding down the rear seats) (Y page 230)
1
Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
Lift handle : and slide the seat forwards
or backwards.
X Release lever : again.
Make sure that you hear the seat engage in
position.
X
Backrest angle
X
X
Relieve the pressure on the backrest.
Turn handwheel ? forwards or backwards.
Seat height
X
Pull handle = upwards or push it down
repeatedly until the seat has reached the
desired height.
Seat cushion angle
Adjust the angle so that your thighs are lightly
supported.
X Turn handwheel ; forwards or backwards.
Not on vehicles with sports seats or electrically adjustable head restraints.
Seats
Adjusting the seats electrically
89
restraint supports the back of the head at
about eye level.
Adjusting the head restraints manually
: Head restraint height2
; Seat cushion angle
= Seat height
? Seat fore-and-aft adjustment
A Backrest angle
i You can store the seat settings using the
memory function (Y page 95).
Adjusting the head restraints
G WARNING
You could lose control of your vehicle if you do
the following while driving:
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X To lower: press release catch : in the
direction of the arrow and push the head
restraint down to the desired position.
X
Adjusting the fore/aft position of the
head restraint
Radjust
the driver's seat, head restraint,
steering wheel or mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirror and fasten your seat belt
before starting the engine.
G WARNING
If head restraints are not installed and adjusted correctly, they cannot provide protection
as intended. There is an increased risk of
injury in the head and neck area, e.g. in the
event of an accident or when braking.
Always drive with the head restraints installed. Before driving off, make sure for every
vehicle occupant that the center of the head
2
This function is only available on vehicles with electrically adjustable head restraints.
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Adjusting the head restraint height
Seats
90
With this function you can adjust the distance
between the head restraint and the back of
the seat occupant's head.
To adjust forwards: pull the head restraint
forwards in the direction of the arrow until
it engages.
There are several notches.
X To move backwards: press and hold
release button : and push the head
restraint backwards.
X When the head restraint is in the desired
position, release the button and make sure
that the head restraint is engaged in position.
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
X
Adjusting the height of the head
restraints electrically
X
To adjust the head restraint height: slide
the switch for head restraint adjustment
(Y page 89) up or down in the direction of
the arrow .
Removing and installing the rear seat
head restraints
G WARNING
If head restraints are not installed and adjusted correctly, they cannot provide protection
as intended. There is an increased risk of
injury in the head and neck area, e.g. in the
event of an accident or when braking.
Always drive with the head restraints installed. Before driving off, make sure for every
vehicle occupant that the center of the head
restraint supports the back of the head at
about eye level.
i Electrically adjustable head restraints
cannot be removed and re-installed.
The rear head restraints on the outer seats
can be removed and re-installed.
Rear seat head restraints
Adjusting the rear seat head restraint
height
Fold the seat backrest slightly forwards in
order to remove the head restraint
(Y page 231).
X To remove: pull the head restraint up to
the stop.
X Press release catch : and pull the head
restraint out of the guides.
X To re-install: insert the head restraint so
that the notches on the bar are on the left
when viewed in the direction of travel.
X Push the head restraint down until you hear
it engage in position.
X
X
To raise: pull the head restraint up to the
desired position.
X
To lower: press release catch : and push
the head restraint down until it is in the
desired position.
Adjusting the 4-way lumbar support
You can adjust the contour of the front seat
backrests individually to provide optimum
support for your back.
The three red indicator lamps in the button
indicate the heating level you have selected.
The system automatically switches from level
3 to level 2 after approximately
eight minutes.
The system automatically switches from level
2 to level 1 after approximately ten minutes.
The system automatically switches off
approximately 20 minutes after it is set to
level 1.
Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 127).
X To switch on: press button : repeatedly
until the desired heating level is set.
X To switch off: press button : repeatedly
until all the indicator lamps go out.
X
:
;
=
?
To raise the backrest contour
To soften the backrest contour
To lower the backrest contour
To harden the backrest contour
i If the battery voltage is too low, the seat
heating may switch off.
Switching the seat heating on/off
Activating/deactivating
G WARNING
Repeatedly switching on the seat heating can
cause the seat cushion and backrest pads to
become very hot. The health of persons with
limited temperature sensitivity or a limited
ability to react to excessively high temperatures may be affected or they may even suffer
burn-like injuries. There is a risk of injury.
Therefore, do not switch the seat heating on
repeatedly.
Z
91
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Seats
92
Steering wheel
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Problems with the seat heating
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The seat heating has
switched off prematurely or cannot be
switched on.
The on-board voltage is too low because too many electrical consumers are switched on.
X Switch off electrical consumers that you do not need, such as
the rear window defroster or interior lighting.
Once the battery is sufficiently charged, the seat heating will
switch back on automatically.
Steering wheel
Important safety notes
Before starting off, make sure the steering
wheel is locked. Never unlock the steering
wheel while the vehicle is in motion.
G WARNING
You could lose control of your vehicle if you do
the following while driving:
Radjust
the driver's seat, head restraint,
steering wheel or mirrors
Rfasten the seat belt
There is a risk of an accident.
Adjust the driver's seat, head restraint, steering wheel and mirror and fasten your seat belt
before starting the engine.
G WARNING
Children could injure themselves if they
adjust the steering wheel. There is a risk of
injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.
Adjusting the steering wheel
G WARNING
If the steering wheel is unlocked while the
vehicle is in motion, it could change position
unexpectedly. This could cause you to lose
control of the vehicle. There is a risk of an
accident.
: Release lever
; To adjust the steering wheel height
= To adjust the steering wheel position
(fore-and-aft adjustment)
Push release lever : down completely.
The steering column is unlocked.
X Adjust the steering wheel to the desired
position.
X Push release lever : up completely.
The steering column is locked.
X Check if the steering column is locked.
When doing so, try to push the steering
wheel up or down or try to move it in the
fore-and-aft direction.
X
Mirrors
Rear-view mirror
X
Anti-glare mode: flick anti-glare lever :
forwards or back.
Exterior mirrors
Adjusting the exterior mirrors
G WARNING
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side reduces the size of the image. Visible
objects are actually closer than they appear.
This means that you could misjudge the distance from road users traveling behind, e.g.
when changing lane. There is a risk of an accident.
For this reason, always make sure of the
actual distance from the road users traveling
behind by glancing over your shoulder.
Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Press button : for the left-hand exterior
mirror or button ; for the right-hand exterior mirror.
The indicator lamp in the corresponding
button lights up in red.
The indicator lamp goes out again after
some time. You can adjust the selected
mirror using adjustment button = as long
as the indicator lamp is lit.
X Press adjustment button = up, down, or to
the left or right until you have adjusted the
exterior mirror to the correct position. You
should have a good overview of traffic conditions.
X
The convex exterior mirrors provide a larger
field of vision.
The exterior mirrors are automatically heated
after starting the vehicle if the rear window
defroster is switched on and the outside temperature is low. Heating takes a maximum of
10 minutes.
i You can also heat up the exterior mirrors
manually by switching on the rear window
defroster.
Exterior mirror pushed out of position
If an exterior mirror has been pushed out of
position, proceed as follows:
X
Move the exterior mirror into the correct
position manually.
The mirror housing is engaged again and
you can adjust the exterior mirrors as usual
(Y page 93).
Automatic anti-glare mirrors
The rear-view mirror and the exterior mirror
on the driver's side automatically go into antiglare mode if:
Rthe
ignition is switched on and
light from headlamps strikes the
sensor in the rear-view mirror.
Rincident
Z
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Mirrors
93
Mirrors
94
The mirrors do not go into anti-glare mode if
reverse gear is engaged or the interior lighting
is switched on.
Parking position for the exterior mirror on the front-passenger side
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
General notes
The "Parking position for the exterior mirror
on the front-passenger side" function is only
available if the vehicle is equipped with the
"Memory package".
Setting and storing the parking position
Using reverse gear
You can position the front-passenger side
exterior mirror in such a way that you can see
the rear wheel on that side as soon as you
engage reverse gear. You can store this position.
i If you shift the transmission to another
position, the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side returns to the driving position.
Using the memory button
You can position the front-passenger side
exterior mirror in such a way that you can see
the rear wheel on that side as soon as you
engage reverse gear. You can store this position. This setting can be stored using memory
button M ?.
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror. You should see the rear
wheel and the curb in the exterior mirror.
X Press memory button M ? and one of the
arrows on adjustment button = within
three seconds.
The parking position is stored if the exterior
mirror does not move.
X If the mirror moves out of position, repeat
the steps.
X
X
Calling up a stored parking position setting
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Adjust the exterior mirror on the frontpassenger side with the corresponding button (Y page 93).
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the stored parking position.
X
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Press button ; for the exterior mirror on
the front-passenger side.
X Engage reverse gear.
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves to the preset parking position.
X Use adjustment button = to adjust the
exterior mirror. You should see the rear
wheel and the curb in the exterior mirror.
The parking position is stored.
X
X
The exterior mirror on the front-passenger
side moves back to its original position:
Ras
soon as you exceed a speed of 9 mph
(15 km/h)
Rabout ten seconds after you have disengaged reverse gear
Rif you press button : for the exterior mirror on the driver's side
Memory functions
With the memory function, you can store up
to three different settings, e.g. for three different people.
The following settings are stored as a single
memory preset:
Rposition of the seat, backrest and head
restraint
Rdriver's side: position of the exterior mirrors on the driver's and front-passenger
sides
Storing settings
G WARNING
If you use the memory function on the driver's
side while driving, you could lose control of
the vehicle as a result of the adjustments
being made. There is a risk of an accident.
Only use the memory function on the driver's
side when the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
When the memory function adjusts the seat,
you and other vehicle occupants – particularly
children – could become trapped. There is a
risk of injury.
While the memory function is making adjustments, make sure that no one has any body
parts in the sweep of the seat. If somebody
becomes trapped, immediately release the
memory function position button. The adjustment process is stopped.
G WARNING
Children could become trapped if they activate the memory function, particularly when
unattended. There is a risk of injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.
Adjust the seat (Y page 89).
Adjust the exterior mirror on the driver's
side (Y page 93).
X Briefly press the M memory button and
then press storage position button 1, 2 or 3
within three seconds.
The settings are stored in the selected preset position, and a confirmation tone
sounds.
X
X
Calling up a stored setting
X
Press and hold the relevant storage position button 1, 2 or 3 until the seat and
exterior mirrors are in the stored position.
i The setting procedure is interrupted as
soon as you release the storage position
button.
The memory function can be used at any time,
e.g. even when the SmartKey isn't in the ignition lock.
Z
95
Seats, steering wheel and mirrors
Memory functions
96
97
Useful information .............................. 98
Exterior lighting .................................. 98
Interior lighting ................................. 101
Replacing bulbs ................................. 102
Lights and windshield wipers
Windshield wipers ............................ 108
98
Exterior lighting
Useful information
i This Operator's Manual describes all
Light switch
Operation
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
Lights and windshield wipers
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Exterior lighting
General notes
For reasons of safety, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you drive with the lights switched
on even during the daytime. In some countries, operation of the headlamps varies due
to legal requirements and self-imposed obligations.
1 W Left-hand standing lamps
2 X Right-hand standing lamps
3 T Parking lamps, license plate and
instrument cluster lighting
4 Ã Automatic headlamp mode, control-
led by the light sensor
5L Low-beam/high-beam headlamps
B R Rear fog lamp
If you hear a warning tone when you leave the
vehicle, the lights may still be switched on.
X
Turn the light switch to Ã.
Setting options
The exterior lighting (except the parking/
standing lamps) switches off automatically if
you:
Exterior lighting can be set using:
Rremove the SmartKey from the ignition lock
Rthe
Ropen the driver's door with the SmartKey in
Setting the exterior lighting
light switch
Rthe combination switch (Y page 100)
Rthe on-board computer (Y page 187)
position 0 in the ignition lock.
Automatic headlamp mode
G WARNING
When the light switch is set to Ã, the lowbeam headlamps may not be switched on
automatically if there is fog, snow or other
causes of poor visibility due to the weather
conditions such as spray. There is a risk of an
accident.
In such situations, turn the light switch to
L.
Exterior lighting
The daytime running lamps improve the visibility of your vehicle during the day. The daytime running lamps function is required by law
in Canada.
When the drive system is switched on and the
vehicle is stationary: if you move the DIRECT
SELECT lever to position P, the daytime running lamps/low-beam headlamps go out after
3 minutes.
When the drive system is switched on, the
vehicle is stationary and in high ambient light
brightness: if you turn the light switch
to T, you turn on the daytime running
lamps and parking lamps.
If the drive system is switched on and you turn
the light switch to L, the manual settings
take precedence over the daytime running
lamps.
Low-beam headlamps
When the ignition is switched on and the light
switch is in position L, the parking lamps
and low-beam headlamps are switched on.
This is the case even if the light sensor does
not detect it is dark. This is a particularly useful function in the event of rain and fog.
X To switch on the low-beam headlamps:
turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to
position 2 or switch on the ignition.
X Turn the light switch to L.
The green L indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Rear fog lamp
The rear fog lamp improves visibility of your
vehicle for the traffic behind in the event of
thick fog. Please take note of the countryspecific regulations for the use of rear fog
lamps.
X To switch on the rear fog lamp: turn the
SmartKey in the ignition lock to position 2
or switch on the ignition.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster lights up.
X To switch off the rear fog lamp: press the
R button.
The yellow R indicator lamp in the
instrument cluster goes out.
i For vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlamps or
the Intelligent Light System, if the rear fog
lamp is switched on, the lower 15 LEDs of
the brake lamp in the tail lamp switch off.
For right-wheel drive vehicles they only
switch off in the left-hand tail lamp, and for
left-wheel drive vehicles only in the righthand tail lamp. This is due to a legal requirement.
Parking lamps
! If the battery has been excessively discharged, the parking lamps or standing
lamps are automatically switched off to
enable the next engine start. Always park
your vehicle safely and sufficiently lit
according to legal standards. Avoid the
continuous use of the T parking lamps
for several hours. If possible, switch on the
X right or the W left standing lamp.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
The automatic headlamp feature is only an
aid. The driver is responsible for the vehicle's
lighting at all times.
à is the favored light switch setting. The
light setting is automatically selected according to the brightness of the ambient light
(exception: poor visibility due to weather conditions such as fog, snow or spray):
RSmartKey in position 1 in the ignition lock:
the parking lamps are switched on or off
automatically depending on the brightness
of the ambient light
RWith the ignition on: if you have switched on
the daytime running lamps function in the
on-board computer, the daytime running
lamps or the parking lamps and low-beam
headlamps are switched on or off automatically depending on the brightness of the
ambient light.
X To switch on automatic headlamp
mode: turn the light switch to Ã.
99
Exterior lighting
100
Lights and windshield wipers
X
To switch on: turn the light switch to T.
The green T indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up.
Standing lamps
Switching on the standing lamps ensures the
corresponding side of the vehicle is illuminated.
X To switch on the standing lamps: the
SmartKey should not be in the ignition lock
or it should be in position 0.
X Turn the light switch to W (left-hand side
of the vehicle) or X (right-hand side of
the vehicle).
Combination switch
Turn signal
High-beam headlamps
To switch on the high-beam headlamps:
turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to
position 2 or switch on the ignition.
X Turn the light switch to L or Ã.
X Press the combination switch beyond the
pressure point in the direction of arrow :.
In the à position, the high-beam headlamps are only switched on when it is dark
and the ignition is on.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster lights up when the high-beam
headlamps are switched on.
X To switch off the high-beam headlamps: move the combination switch back
to its normal position.
The blue K indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
High-beam flasher
To switch on: turn the SmartKey in the
ignition lock to position 1 or 2, or switch on
the ignition.
X Pull the combination switch in the direction
of arrow =.
X
Hazard warning lamps
:
;
=
?
High-beam headlamps
Turn signal, right
High-beam flasher
Turn signal, left
To indicate briefly: press the combination
switch briefly to the pressure point in the
direction of arrow ; or ?.
The corresponding turn signal flashes three
times.
X To indicate: press the combination switch
beyond the pressure point in the direction
of arrow ; or ?.
X
Interior lighting
Ran
air bag is deployed or
Rthe vehicle decelerates rapidly from a
speed of above 45 mph (70 km/h) and
comes to a standstill.
X To switch on the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
All turn signals flash. If you now switch on a
turn signal using the combination switch,
only the turn signal lamp on the corresponding side of the vehicle will flash.
X To switch off the hazard warning lamps:
press button :.
The hazard warning lamps switch off automatically if the vehicle reaches a speed of
above 6 mph (10 km/h) again after a full
brake application.
i The hazard warning lamps still operate if
the ignition is switched off.
Headlamps fogged up on the inside
The headlamps may fog up on the inside if
there is high atmospheric humidity.
Interior lighting
Overview of interior lighting
Front overhead control panel
: p To switch the left-hand front reading
lamp on/off
; c To switch the front interior lighting
on
= v To switch the on/off
? | To switch the front interior lighting/
automatic interior lighting control off
A p To switch the right-hand front read-
ing lamp on/off
B To switch the automatic interior lighting
control on
Switch on the lights and drive off.
The level of fogging diminishes, depending
on the length of the journey and the
weather conditions (humidity and temperature).
If the level of fogging does not diminish:
X
X
Have the headlamps checked at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Rear-compartment overhead control panel (grab
handle in the rear compartment)
: To switch the reading lamp on/off
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
The hazard warning lamps automatically
switch on if:
101
Replacing bulbs
102
Interior lighting control
Lights and windshield wipers
Important notes
The interior lighting functions are automatically deactivated after some time except for
when the SmartKey is in position 2 in the ignition lock. This prevents your vehicle's starter
battery from discharging.
The brightness of the ambient lighting may be
set using the on-board computer
(Y page 188). If the interior lighting control is
switched off, the ambient lighting is also
switched off.
Automatic interior lighting control
X
X
To switch on: move the switch to center
position B.
To switch off: move the switch to the |
position.
The interior lighting automatically switches
on if you:
Runlock
the vehicle
a door
Rremove the SmartKey from the ignition lock
The interior light is activated for a short while
when the SmartKey is removed from the ignition lock. You can activate this delayed
switch-off using the on-board computer
(Y page 188).
Ropen
Manual interior lighting control
To switch the front interior lighting on:
set the switch to the c position.
X To switch off the interior lighting: set the
switch to the | position or (if the door is
closed) to the center position.
X To switch the on/off: press the u button.
X To switch the reading lamps on/off:
press the p button.
X
Crash-responsive emergency lighting
The interior lighting is activated automatically
if the vehicle is involved in an accident.
X To switch off the crash-responsive
emergency lighting: press the hazard
warning lamp button.
or
X Lock and then unlock the vehicle using the
SmartKey.
Replacing bulbs
Important safety notes
Xenon bulbs
G DANGER
Xenon bulbs carry a high voltage. You can get
an electric shock if you remove the cover of
the Xenon bulb and touch the electrical contacts. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Never touch the parts or the electrical contacts of the Xenon bulb. Always have work on
the Xenon bulbs carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
You can recognize whether your vehicle is
equipped with Xenon bulbs by the following:
the cone of light from the Xenon bulbs moves
from the top to the bottom and back again
when you start the drive system. Before starting the drive system, you must first switch on
the lights.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Other bulbs
G WARNING
Bulbs, lamps and connectors can get very hot
when operating. If you change a bulb, you
could burn yourself on these components.
There is a risk of injury.
Replacing bulbs
103
Allow these components to cool down before
changing a bulb.
Do not use a bulb that has been dropped or if
its glass tube has been scratched.
The bulb may explode if:
Ryou
touch it
is hot
Ryou drop it
Ryou scratch it
Only operate bulbs in enclosed lamps
designed for that purpose. Only install spare
bulbs of the same type and the specified voltage.
Marks on the glass tube reduce the service
life of the bulbs. Do not touch the glass tube
with your bare hands. If necessary, clean the
glass tube when cold with alcohol or spirit and
rub it off with a lint-free cloth.
Protect bulbs from moisture during operation. Do not allow bulbs to come into contact
with liquids.
There are bulbs other than the Xenon bulbs
that you cannot replace. Replace only the
bulbs listed (Y page 103). Have the bulbs that
you cannot replace yourself changed at a
qualified specialist workshop.
If you require assistance changing bulbs, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
If the new bulb still does not light up, consult
a qualified specialist workshop.
Bulbs and lamps are an important aspect of
vehicle safety. You must therefore make sure
that these function correctly at all times.
Have the headlamp setting checked regularly.
Vehicles with halogen headlamps
: Turn signal lamp: 3457
; High-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
= Parking lamp/standing lamp: W 5 W LL
? Low-beam headlamp: H7 55 W
Vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlamps
: Cornering lamp: H7 55 W
Overview: changing bulbs/bulb types
You can replace the following bulbs. The bulb
type can be found in the legend.
Tail lamps (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
: Tail lamp/turn signal lamp/brake lamp:
P 21 W
; Inoperative
= Side marker lamp: P 21 W
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
Rit
104
Replacing bulbs
? Rear fog lamp: P 21 W
A Backup lamp: W 16 W
To remove: switch off the lights.
Turn the front wheels inwards.
X Slide cover : upwards.
Cover : is released.
X Unclip cover :.
X To install: clip in cover :.
X Push cover : down.
Cover : is locked.
Lights and windshield wipers
X
X
Tail lamps (vehicles with Bi-Xenon headlamps)
: Turn signal lamp/brake lamp: P 21 W
; Rear fog lamp: H 21 W
= Backup lamp: W 16 W
Low-beam headlamps (halogen headlamps)
License plate lamp (vehicles with halogen headlamps)
: License plate lamp: C 5 W
Changing the front bulbs
Removing and installing the cover in the
front wheel housing
You must remove the cover from the front
wheel housing before you can change the
front bulbs.
Remove the cover in the front wheel housing (Y page 104).
X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise
and remove it.
X Turn bulb holder ; counter-clockwise and
pull out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; and turn it clockwise.
X
Replacing bulbs
High-beam headlamps/daytime running lamps (halogen headlamps)
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood.
X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise
and remove it.
X Pull out bulb holder ;.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ;.
X Press on housing cover : and turn it to the
right.
X
X
Turn signals (halogen headlamps)
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood.
X Turn housing cover : counter-clockwise
and remove it.
X Turn bulb holder ; counter-clockwise and
pull out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder ;.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder ;.
X Insert bulb holder ; and turn it clockwise.
X Press on housing cover : and turn it to the
right.
X Replace the cover in the front wheel housing (Y page 104).
X
X
Parking lamps/standing lamps (halogen headlamps)
Switch off the lights.
Open the hood.
X Turn bulb holder : counter-clockwise and
pull out.
X Take the bulb out of bulb holder :.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder :.
X Insert bulb holder : and turn it clockwise
until it engages.
X
X
Changing the rear bulbs
Opening and closing the side trim panels
You must open the side trim panel in the
cargo compartment before you can change
the bulbs in the tail lamps.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
Press on housing cover : and turn it to the
right.
X Replace the cover in the front wheel housing (Y page 104).
X
105
Replacing bulbs
106
Lights and windshield wipers
Left-hand side trim panel
X
Press retaining lugs : simultaneously in
the direction of the arrow and pull the bulb
holder out.
Right-hand side trim panel
To open: turn release knob : 90° in the
direction of the arrow and remove side trim
panel ;.
X To close: insert side trim panel ; and turn
release knob : 90° in the opposite direction to the arrow.
X
Tail lamps
Turn signal/tail and brake lamps
X Switch off the lights.
X Open the cargo compartment.
X Open the side trim panel (Y page 105).
3
Vehicles with LEDs: turn signal/brake lamps only
Bulb holder
: Turn signal/tail/brake lamps3.
; Unused bulbs (vehicles without LEDs)
= Side marker lamp (vehicles without LEDs)
Lightly press the corresponding bulb into
the holder, turn it counter-clockwise and
remove it from the bulb holder.
X Insert the corresponding new bulb into the
bulb holder, press gently and turn it clockwise.
X Attach the bulb holder and press firmly.
The retaining lugs on the bulb holder
engage audibly.
X Close the side trim panel (Y page 105).
X
Replacing bulbs
107
Backup lamp and rear fog lamp
Due to their location, have the bulbs in the
backup lamp and rear fog lamp in the tailgate
changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Switch off the lights.
Open the tailgate.
X Insert a screwdriver, for example, into
recess ? on the inside.
X Pry off and remove the upper section of
handle =.
X Pull the lower section of handle : using a
sharp, sudden movement to remove it from
the trim and then place it to one side.
X
X
Remove bulb holder E using both sides of
lever F.
Bulb holder
Reach under the right-hand side of trim B.
Apply a gentle jolting force along the entire
length of the trim in order to unclip it.
X Pull out connector C of the surround lighting by releasing the latches.
X Place trim B to one side.
X
X
X
Unclip part of trim D from the assembly
using a sudden, sharp movement, until bulb
holder E is accessible.
Rear fog lamp G: press the bulb gently
into holder E, turn it counter-clockwise
and remove it from bulb holder E.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder E and
turn it clockwise.
X Backup lamp H: remove the bulb from
bulb holder E.
X Insert the new bulb into bulb holder E.
X Re-insert bulb holder E until you hear
engage audibly.
X Position trim D and engage it in place by
tapping it with your hand.
X Before beginning the installation, check
that all the metal clips are inserted in the
parts placed to one side: 2 clips ; in the
upper part of handle = and 5 clips A in
trim B.
X
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
X
Windshield wipers
108
If not, remove the missing metal clips from
the metal openings in the tailgate and
insert them in the appropriate places.
X Take trim B and connect plug connector
C to the surround lighting.
X
i The surround lighting only illuminates
when the tailgate has been shut and reopened.
Position trim B and engage it in place by
tapping it with your hand, starting from the
outside.
X Clip in the lower section of handle : again.
X Insert and engage the upper section of handle = into lower section :.
Lights and windshield wipers
X
Combination switch
1 $ Windshield wiper off
2 Ä Intermittent wipe, low (rain sensor
set to low sensitivity)
3 Å Intermittent wipe, high (rain sensor
set to high sensitivity)
Windshield wipers
Switching the windshield wipers
on/off
! Do not operate the windshield wipers
when the windshield is dry, as this could
damage the wiper blades. Moreover, dust
that has collected on the windshield can
scratch the glass if wiping takes place when
the windshield is dry.
If it is necessary to switch on the windshield
wipers in dry weather conditions, always
use washer fluid when operating the windshield wipers.
! If the windshield wipers leave smears on
the windshield after the vehicle has been
washed in an automatic car wash, wax or
other residues may be the reason for this.
Clean the windshield using washer fluid
after washing the vehicle in an automatic
car wash.
4 ° Continuous wipe, slow
5 ¯ Continuous wipe, fast
B í Single wipe/î To wipe the wind-
shield using washer fluid
X
X
Switch on the ignition.
Turn the combination switch to the corresponding position.
! Vehicles with a rain sensor: if the wind-
shield becomes dirty in dry weather conditions, the windshield wipers may be activated inadvertently. This could then damage
the windshield wiper blades or scratch the
windshield.
For this reason, you should always switch
off the windshield wipers in dry weather.
Vehicles with a rain sensor: in the Ä or
Å position, the appropriate wiping frequency is automatically set according to the
intensity of the rain. In the Å position, the
rain sensor is more sensitive than in the Ä
position, causing the windshield wiper to wipe
more frequently.
If the wiper blades are worn, the windshield
will no longer be wiped properly. This could
prevent you from observing the traffic conditions.
Windshield wipers
4 0 To switch off intermittent wiping
5 ô To wipe with washer fluid
Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Turn switch : on the combination switch
to the corresponding position.
When the rear window wiper is switched on,
the icon appears in the instrument cluster.
X
Changing the windshield wiper blades
Removing the wiper blades
Remove the SmartKey from the ignition
lock.
X Fold the wiper arm away from the windshield.
X
Replacing the wiper blades
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the windshield wipers begin to move while
you are changing the wiper blades, you could
be trapped by the wiper arm. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windshield wipers and
ignition before changing the wiper blades.
Press both release clips ;.
Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = away from wiper arm ?.
X Remove wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow A.
X
X
! To avoid damaging the wiper blades,
make sure that you touch only the wiper
arm of the wiper.
! Never open the hood/tailgate if a wiper
arm has been folded away from the windshield/rear window.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
Never fold a windshield wiper arm without a
wiper blade back onto the windshield/rear
window.
Hold the windshield wiper arm firmly when
you change the wiper blade. If you release
the wiper arm without a wiper blade and it
falls onto the windshield/rear window, the
windshield/rear window may be damaged
by the force of the impact.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you have
the wiper blades changed at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Switching the rear window wiper on/
off
Combination switch
: è Switch
2 ô To wipe with washer fluid
3 I To switch on intermittent wiping
109
Windshield wipers
110
Installing the wiper blades
Hold wiper arm : and press wiper
blade ; in the direction of the arrow until
it releases.
X Remove wiper blade ;.
X
Installing a wiper blade
Place new wiper blade ; onto wiper
arm :.
X Hold wiper arm : and press wiper
blade ; in the opposite direction to the
arrow until it engages.
X Make sure that wiper blade ; is seated
correctly.
X Position wiper blade ; parallel to wiper
arm :.
X Fold wiper arm : back onto the rear window.
Lights and windshield wipers
X
Position new wiper blade : with recess B
on lug A.
X Fold wiper blade : in the direction of
arrow = onto the wiper arm, until retaining
clips ; engage in bracket ?.
X Make sure that wiper blade : is seated
correctly.
X Fold the wiper arm back onto the windshield.
X
Replacing the rear window wiper blade
Removing a wiper blade
Remove the SmartKey from the ignition
lock.
X Fold wiper arm : away from the rear window until it engages.
X Position wiper blade ; at a right angle to
wiper arm :.
X
Windshield wipers
111
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The windshield wipers
are jammed.
Leaves or snow, for example, may be obstructing the windshield
wiper movement. The wiper motor has been deactivated.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the SmartKey from the
ignition lock.
X Remove the cause of the obstruction.
X Switch the windshield wipers back on.
The windshield wipers
fail completely.
The windshield wiper drive is malfunctioning.
Select another wiper speed on the combination switch.
X Have the windshield wipers checked at a qualified specialist
workshop.
The windshield washer
fluid from the spray
nozzles no longer hits
the center of the windshield.
The spray nozzles are misaligned.
X Have the spray nozzles adjusted at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
The spray nozzles are dirty.
X For safety reasons, you should remove the SmartKey from the
ignition lock.
X Clean the spray nozzles.
Z
Lights and windshield wipers
Problems with the windshield wipers
112
113
Useful information ............................ 114
Overview of climate control systems ................................................... 114
Operating the climate control systems ................................................... 116
Climate control
Setting the air vents ......................... 123
114
Overview of climate control systems
Useful information
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified special-
Climate control
ist workshops: (Y page 24).
Overview of climate control systems
General notes
Observe the settings recommended on the
following pages. The windows could otherwise fog up.
To prevent the windows from fogging up:
Rswitch
Rswitch
briefly
off climate control only briefly
on air-recirculation mode only
Rswitch
on the cooling with air dehumidification function
Rswitch on the defrost windshield function
briefly, if required
Dual-zone automatic climate control dehumidifies the air and regulates the temperature
in the vehicle interior and filters undesirable
substances out of the air.
Optimum operation is only achieved with the
side windows closed.
i Ventilate the vehicle for a brief period
during warm weather, e.g. using the convenience opening feature (Y page 82). This
will speed up the cooling process and the
desired vehicle interior temperature will be
reached more quickly.
i The integrated filter filters out most par-
ticles of dust and soot and completely filters out pollen. It also reduces gaseous pol-
lutants and odors. A clogged filter reduces
the amount of air supplied to the vehicle
interior. For this reason, you should always
observe the interval for replacing the filter,
which is specified in the Maintenance
Booklet. As it depends on environmental
conditions, e.g. heavy air pollution, the
interval may be shorter than stated in the
Maintenance Booklet.
i It is possible that the dehumidification
function of the climate control system may
be activated automatically an hour after the
SmartKey has been removed. The vehicle is
then ventilated for 30 minutes.
Overview of climate control systems
115
:
;
=
?
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
I
J
To set the temperature, left (Y page 117)
To set climate control to automatic (Y page 117)
To defrost the windshield (Y page 118)
To increase the airflow (Y page 118)
To set the air distribution (Y page 117)
Display
To activate/deactivate air-recirculation mode (Y page 120)
To switch climate control on/off (Y page 116)
To set the temperature, right (Y page 117)
To activate/deactivate maximum cooling (Y page 119)
To switch cooling with air dehumidification on/off (Y page 116)
To reduce the airflow (Y page 118)
To switch the rear window defroster on/off (Y page 119)
To switch the ZONE function on/off (Y page 118)
Optimum use of dual-zone automatic
climate control
Automatic climate control
The following contains instructions and recommendations to enable you to get the most
out of your automatic climate control.
RActivate climate control using the à and
¿ buttons. The indicator lamps in the
à and ¿ buttons light up.
RSet the temperature to 72 ‡ (22 †).
ROnly
use the "Windshield defrosting" function briefly until the windshield is clear
again.
ROnly use air-recirculation mode briefly, e.g.
if there are unpleasant outside odors or
when in a tunnel. The windows could otherwise fog up, since no fresh air is drawn
into the vehicle in air-recirculation mode.
RUse the ZONE function to adopt the temperature settings on the driver's side for
the front-passenger side as well. The indicator lamp in the á button goes out.
Climate control
Control panel for dual-zone automatic climate control
Operating the climate control systems
116
Operating the climate control systems
Switching climate control on/off
General notes
When the climate control is switched off, the
air supply and air circulation are also
switched off. The windows could fog up.
Therefore, switch off climate control only
briefly
Dual-zone automatic climate control
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X To switch on: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
or
X Press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button goes
out. The previously selected settings are
restored.
X To switch off: press the ^ button.
The indicator lamp in the ^ button lights
up.
Climate control
X
i Dual-zone automatic climate control:
switch on climate control primarily using
the à button.
Activating/deactivating cooling with
air dehumidification
General notes
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can fog up more quickly. Therefore, only
deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function briefly.
The "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function is operational when the vehicle is ready
to drive. The air inside the vehicle is cooled
and dehumidified according to the temperature selected.
Condensation may drip from the underside of
the vehicle when it is in cooling mode. This is
normal and not a sign that there is a malfunction.
Activating/deactivating
To activate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button lights
up.
X To deactivate: press the ¿ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¿ button goes
out. The "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function has a delayed switch-off feature.
X
Operating the climate control systems
117
Problems with the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The indicator lamp in
Cooling with air dehumidification has been deactivated due to a
the ¿ button
malfunction.
flashes three times or X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
remains off. The "Cooling with air dehumidification" function cannot
be switched on.
General notes
In automatic mode, the set temperature is
maintained automatically at a constant level.
The system automatically regulates the temperature of the dispensed air, the airflow and
the air distribution.
The automatic mode functions optimally
when the "Cooling with air dehumidification"
function is activated. If necessary, cooling
with air dehumidification can be deactivated.
If you deactivate the "Cooling with air-dehumidification" function, the air inside the vehicle will not be cooled. The air inside the vehicle will also not be dehumidified. The windows can fog up more quickly. Only switch
the cooling with air dehumidification function
off for short periods.
Setting climate control to automatic
Turn the key to position 3 in the ignition
lock.
The READY indicator is displayed.
X Set the desired temperature.
X To activate: press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the à button lights
up. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are activated.
X
X
To switch to manual mode: press the
É or Ë button.
or
X
Press the K or I button.
The indicator lamp in the à button goes
out. Automatic air distribution and airflow
are deactivated.
Setting the temperature
Dual-zone automatic climate control
Different temperatures can be set for the
driver's and front-passenger sides.
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X To increase/reduce: turn thumbwheel :
or E counter-clockwise or clockwise
(Y page 115). Only change the temperature
setting in small increments. Start at 72 ‡
(22 †).
X
Setting the air distribution
Dual-zone automatic climate control
Air distribution settings
¯ Directs air through the defroster vents
P Directs air through the center and side
air vents
O Directs air through the footwell air
vents
Climate control
Setting climate control to automatic
Operating the climate control systems
118
b Directs the airflow through the center
and side air vents as well as the
defroster vents
a Directs air through the defroster and
footwell vents
i Regardless of the air distribution setting,
Climate control
airflow is always directed through the side
air vents. The side air vents can only be
closed if the adjusters are turned clockwise
until they engage.
Setting the air distribution
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Press the É or Ë button repeatedly
until the desired symbol appears in the display.
Setting the airflow
Dual-zone automatic climate control
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X To increase/reduce: press the K or
I button.
X
Switching the ZONE function on/off
This function is only available with dual-zone
automatic climate control.
X To activate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button lights
up.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is not adopted for the front-passenger
side.
X
To deactivate: press the á button.
The indicator lamp in the á button goes
out.
The temperature setting for the driver's
side is adopted for the front-passenger
side.
Defrosting the windshield
You can use this function to defrost the windshield or to defrost the inside of the windshield and the side windows.
i The windshield heating is switched on
using the "Windshield defrosting" function.
i Only use the "Windshield defrosting"
function briefly until the windshield is clear
again.
Turn the SmartKey to position 3 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
The READY indicator is displayed.
X To activate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button lights
up.
The climate control system switches to the
following functions:
X
Rhigh
airflow
temperature
Rair distribution to the windshield and
front side windows
Rair-recirculation mode off
Rwindshield heating on
i The "Windshield defrosting" function
automatically sets the blower output to the
optimum defrosting effect. As a result, the
airflow may increase or decrease automatically after the button is pressed.
Rhigh
i You can adjust the blower output manually while the "Windshield defrosting"
function is in operation:
X Press the ó or ô button.
X
To deactivate: press the ¬ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. The previously selected settings are
restored. Air-recirculation mode remains
deactivated.
or
X
Press the à button.
The indicator lamp in the ¬ button goes
out. Airflow and air distribution are set to
automatic mode.
Operating the climate control systems
Turn temperature control : or E counterclockwise or clockwise (Y page 115).
MAX COOL maximum cooling
The MAX COOL function is only available in
vehicles for the USA.
The MAX COOL function only works when the
vehicle is ready to drive.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 3 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
The READY indicator is displayed.
X To activate: press the Ù button.
The indicator lamp in the button lights up.
X To activate: press the Ù button again.
The indicator lamp goes out. The previously
selected settings are restored.
When you activate MAX COOL, climate control switches to the following functions:
Rmaximum
cooling
airflow
Rair-recirculation mode on
Rmaximum
Defrosting the windows
Windows fogged up on the inside
Dual-zone automatic climate control
X Activate the ¿ "Cooling with air dehumidification" function.
X Activate automatic mode Ã.
X If the windows continue to fog up, activate
the ¬ "Windshield defrosting" function.
i You should only select this setting until
the windshield is clear again.
Windows fogged up on the outside
Activate the windshield wipers.
Set the air distribution to P or O.
i You should only select this setting until
the windshield is clear again.
X
X
Rear window defroster
General notes
The rear window defroster has a high current
draw. You should therefore switch it off as
soon as the rear window is clear. Otherwise,
the rear window defroster switches off automatically after several minutes.
If the battery voltage is too low, the rear window defroster may switch off.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Press the ¤ button.
The indicator lamp in the ¤ button lights
up or goes out.
X
Climate control
or
X
119
Operating the climate control systems
120
Problems with the rear window defroster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The rear window
The battery has not been sufficiently charged.
defroster has deactiva- X Switch off any consumers that are not required, e.g. reading
ted prematurely or canlamps, interior lighting or the seat heating.
not be activated.
When the battery is sufficiently charged, the rear window
defroster can be activated again.
Activating/deactivating air-recirculation mode
Climate control
General notes
You can deactivate the flow of fresh air if
unpleasant odors are entering the vehicle
from outside. The air already inside the vehicle will then be recirculated.
If you switch on air-recirculation mode, the
windows can fog up more quickly, in particular at low temperatures. Only use air-recirculation mode briefly to prevent the windows
from fogging up.
Activating/deactivating
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X To activate: press the e button.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up.
X
i Air-recirculation mode is activated automatically at high outside temperatures.
When air-recirculation mode is activated
automatically, the indicator lamp in the
e button is not lit.
Outside air is added after about
30 minutes.
X
To deactivate: press the e button.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out.
i Air-recirculation mode deactivates automatically:
Rafter approximately 5 minutes at outside
temperatures below approximately 41 ‡
(5 †)
Rafter approximately 5 minutes if the cooling with air dehumidification function is
deactivated
Rafter approximately 30 minutes at outside temperatures above approximately
41 ‡ (5 †) if the "Cooling with air dehumidification" function is activated
Convenience opening/closing using
the air-recirculation button
G WARNING
When using the convenience closing feature,
parts of the body could be trapped in the closing area when a side window is being closed.
There is a risk of injury.
Observe the complete closing procedure
when the convenience closing feature is operating. Make sure that no body parts are in
close proximity during the closing procedure.
G WARNING
During convenience opening parts of the body
could be drawn in or become trapped
between the side window and window frame.
There is a risk of injury.
Make sure that nobody touches the side window during the opening procedure. If someone becomes trapped, press the W switch
Operating the climate control systems
X
Convenience closing feature: press and
hold the e button until the side windows are closed.
The indicator lamp in the e button lights
up. Air-recirculation mode is activated.
If parts of the body are in the closing area
during convenience closing, proceed as follows:
Press the W button for opening/closing
the side windows.
The side window stops.
X To then open the side windows, press the
W button again.
or
X Press and hold the e button again for
longer than 2 seconds.
The side windows move in the opposite
direction.
i Notes on the automatic reversing feature
for the side windows (Y page 81).
X Convenience opening feature: press and
hold the e button until the side windows are opened. The side windows move
back to their original positions.
The indicator lamp in the e button goes
out. Air-recirculation mode is deactivated.
X
i If you open the side windows manually
after closing them with the convenience
closing feature, they will remain in this position when opened using the convenience
opening feature.
Pre-entry climate control via key
Before getting in, the vehicle interior can be
briefly warmed or ventilated in advance and
the air from the air vents can be pre-cooled.
The high-voltage battery must be sufficiently
charged before the pre-entry climate control
(via key) can be activated.
Activating/deactivating the pre-entry climate control (via key)
When the vehicle is unlocked using the SmartKey, the climate control functions are activated.
i You can activate pre-entry climate control
(via the SmartKey) three times in succession. The climate control function will be
deactivated after the third time. The PreEntry Climate Ctrl. (Via SmartKey)
Available Again After Engine Start
display message appears in the instrument
cluster. To activate the pre-entry climate
control again, start the drive system.
The pre-cooling climate control function runs
for up to 1 minute, the pre-heating climate
control function runs for up to 5 minutes.
When the vehicle is pre-cooled, the following
functions are activated as necessary:
RClimate
RCooling
control system
with air dehumidification
RBlower
When the vehicle is pre-heated, the following
functions are activated as necessary:
RClimate
control system
RBlower
RSeat
heating
heating
RRear window defroster
Pre-entry climate control is automatically
switched off when operational readiness
mode is requested.
Activating/deactivating pre-entry climate control (via SmartKey)
You can activate and deactivate pre-entry climate control (via SmartKey) via the on-board
computer in the E‑CELL submenu
(Y page 185).
RWindshield
i If the condition of charge of the high-voltage battery is below the specified minimum
Z
Climate control
immediately to open/close the side window
in the door. The side window stops. To continue closing the side window, pull on the
W switch.
121
122
Operating the climate control systems
condition of charge, pre-entry climate control will not be activated even if it has been
set.
Pre-entry climate control at departure
time and immediate pre-entry climate
control
Important safety notes
Climate control
G WARNING
If persons, particularly children are subjected
to prolonged exposure to extreme heat or
cold, there is a risk of injury, possibly even
fatal. Never leave children unattended in the
vehicle.
General notes
Using the "pre-entry climate control at departure time" function, you can cool or heat the
vehicle interior prior to the desired departure
time.
When using the "pre-entry climate control at
departure time" function, the condition of
charge of the high-voltage battery must be
higher than the specified minimum condition
of charge.
The running time of the climate control may
be reduced if:
Rthe
vehicle is not connected to an electric
power supply
Rthe high-voltage battery is not fully charged
In certain situations, the desired interior temperature cannot be reached.
When the vehicle is cooled, the following
functions are activated as necessary:
RClimate
control system
RCooling with air dehumidification
RBlower
When the vehicle is heated, the following
functions are activated as necessary:
RClimate
RBlower
control system
RSeat
heating
heating
RRear window defroster
"Immediate pre-entry climate control" is automatically switched off when operational readiness mode is requested.
RWindshield
Setting the departure time
You can set a departure time for the "preentry climate control at departure time". Your
vehicle will then be cooled or heated until the
desired temperature is reached in time for the
set departure time. "Pre-entry climate control
at departure time" will be activated a maximum of 50 minutes before departure. If the
departure is delayed, the vehicle will be
heated or cooled for a further 5 minutes.
You can set the desired departure time in the
E‑CELL submenu on the on-board computer
(Y page 185).
Activating immediate pre-entry climate
control
You can activate "immediate pre-entry climate control" even if the vehicle interior is
already at the desired temperature. This
means that the vehicle interior continues to
be cooled or heated, e.g. if the journey is
interrupted for up to 50 minutes, and the interior temperature is kept constant. You can
only set the desired temperature using the
climate control unit. If you do not pre-select a
temperature, the last temperature set will be
automatically adopted.
Setting the air vents
The colors of the indicator lamps in the button
have the following meanings:
123
Setting the center air vents
Red
Heating activated
Blue Cooling activated
Yellow Pre-entry climate control at departure is preselected
X
To activate/deactivate "immediate preentry climate control": press button :
on the center console (Y page 34).
The blue or red indicator lamp in the button
lights up or goes out.
To open the center air vents: turn the
adjuster in one of center air vents : counter-clockwise.
X To close the center air vents: turn the
adjuster in one of center air vents : clockwise until it engages.
Setting the air vents
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Very hot or very cold air can flow from the air
vents. This could result in burns or frostbite in
the immediate vicinity of the air vents. There
is a risk of injury.
Make sure that all vehicle occupants always
maintain a sufficient distance to the air outlets. If necessary, redirect the airflow to
another area of the vehicle interior.
Setting the side air vents
In order to ensure the direct flow of fresh air
through the air vents into the vehicle interior,
please observe the following notes:
Rkeep
the air inlet between the windshield
and the hood free of blockages, such as ice,
snow or leaves.
Rnever cover the air vents or air intake grilles
in the vehicle interior.
i You can move the adjusters for the air
vents vertically or horizontally to set the
direction of the airflow.
i For optimal climate control in the vehicle,
: Side window defroster vent
; Side air vent
To open a side air vent: turn the adjuster
in the side air vent ; to the left.
X To close a side air vent: turn the adjuster
in the side air vent ; to the right until it
engages.
X
open the air vents completely and set the
adjusters to the central position.
Z
Climate control
X
124
125
Useful information ............................ 126
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle
............................................................. 126
Transmission ..................................... 128
Charging the high-voltage battery .. 134
Parking ............................................... 144
Driving tips ........................................ 147
Driving systems ................................ 152
Driving and parking
Driving ............................................... 126
126
Driving
Useful information
Driving and parking
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Notes on breaking-in a new vehicle
Important safety notes
New and replaced brake pads and discs only
reach their optimum braking effect after several hundred kilometers of driving. Compensate for this by applying greater force to the
brake pedal.
Driving
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell can restrict the
pedal travel or obstruct a depressed pedal.
The operating and road safety of the vehicle is
jeopardized. There is a risk of an accident.
Make sure that all objects in the vehicle are
stowed correctly, and that they cannot enter
the driver's footwell. Install the floormats
securely and as specified in order to ensure
sufficient clearance for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place floormats on
top of one another.
G WARNING
Unsuitable footwear can hinder correct usage
of the pedals, e.g.:
Rshoes
with thick soles
with high heels
Rslippers
There is a risk of an accident.
Wear suitable footwear to ensure correct
usage of the pedals.
Rshoes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
If the parking brake has not been fully
released when driving, the parking brake can:
Roverheat
and cause a fire
its hold function.
There is a risk of fire and an accident. Release
the parking brake fully before driving off.
Rlose
The braking performance of the electric
motor using recuperative braking is, in some
operating modes, either reduced or not effective:
Rwhen
the condition of charge of the highvoltage battery increases
Rif the high-voltage battery is not yet at a
normal operating temperature
Rwhen driving at speeds close to zero
Rin transmission position N
Rduring and after ESP stability control.
If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake
yourself.
Driving
disconnected from the vehicle socket
before starting a journey. The vehicle or
charging cable may otherwise be damaged
when you drive off.
i Before commencing your journey, ensure
that the charging cable required for charging the high-voltage battery is in the vehicle.
SmartKey positions
Starting the engine
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen
the doors, thus endangering other
people or road users.
Rget out and disrupt traffic.
Roperate the vehicle's equipment.
Additionally, children could set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake.
Rshift the transmission out of park position P
Rstart
g To remove the SmartKey
(shift the transmission to position P)
1 Power supply for some consumers, such
as the windshield wipers
2 Ignition (power supply for all consumers)
and drive position
3 Starting the engine
i The SmartKey can be turned in the igni-
tion lock even if it is not the correct SmartKey for the vehicle. The ignition is not
switched on. The drive system cannot be
started.
the vehicle's drive system.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children or animals unattended in the
vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of
reach of children.
Vehicles with an electric motor generate
much less driving noise than vehicles with
internal combustion engines. As a result, your
vehicle may not be heard by other road users
in certain situations. This can happen, for
example, when you are parking and your vehicle is not seen by other road users. This
requires you to adopt a particularly anticipatory driving style, as it is necessary to allow
for the possibility that other road users may
behave erratically.
The vehicle is equipped with a sound generator. The sound generator is activated so that
other road users can hear your vehicle better.
The sound generator is activated at speeds of
under 20 mph (30 km/h) and switches off
automatically at higher speeds.
Starting procedure
i Do not switch the ignition on and off at
intervals of less than 3 seconds more than
15 times in succession. If it is switched on
Z
Driving and parking
! Make sure the charging cable has been
127
Transmission
128
and off more than 16 times, the ignition
must remain off for at least 20 seconds.
You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
Driving and parking
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 3
(Y page 127) in the ignition lock and release
it.
The drive system is started. The system
check display appears in the multifunction
display.
Once the system check is complete, the
Ready display appears in the lower multifunction display. The vehicle is ready to
drive.
Pulling away
The vehicle is equipped with a sound generator. At low speeds, an electric vehicle makes
less noise than a vehicle with a combustion
engine. The sound generator is activated so
that other road users can hear your vehicle
better. The sound generator is activated at
speeds of under 20 mph (30 km/h) and
switches off automatically at higher speeds.
i It is only possible to move the DIRECT
SELECT lever from position P to the desired
selector lever position if you depress the
brake pedal. Only then is the parking lock
deactivated, at which point the electrical
parking brake is released automatically. If
the brake pedal is not depressed, the
DIRECT SELECT lever can still be moved but
the parking lock remains engaged.
Depress the brake pedal and keep it
depressed.
X Move the DIRECT SELECT lever to position
D or R.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Carefully depress the accelerator pedal.
The electric parking brake is automatically
released (Y page 145).
The red F (USA only) or ! (Canada
only) indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
X
i The vehicle locks centrally once you have
pulled away. The locking knobs in the doors
drop down.
You can open the doors from the inside at
any time.
Hill start assist
Hill start assist will aid you when pulling away
on a hill. It holds the vehicle for a short time
after you have removed your foot from the
brake pedal. This gives you enough time to
move your foot from the brake pedal to the
accelerator pedal and depress it before the
vehicle begins to roll.
G WARNING
After a short time, hill start assist will no longer brake your vehicle and it could roll away.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Therefore, quickly move your foot from the
brake pedal to the accelerator pedal. Never
leave the vehicle when it is held by hill start
assist.
Take your foot off the brake pedal.
The vehicle is then held for about a second.
X Pull away.
X
Hill start assist is not active if:
Ryou are pulling away on a level road or on a
downhill gradient.
DIRECT SELECT lever is in position N.
Rthe electric parking brake is applied.
RESP® is malfunctioning.
Further information on holding the vehicle
stationary on uphill gradients (Y page 131).
Rthe
Transmission
Important safety notes
i Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to position
P when the drive system is switched off and
the vehicle is stationary. Park position P is
engaged and the electric parking brake is
applied automatically:
If the DIRECT SELECT lever cannot be
engaged in park position P, the parking
brake is engaged automatically.
Observe the "Important safety notes" section
on activating/deactivating ESP®
(Y page 183).
DIRECT SELECT lever
: Transmission position display
; Drive program display
i The arrows in the transmission position
display show how and into which transmission positions you can shift using the
DIRECT SELECT lever.
Overview of transmission positions
The DIRECT SELECT lever is on the right of the
steering column.
! If the transmission position display in the
multifunction display is not working, you
should pull away carefully to check whether
the desired transmission position is
engaged. it is advisable to select transmission position D.
Engaging park position P
i You can only engage park position P when
the vehicle is stationary.
X
j
k
i
h
Park position with parking lock
Reverse gear
Neutral
Drive
i The DIRECT SELECT lever always returns
to its original position. The current transmission position P, R, N or D appears in the
transmission position display (Y page 176)
in the multifunction display.
Transmission position display
The current transmission position and drive
program appear in the multifunction display.
Push the DIRECT SELECT lever in the direction of arrow P.
Transmission position display P is shown in
the multifunction display.
i When you have engaged park position P,
make sure that the transmission position
display shows P in the multifunction display.
i The transmission shifts into park position
P automatically if you open the driver's
door when the vehicle is stationary or when
driving at very low speed with the transmission in position D or R.
In addition, a warning tone sounds and a
display message is shown.
i Depressing the brake and pushing the
DIRECT SELECT lever up or down disengages the parking lock. The transmission is
in N neutral.
Z
129
Driving and parking
Transmission
Transmission
130
In order to shift from park position P
directly into R or D:
Rdepress
the brake pedal and
the DIRECT SELECT lever up or
down past the first point of resistance
Driving and parking
Rpush
Engaging reverse gear R
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children or animals unattended in the
vehicle. Always keep the SmartKey out of
reach of children.
RMake
sure that the ignition is switched on.
RWhen the vehicle is stationary, depress the
X
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up past the
first point of resistance.
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
to neutral N.
RRelease the brake pedal.
RIf the electric parking brake is engaged,
release it.
RSwitch off the ignition and leave the SmartKey in the ignition lock.
Shifting to neutral N
Engaging drive position D
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Push the DIRECT SELECT lever up or down
to the first point of resistance.
X
! Only shift into reverse gear R when the
vehicle is stationary. You could otherwise
damage the drive system.
X
When the drive system is switched off, the
transmission shifts to N automatically.
Remaining in neutral N
If the transmission is to remain in neutral N,
for example when washing the vehicle in an
automatic car wash with a towing mechanism, observe the following information:
RShift
When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal.
X Push the DIRECT SELECT lever down past
the first point of resistance.
Transmission positions
B
Park position
This prevents the vehicle from rolling away when stopped. Only move
the selector lever to P when the
vehicle is stationary.
The SmartKey can only be removed
when the selector lever is in position P. When there is no SmartKey
in the ignition lock, the selector
lever is locked in position P.
C
Reverse gear
Only move the selector lever to R
when the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
If children are left unsupervised in the vehicle,
they could:
Ropen
the doors, thus endangering other
people or road users.
Rget out and disrupt traffic.
Roperate the vehicle's equipment.
Additionally, children could set the vehicle in
motion if, for example, they:
Rrelease
the parking brake.
Rshift the transmission out of park position P
Rstart the vehicle's drive system.
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Transmission
7
Neutral
No power is transmitted from the
drive system to the drive wheels.
Releasing the brakes will allow you
to move the vehicle freely.
If ESP® is faulty: only move the
selector lever to N if the vehicle is
in danger of skidding, e.g. on icy
roads.
move the DIRECT SELECT lever up and down
past the point of resistance.
Program selector button
General notes
The program selector button allows you to
choose between drive programs with different driving characteristics.
Drive
For driving forwards
Driving tips
Holding the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients
Do not hold the vehicle stationary on uphill
gradients by depressing the accelerator
pedal. Instead, only ever hold the vehicle stationary on uphill gradients by:
Rdepressing
the brake pedal
Rengaging the electric parking brake
Kickdown
Use kickdown for maximum acceleration.
Depress the accelerator pedal beyond the
pressure point.
The needle in the power display points to
the boost area (Y page 173).
X Ease off the accelerator pedal once the
desired speed is reached.
i Maximum acceleration is available for a
limited time.
X
Rocking the vehicle free
Shifting the transmission repeatedly between
gears D and R may help to free the vehicle if it
has become stuck in slush or snow. The vehicle's engine management system limits the
speed to a maximum of 5 mph (9 km/h) when
shifting back and forth. To shift back and forth
between transmission positions D and R,
Program selector button
E Economy
Comfortable, economical
driving style
S Sport
Sporty driving style
X
Press program selector button :.
The selected drive program appears in the
multifunction display.
When the ignition is switched on, the driving
mode last selected becomes active.
Steering wheel paddle shifters
Manually adjustable recuperation
If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake
yourself.
You can increase or reduce recuperation in
overrun mode using the steering wheel paddle shifters. When you remove your foot from
the accelerator pedal, recuperation occurs.
The electric motor is then used as a alternator
and energy is recovered while driving. The
Z
Driving and parking
A
131
Transmission
Driving and parking
132
recuperated electrical energy is stored in the
high-voltage battery. A higher energy recuperation level means that the vehicle is
braked more powerfully.
The various recuperation levels are shown in
the transmission position display once D has
been selected (Y page 129).
The following recuperation levels are available in overrun mode:
recuperation (D+, coasting mode)
Rmoderate recuperation (D)
Rhigh recuperation (D-)
Rrecuperation depending on the traffic situation (DAUTO, radar-based)
You can see the intensity of recuperation in
overrun mode by reading the recuperation
performance value shown in the power display (Y page 173).
The transmission shifts into recuperation
level DAUTO each time the ignition is switched
on.
Rno
The various different levels are to be used
under the following conditions:
D+
Driving without much braking
and without the presence of
obstacles or sharp bends
The vehicle retains the maximum possible amount of kinetic
energy.
D
Normal driving (standard setting)
D-
Sporty driving
The brake pedal does not need
to be used as often because the
extent of the deceleration is
greater than in D.
Energy use when decelerating is
considerably higher than when
the vehicle is braked with the
brake pedal.
DAUTO
(radarbased)
The intensity of recuperation is
automatically adjusted to the
current traffic situation.
In levels D and D-, deceleration can be controlled in an infinitely variable manner using
the accelerator pedal.
The braking performance of the electric
motor using recuperative braking is, in some
operating modes, either reduced or not effective:
: Left-hand steering wheel paddle shifter ; Right-hand steering wheel paddle shifter
+
To reduce recuperation: pull right-hand
steering wheel paddle shifter ; towards
you.
X To increase recuperation: pull left-hand
steering wheel paddle shifter : towards
you.
X
Rwhen
the condition of charge of the highvoltage battery increases
Rif the high-voltage battery is not yet at a
normal operating temperature
Rwhen the vehicle is almost stationary
Rin transmission position N
Rduring and after ESP stability control
Radar-based recuperation
i Radar-based recuperation is not a dis-
tance control function and therefore can-
Transmission
The vehicle uses the sensors of COLLISION
PREVENTION ASSIST during radar-based
recuperation (DAUTO). The sensors detect the
distance to the vehicle ahead and its speed.
The intensity of recuperation is then automatically adjusted to the current traffic situation.
The range can then be increased by storing
energy efficiently. Adjustment is infinitely variable from overrun mode (no recuperation) to
maximum recuperation.
Examples of radar-based recuperation:
RApproaching a slower vehicle, a decelerating vehicle or when following a vehicle
downhill. Your vehicle decelerates slightly
and increases recuperation.
RDriving when no vehicle is detected in front
or when a vehicle is detected in the far distance or an accelerating vehicle is detected. Your vehicle switches to overrun mode
at higher speeds.
RDriving on a steep downhill slope. Acceleration downhill is reduced and recuperation
is increased. This is comparable with shifting down when driving downhill.
X To activate radar-based recuperation:
pull one steering wheel paddle shifter :
or ; towards you and hold for
about one second.
X To deactivate radar-based recuperation: briefly pull one steering wheel paddle
shifter : or ; towards you.
If you change between radar-based and manual recuperation, the following levels are activated depending on the steering wheel paddle shifter selected:
; Steering
wheel paddle
shifter +
selects D+ (overrun)
: Steering
wheel paddle
shifter -
selects D- (maximum
recuperation)
In particular, the function of the radar sensors
can be impaired in the case of:
Rthere is dirt on the sensors or anything else
covering the sensors
is snow or heavy rain
Rthere is interference by other radar sources
Rthere are strong radar reflections, for
example in parking garages
Ra narrow vehicle traveling in front, e.g. a
motorbike
Ra vehicle traveling in front on a different line
relative to the center of your vehicle
Following damage to the front end of the vehicle, have the configuration and operation of
the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop. This also applies to collisions at slow speeds where there is no visible
damage to the front of the vehicle.
Rthere
i If the radar sensor is not available, the
system switches automatically to level D
with moderate recuperation. In this case
have the radar sensor checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Automatic adjustment of recuperation
on downhill gradients
i Automatic adjustment of recuperation on
downhill gradients is available in level
DAUTO or on vehicles without steering wheel
paddle shifters in level D.
The vehicle can detect steep downhill gradients. To reduce acceleration downhill and to
Z
Driving and parking
not maintain the distance to the vehicle in
front.
Maintain a safe distance.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you activate COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST as a
visual and acoustic aid.
133
Driving and parking
134
Charging the high-voltage battery
charge the high-voltage battery, recuperation
is increased steplessly. This is comparable to
the engine brake in a combustion engine
when you downshift a gear on a downhill gradient.
Drive program
Drive program E is characterized by the following:
Rfull
power output by using kickdown.
vehicle pulling away more gently in
forward gear unless the accelerator pedal
is depressed fully.
Rreduced power on the accelerator pedal
increases sensitivity. This supports an even
and economical driving style.
Rthe wheels are less likely to spin.
Drive program S is characterized by the following:
Rthe
Rthe
entire power output can be utilized by
depressing the accelerator pedal.
Charging the high-voltage battery
Important safety notes
G DANGER
The vehicle's high voltage electrical system is
under high voltage. If you modify components
in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
or touch damaged components, you may be
electrocuted. The components in the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system may be
damaged in an accident, although the damage
is not visible. There is a risk of fatal injury.
Following an accident, do not touch any highvoltage components and never modify the
vehicle's high-voltage electrical system. Have
the vehicle towed away after an accident and
the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
checked by a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
In the event of a vehicle fire, the internal pressure of the high-voltage battery can exceed a
critical value. In this case flammable gas
escapes through a ventilation valve on the
underbody. The gas can ignite. There is a risk
of injury.
Leave the danger zone immediately. Secure
the danger area at a suitable distance, whilst
observing legal requirements.
G DANGER
If you use incorrectly installed mains sockets
or adapters, extension cables or similar to
connect the charging cable to a mains socket,
this could lead to fires or an electric shock.
There is a risk of fatal injury.
To avoid hazardous situations, observe the
following:
ROnly
connect the charging cable to mains
sockets that:
- are installed correctly and
- have been approved by an electrical specialist.
RFor safety reasons, only use the charging
cables supplied with the vehicle, or charging cables which have been approved for
use with this vehicle.
RNever use a damaged charging cable.
RDo not use:
- Extension cables
- Cable drums
- Multiple sockets
RDo not use a socket adapter to connect the
charging cable to the mains socket. The
only exception is if the adapter has been
tested and approved by the manufacturer
for charging the high-voltage battery in an
electric vehicle.
RAlways observe the safety notes in the
socket adapter's operating instructions.
The vehicle's high voltage electrical system is
under high voltage.
RDo
not handle high-voltage components or
the orange cables of the vehicle's high-voltage electrical system.
RDo not touch high-voltage components or
the orange cables of the high-voltage electrical system when a vehicle has been
involved in a crash.
RDo not touch any damaged components or
the damaged orange cables of the vehicle's
high-voltage electrical system.
RDo not remove the covers of the high-voltage electrical system components that are
marked with a warning sticker.
General notes
Method of operation
The vehicle is equipped with a high-voltage
battery for driving. The high-voltage battery
stores the energy needed to operate the electric motor and releases it again.
The electric motor uses energy that has been
stored in the high-voltage battery when pulling away, accelerating and during the journey.
In overrun mode, kinetic energy is converted
by means of energy recuperation into electrical energy and stored in the high-voltage battery.
The high-voltage battery can be charged as
follows:
Rthrough
energy recuperation while the
vehicle is in motion
Rwith the charging cable at a mains socket
while the vehicle is stationary
Rwith the charging cable at a charging station while the vehicle is stationary
The high-voltage battery can be charged in a
voltage range from 110 V to 240 V.
i If the condition of charge drops to less
than 13%, the high-voltage battery reserve
indicator lamp lights up in the instrument
cluster. Charge the high-voltage battery as
soon as possible.
Below a condition of charge of 5%, the performance of the vehicle is reduced.
The vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
switches off at a condition of charge of 0%.
i Use of the pre-entry climate control (via
key) may mean that the high-voltage battery is not fully charged.
Discharged battery
The vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
switches off if the high-voltage battery is completely discharged. 30 seconds prior to this,
you are informed of the switch-off by the
Battery level too low. Stop and
charge immediately message. This protects the battery from exhaustive discharge.
i It is not possible to restart the drive system until after charging.
Do not leave the vehicle parked for longer
than 14 days with a high-voltage battery condition of charge below 20%.
You can check the condition of charge in the
charge level display (Y page 174).
Further information on the "Energy flow display" can be found in the "Trip" menu
(Y page 176).
High and low outside temperatures
Low outside temperatures
The efficiency of the high-voltage battery is
significantly reduced at very low outside temperatures. The high-voltage battery is then no
longer able to provide the normal electrical
power output.
High outside temperatures
To prevent damage to the high-voltage battery due to very high outside temperatures,
the maximum power output of the high-voltage battery is reduced automatically.
The E-CELL display indicates the maximum
amount of power available (Y page 173).
Z
135
Driving and parking
Charging the high-voltage battery
136
Charging the high-voltage battery
Energy consumption and range
This range is reduced by:
Driving and parking
Rhigh
and low outside temperatures
use of air conditioning or heating
Rswitching on consumers
The battery's physical characteristics are
such that leaving the vehicle parked for an
extended period at low outdoor temperatures
without charging it can lead to:
Rthe
reduction in battery performance
charge times
In extreme cases, this could mean that the
vehicle cannot be started. For this reason,
connect the charging cable when leaving the
vehicle parked for long periods at low outdoor
temperatures.
As a result of its basic characteristics, the
amount of energy available from the highvoltage battery decreases over the course of
its life.
This reduces:
If you activate RANGE PLUS, the operating
window of the battery will be extended at the
next charging process. An extended driving
range will be available to you for the next
journey.
i The more often RANGE PLUS is used, the
more the extended range is reduced.
Therefore always check the range display
before every journey.
Ra
Rlonger
Rthe
maximum range that can be achieved
by the vehicle
Rthe maximum output (acceleration) of the
vehicle
You can actively reduce the energy consumption of your vehicle in a number of ways, for
example, by:
Ran
anticipatory driving style
Rreducing the use of electrical consumers
Rhaving the vehicle regularly maintained
The charging time of the high-voltage battery
may change over the course of its life.
RANGE PLUS
i Using RANGE PLUS shortens the service
life of the battery. Therefore, only use
RANGE PLUS if, for example:
Rlong journeys are planned or
Rthe availability of charging stations at the
destination is limited
To switch on: press button :.
The green Indicator lamp lights up.
X To switch off: press button :.
The indicator lamp goes out.
X
RANGE PLUS switches off automatically if:
Rthe
Rthe
charging cable is disconnected or
charging process is complete
Notes on battery care
Avoid storing or transporting the vehicle in
high temperatures over a long period (e.g.
container transport).
If you park the vehicle and leave it stationary
for longer periods, connect it to a power supply.
Temperatures below Ò13 ‡ (Ò25 †) and over
104 ‡ (40 †), which affect the vehicle for a
period of more than seven days, can cause
irreversible damage.
Charging the high-voltage battery
Observe the following notes:
Rinformation
on exceptions to the high-voltage battery terms of use in the battery
rental agreement
Rinformation on exceptions and limitations
in warranty documentation and in the related Maintenance Booklet
Rmaintenance notes for the high-voltage
battery in the Maintenance Booklet
Handling the charging cable and charging cable controls
Do not leave the charging cable controls
(Y page 138) hanging loose from an electrical
outlet. Otherwise, this could result in a poor
contact with the electrical outlet and malfunctions when charging the vehicle.
To ensure that the brackets within the charging cable controls are not subjected to incorrect loads, observe the following:
RNever lift or carry the controls by the charg-
ing cable connector or the mains plug.
RTo transport the charging cable, the coiled
part can be:
- wrapped around the controls or
- secured to the housing of the controls
Heat generated by the charging cable
and connector
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 134).
During the charging process, the charging
cable and connector may heat up.
The charging cable and connector will only
heat up within the permissible limiting values,
provided that:
Rthe
power supply and the charging cable
are not damaged
Rthe instructions for handling the charging
cable and controls on the charging cable
are observed
Should the permissible heating temperature
limits be exceeded, have the mains power
supply checked.
Protection device against overvoltage
! Overvoltage in the mains supply may
damage the vehicle. For this reason, the
vehicle is equipped with a protection device
against overvoltage in the mains supply.
This device may be triggered during severe
thunderstorms, for example, and may lead
to the building's fuse being tripped and an
interruption in the power supply. These
functions protect the vehicle. After the
building fuse is switched on again, the
charging process resumes automatically.
Following an interruption in the power supply or tripping of the building's fuse, it may
take up to 10 minutes for charging to
resume automatically.
Switch on the building protection system
again after it has been triggered. Otherwise,
the charging process cannot be continued.
The high-voltage battery will not be charged
and you may not be able to drive the vehicle.
If other devices are protected by the same
protective device, these are switched off as
well when the protective device is triggered.
Ensure that these other devices are still
operational after reactivating the protection
device.
Charging the high-voltage battery via
the electrical outlet
Charging cable
Important safety notes
The vehicle is supplied with a single-phase
12 A charging cable. Only use the charging
cable included with the vehicle, which has
been approved for vehicle use.
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 134).
Z
Driving and parking
Conditions of use
137
138
Charging the high-voltage battery
! Only use the charging cable to charge the
Driving and parking
high-voltage battery. Do not use the charging cable for other purposes. It may otherwise be damaged.
Display :
Lights up
green
The external power supply
connection is working properly. The high-voltage battery can be charged.
Flashes red
A malfunction has been
detected in the external
power supply. The high-voltage battery is recharged as
soon as the electricity signal
registers normal values.
i If you use the supplied 12 A charging
cable to charge a high-voltage battery:
Rthe
charge time increases considerably
Relectrical consumption increases consid-
erably
Where possible, charge the high-voltage
battery at a charging station (Y page 140).
Only then can certified electrical energy
consumption levels be reached.
i The charging process can vary depending
Lights up red There is a malfunction. The
charging cable must be
removed from the electrical
outlet and then re-inserted.
Information about charging at a charging station can be found at (Y page 140).
Display ;
on the charging station. Therefore, always
observe the local information.
Stowing the charging cable
The charging cable can be stowed in a bag in
the trunk of the vehicle. To do so, the bag
must be secured to the cargo tie-down rings
using the retaining strap provided.
Controls on the charging cable
Lights up
green
There are no malfunctions.
The high-voltage battery
can be charged.
Lights up red There is a malfunction. The
high-voltage battery cannot
be charged.
i For information on problems relating to
the charging process, see (Y page 142).
Setting the maximum charge current
G WARNING
:
;
=
?
Alternating current status indicator
Control/protection system indicator
Charge current indicator
Charge current setting button
When displays : and ; on the charging
cable light up, this means the following:
If the charge current draw via a mains socket
is too high during the charging process, the
external electrical system may overheat.
There is a risk of fire.
Before beginning the charging process, check
the maximum permissible charge current
locally. Consult a qualified expert to do so
where necessary.
If necessary, adjust your vehicle's settings.
! An excessive charge current can blow a
fuse or lead to overheating of the external
power supply. Check whether the external
power supply is compatible with the set
Charging the high-voltage battery
You can set a limit for the values of the charge
current used in charging the high-voltage battery. This acts as a means of preventing the
power supply from overloading. You can set
this limit by using the controls on the charging
cable or in the on-board computer's menu.
Only set the maximum charge current in the
on-board computer menu if there are no
charge current settings on the charging
cable.
The default standard value is the minimum
charge current setting. This corresponds to
the minimum available charge current from
the power supply.
the controls on the charging cable or in the
on-board computer's menu.
Connecting the charging cable
Driving and parking
charge current. If necessary, lower the set
charge current or use another power
socket.
i The value of the maximum setting and the
adjustment values may vary depending on
the country.
Before charging the high-voltage battery,
have the maximum permissible charge current for the relevant power socket checked by
an electrician.
X To adjust the setting: press button ?
repeatedly until the desired setting is selected in display =.
RTwo LEDs are flashing: minimum setting
RAll LEDs are flashing: maximum setting
Information about the charging time
(Y page 311)
If, after the charging process, the charging
cable is:
Rleft
connected to the power socket, the
currently selected values will be used for
the next charging process.
Rremoved from the power socket, the values
will be reset to the minimum setting for the
next charging process. You may then need
to reset the values of the maximum charge
current.
i If more time than usual is required when
charging the high-voltage battery, check
the maximum charge current setting using
139
:
;
=
?
A
B
To open the charge socket flap
Tire pressure table
Vehicle charge socket cover
Fastener
Vehicle socket
Warning sticker
Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to position
P.
X Switch the ignition off.
X Press the charge socket flap in the direction of arrow :.
The charge socket flap swings up.
X Slide fastener ? to the right.
Vehicle charge socket cover = is open.
X Insert the power supply plug into the electrical outlet to the stop.
X Insert the charging cable connector into
vehicle socket A to the stop.
The high-voltage battery is being charged.
X
Z
Charging the high-voltage battery
140
i The vehicle must not be moved while the
charging cable is connected or during
charging.
Driving and parking
i Depending on the temperature, the
engine cooling system and battery cooling
system may audibly switch on when the
charging cable is connected or during the
charging process.
Removing the charging cable
When the charge level display reaches 100%,
the battery is fully charged (Y page 174).
! Make sure the charging cable has been
disconnected from the vehicle socket
before starting a journey. The vehicle or
charging cable may otherwise be damaged
when you drive off.
Charging the high-voltage battery at
the charging station
General notes
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 134).
Charging communication at a charging
station
The charging station first has to be activated
before you can charge at a charging station.
You can activate the charging station by using
an RFID card or via telephone activation.
Observe the on-site operator instructions for
the charging station.
When the vehicle is connected to the charging
station, information and details on technical
parameters are exchanged. It can thus take
up to 30 seconds for the charging process to
begin.
Connecting the charging cable
When the battery is charged:
Press and hold button C on the charging
cable connector and remove the charging
cable from vehicle socket A.
X Close vehicle socket cover =.
X Close the charge socket flap.
X Remove the charging cable from the electrical outlet.
X Stow the charging cable safely in the vehicle (Y page 138).
X
: To open the charge socket flap
; Tire pressure table
Charging the high-voltage battery
Vehicle charge socket cover
Fastener
Vehicle socket
Warning sticker
Set the DIRECT SELECT lever to position P.
Switch the ignition off.
X Press the charge socket flap in the direction of arrow :.
The charge socket flap swings up.
X Slide fastener ? to the right.
Vehicle charge socket cover = is open.
X Insert the charging cable connector into
vehicle socket A to the stop.
X
X
When the battery is charged:
Press and hold button C on the charging
cable connector and remove the charging
cable from vehicle socket A.
X Close vehicle socket cover =.
X Close the charge socket flap.
X
i The vehicle must not be moved while the
charging cable is connected or during
charging.
i Depending on the temperature, the
engine cooling system and battery cooling
system may audibly switch on when the
charging cable is connected or during the
charging process.
Removing the charging cable
When the charge level display reaches 100%,
the battery is fully charged (Y page 174).
! Make sure the charging cable has been
disconnected from the vehicle socket
before starting a journey. The vehicle or
charging cable may otherwise be damaged
when you drive off.
Z
Driving and parking
=
?
A
B
141
142
Charging the high-voltage battery
Driving and parking
Problems with the charging process
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The charge socket flap
cannot be opened.
The charge socket flap is not unlocked.
X Unlock the vehicle (Y page 72).
The SmartKey batteries are discharged.
X Unlock the vehicle manually using the SmartKey (Y page 73).
The charge socket flap is unlocked, but the opening mechanism is
jammed.
X Lock and unlock the vehicle.
If, after that, the opening mechanism is still jammed:
X
The high-voltage battery is not being
charged.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
A malfunction has occurred during the initialization of the charging
process.
X Ensure that the charging cable is connected to the electrical
outlet.
X Remove the charging cable connector from the vehicle socket
and wait 30 seconds; then re-insert it into the vehicle socket.
X If the problem persists, consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The high-voltage batThe electrical outlet is faulty.
tery is not charged dur- X Have the electrical outlet checked to test if it is functioning
ing the charging procproperly.
ess when connected to
or
a power socket.
X Use a different electrical outlet.
The charging cable con- The snap fastener on the charging cable connector is locked.
nector cannot be
X Press and hold the button on the charging cable connector. The
removed from the vehisnap fastener on the vehicle socket is unlocked.
cle socket.
X Remove the charging cable connector from the vehicle socket.
The snap fastener on the charging cable connector is blocked.
X Press and hold the button on the charging cable connector.
X Try to remove the blockage.
Online access to the vehicle
General information
G WARNING
If you operate information systems and communication equipment integrated in the vehicle while driving, you will be distracted from
traffic conditions. You could also lose control
of the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate the equipment when the traffic
situation permits. If you are not sure that this
is possible, park the vehicle paying attention
to traffic conditions and operate the equipment when the vehicle is stationary.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating integrated information systems and communications equipment.
Only use information systems and communications devices if this is permitted while driving and if the traffic situation permits. You
may otherwise be distracted from the traffic
conditions, cause an accident and injure
yourself and others.
From the "My Mercedes Electric - Vehicle
Homepage", you can call up remote query and
remote configuration functions for your vehicle. This is possible from an Internet-enabled
computer, as well as many modern smartphones.
You can access the "Vehicle Homepage" via
your web browser.
The Internet address was not available at the
time of going to press. Please call the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center
(USA) at the hotline number
1-800-FOR-MERCedes (1-800-367-6372)
to obtain the relevant Internet address.
In order to use the "Vehicle Homepage", you
must agree to the applicable terms of use.
The contractual periods of mbrace apply to
the "Vehicle Homepage". To use the "Vehicle
Homepage", you require an activated mbrace
access and a separate activation/registration for the "Vehicle Homepage".
Further information about the supported end
devices and available languages is available
at any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
In order to call up the "Vehicle Homepage",
the vehicle must be connected to the Internet.
This is possible via the radio module
(Y page 144).
Notes on data protection
Bear in mind that the "Vehicle Homepage"
offers access to your data. Therefore, look
after the vehicle verification code (VVC) and
your user details carefully.
The vehicle verification code (VVC) is required
when you register for the first time on the
"Vehicle Homepage". This code is used to link
the vehicle and the user access on the "Vehicle Homepage" and enables correct use. You
can obtain further information from an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Prevent unauthorized persons from
accessing this data.
Every person who has access to the information stated can use the functions on the "Vehicle Homepage".
RIf you sell your vehicle, you are obliged to
delete the vehicle from your personal area
on the "Vehicle Homepage". Additionally,
you must destroy documents containing
the vehicle verification code (VVC).
RIf you have bought a used vehicle, it is possible that the previous owner still has
access to the "Vehicle Homepage". If in
doubt, have a new vehicle verification code
(VVC) issued by the Mercedes-Benz Center
after purchase. With the new code you can
set up the access to your vehicle, as described in the section "Setting up a personal
area". There, you may also deactivate the
existing access of the previous owner.
Z
143
Driving and parking
Charging the high-voltage battery
144
Parking
Driving and parking
Calling up functions in the "My
Mercedes Electric - Vehicle Homepage"
The "My Mercedes Electric - Vehicle Homepage" allows you access to your vehicle's
functions using remote query and remote
configuration. For example, climate control
can be activated using remote configuration
which means that it need not be set in the
vehicle. Power for the climate control is primarily supplied via the charging cable connected to the mains supply. In this way, the
range of the vehicle in most cases is not
reduced. If climate control is activated, the
battery charge level and thus the range may
be reduced. The "Vehicle Homepage" provides you with information all about how to
use your vehicle.
If the vehicle is entered in your personal area
of the "Vehicle Homepage", you can also
access the following functions:
Rrequest
the current condition of charge
the departure time
Rorder and activate the "Pre-entry climate
control at departure time" function
If the vehicle is charging, the predicted charging time and the predicted range will also be
shown.
This data is estimated and may be influenced
by the following factors:
Rprogram
Routside
temperature
on consumers, e.g. climate control and seat heating
Rpersonal driving style
Rroad and traffic conditions
Rroute characteristics
Therefore, allow for a sufficient reserve.
Rswitched
Connecting the vehicle to the Internet
Via a radio module
i This function is not available in all countries and requires an activated mbrace
access.
You can use the "Vehicle Homepage" if the
vehicle has a connection to the Internet via a
mobile phone. The radio module uses a
mobile phone connection and transmits the
necessary data by radio. The vehicle automatically recognizes whether a connection to
the Internet via the radio module is possible
or not. No presets are necessary.
i Restrictions in reception are possible if
the vehicle is in an underground car park,
for example. Restrictions may also occur in
areas with poor mobile network coverage.
Parking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you release the parking brake on uphill or
downhill gradients, the vehicle can begin to
move when in park position P. There is a risk
of an accident.
To avoid hazardous situations:
Rprevent
the parked vehicle from rolling on
uphill or downhill gradients by always
applying the parking brake.
Rdo not park the vehicle on uphill or downhill
gradients if the parking brake is malfunctioning.
G WARNING
If you leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, they could set it in motion by, for example:
Rrelease
Rshift
the parking brake.
the transmission out of park position
P.
Rstart the vehicle's drive system.
They could also operate the vehicle's equipment. There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.
Parking
transmission directly from D to R, from R to
D or directly to P.
Do not open the driver's door while the
vehicle is in motion. Otherwise, at low
speeds in transmission position D or R,
park position P is engaged automatically
and the electrical parking brake is applied.
The transmission could be damaged.
! Always secure the vehicle correctly
against rolling away. Otherwise, the vehicle
or its drivetrain could be damaged.
To ensure that the vehicle is secured against
rolling away unintentionally:
Rthe electric parking brake must be applied.
Rthe
transmission must be in position P.
key in the ignition lock must be turned
to position 0 and removed from the ignition
lock.
Ron steep uphill or downhill gradients, turn
the front wheels towards the curb.
Rthe
Switching off the drive system
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This can affect
the power steering and the brake boosting
effect, for example. You will require considerably more effort to steer and brake. There is a
risk of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to position
P.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove it.
The immobilizer is activated.
X
Electric parking brake
General notes
G WARNING
If you leave children unsupervised in the vehicle, they could set it in motion by, for example:
Rrelease
Rshift
P.
the parking brake.
the transmission out of park position
Rstart
the vehicle's drive system.
They could also operate the vehicle's equipment. There is a risk of an accident and injury.
When leaving the vehicle, always take the
SmartKey with you and lock the vehicle. Never
leave children unsupervised in the vehicle.
i The function of the electric parking brake
and the parking lock is dependent on the
on-board voltage. If the on-board voltage is
low or if there is a malfunction in the system, it may not be possible to apply the
released parking brake or to shift the transmission to the P position.
If this is the case, only park the vehicle on
level ground and secure it to prevent it rolling away.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X
It may not be possible to release an applied
parking brake if the on-board voltage is low or
there is a malfunction in the system. Contact
a qualified specialist workshop.
i The electric parking brake carries out a
function check at regular intervals when
the drive system is switched off. The
sounds that can be heard while this is
occurring are normal.
Z
Driving and parking
! While the vehicle is rolling, do not shift the
145
146
Parking
Driving and parking
The red F (USA only) or ! (Canada
only) indicator lamp in the instrument cluster
lights up.
Releasing automatically
Your vehicle's electric parking brake is automatically released if all of the following conditions are met:
Rthe
vehicle has been started.
transmission is in position D or R.
Rthe seat belt has been fastened.
Ryou depress the accelerator pedal.
If the transmission is in position R, the tailgate
must be closed.
If your seat belt is not fastened, the following
conditions must be fulfilled to automatically
release the electric parking brake:
Rthe
Applying/releasing manually
Applying
X Push handle :.
When the electric parking brake is applied,
the red F (USA only) or ! (Canada
only) indicator lamp lights up in the instrument cluster.
i The electric parking brake can also be
applied when the SmartKey is removed.
Releasing
X Turn the SmartKey to position 1 or 2 in the
ignition lock.
X Pull handle :.
The red F (USA only) or ! (Canada
only) indicator lamp in the instrument cluster goes out.
Applying automatically
When the vehicle's HOLD function is holding
the vehicle at a standstill, the electric parking
brake is engaged automatically.
In addition, at least one of the following conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
drive system is switched off.
Rthe driver's door is open and the seat belt is
not fastened.
Rthere is a system malfunction.
Rthe power supply is insufficient.
Rthe vehicle is stationary for a lengthy
period.
Rthe
driver's door is closed.
have shifted out of transmission position P or you have previously driven faster
than 2 mph (3 km/h).
Ryou
i Ensure that you do not depress the accel-
erator pedal unintentionally. Otherwise the
parking brake will be released and the vehicle will start to move.
Emergency braking
The vehicle can also be braked during an
emergency by using the electric parking
brake.
X While driving, push handle : of the electric
parking brake (Y page 145).
i The vehicle is braked for as long as han-
dle : of the electric parking brake is
pressed. The longer electric parking brake
handle : is depressed, the greater the
braking force.
Driving tips
Ra
warning tone sounds
Rthe Please Release Parking Brake
message appears
Rthe red F (USA only) or ! (Canada
only) indicator lamp in the instrument cluster flashes
When the vehicle has been braked to a standstill, the electric parking brake is applied.
Parking the vehicle for a long period
If you leave the vehicle parked for longer than
four weeks, the battery may be damaged by
exhaustive discharging.
If you leave the vehicle parked for longer than
six weeks, the vehicle may suffer damage as a
result of lack of use.
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop and
seek advice.
i You can obtain information about trickle
chargers from a qualified specialist workshop.
Driving tips
General notes
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you switch off the ignition while driving,
safety-relevant functions are only available
with limitations, or not at all. This could affect,
for example, the power steering and the brake
boosting effect. You will require considerably
more effort to steer and brake. There is a risk
of an accident.
Do not switch off the ignition while driving.
G WARNING
If you operate mobile communication equipment while driving, you will be distracted from
traffic conditions. You could also lose control
of the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate this equipment when the vehicle
is stationary.
Observe the legal requirements for the country in which you are driving. Some jurisdictions prohibit the driver from using a mobile
phone while driving a vehicle.
If you make a call while driving, always use
hands-free mode. Only operate the telephone
when the traffic situation permits. If you are
unsure, pull over to a safe location and stop
before operating the telephone.
Bear in mind that at a speed of only 30 mph
(approximately 50 km/h), the vehicle covers
a distance of 44 ft (approximately 14 m) per
second.
Drive sensibly – save energy
Observe the following tips to save energy:
RThe
tires should always be inflated to the
recommended tire pressure.
RRemove unnecessary loads.
RRemove roof racks when they are not needed.
RAvoid frequent acceleration or braking.
Energy consumption also increases when
driving in low or high outside temperatures, in
stop-start traffic, on short journeys and in
hilly terrain.
Drinking and driving
G WARNING
Drinking and driving and/or taking drugs and
driving are very dangerous combinations.
Even a small amount of alcohol or drugs can
affect your reflexes, perceptions and judgment.
The possibility of a serious or even fatal accident is greatly increased when you drink or
take drugs and drive.
Z
Driving and parking
During braking:
147
148
Driving tips
Driving and parking
Do not drink or take drugs and drive or allow
anyone to drive who has been drinking or taking drugs.
ECO display
The ECO display gives you information on how
economical your driving style is. The ECO display assists you in achieving the optimum
driving style in terms of consumption, taking
the actual and selected conditions into consideration. Your driving style can significantly
influence the vehicle's consumption.
ECO display (example: multifunction display)
The ECO display consists of three bars:
RAcceleration
RConstant
RCoasting
The percent value is the average value of the
three bars. The three bars and the mean value
begin at the value of 50%. A higher percentage indicates a more economical driving
style.
The ECO display does not indicate the actual
fuel consumption and a fixed percentage
count in the ECO display does not indicate a
fixed consumption figure.
Apart from driving style, consumption is
dependent on many factors such as, e.g.:
Rload
Rtire
pressure
start
Rchoice of route
Relectrical consumers switched on
These factors are not taken into consideration by the ECO display.
Rcold
The evaluation of your driving style is carried
out using the following three categories:
RAcceleration (evaluation of all acceleration processes):
- The bar fills up: moderate acceleration,
especially at higher speeds
- The bar empties: sporty acceleration
RConstant (assessment of driving behavior
at all times):
- The bar fills up: constant speed and
avoidance of unnecessary acceleration
and deceleration
- The bar empties: fluctuations in speed
RCoasting (assessment of all deceleration
processes):
- The bar fills up: anticipatory driving,
keeping your distance and early release
of the accelerator. The vehicle can coast
without use of the brakes.
- The bar empties: frequent braking
To achieve a higher value in the categories
Acceleration and Constant
Constant, drive the vehicle in drive program E:
i On long journeys at a constant speed, e.g.
on the highway, only the bar for Constant
will change.
i The ECO display summaries the driving
characteristics from the start of the journey
to its completion. For this reason, the bars
change dynamically at the beginning of the
journey. On longer journeys, there are
fewer changes. For more dynamic changes,
carry out a manual reset.
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 177).
Braking
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you increase the recuperation level on slippery road surfaces, the drive wheels may lose
their traction. There is an increased danger of
skidding and accidents.
Do not increase the recuperation level on slippery road surfaces.
The braking performance of the electric
motor using recuperative braking is, in some
operating modes, either reduced or not effective:
Rwhen
the condition of charge of the highvoltage battery increases
Rif the high-voltage battery is not yet at a
normal operating temperature
Rwhen driving close to the maximum speed
Rwhen driving at speeds close to zero
Rin transmission position N
Rduring and after ESP stability control.
If you do not make an additional effort to
apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect
by applying the brake yourself.
Downhill gradients
On long, steep gradients, you must reduce the
load on the brakes by selecting maximum
recuperation. This helps you to avoid overheating the brakes and wearing them out
excessively.
Recuperation allows the vehicle to be decelerated without placing a load on the braking
system.
Do not depress the brake pedal continuously
while the vehicle is in motion, e.g. causing the
brakes to rub by constantly applying light
pressure to the pedal. This results in excessive and premature wear to the brake pads.
Heavy and light loads
G WARNING
If you rest your foot on the brake pedal while
driving, the braking system can overheat. This
increases the stopping distance and can even
cause the braking system to fail. There is a
risk of an accident.
Never use the brake pedal as a footrest. Never
depress the brake pedal and the accelerator
pedal at the same time.
! Depressing the brake pedal constantly
results in excessive and premature wear to
the brake pads.
If the brakes have been subjected to a heavy
load, do not stop the vehicle immediately.
Drive on for a short while. This allows the airflow to cool the brakes more quickly.
Wet roads
If you have driven for a long time in heavy rain
without braking, there may be a delayed reaction from the brakes when braking for the first
time. This may also occur after the vehicle has
been washed or driven through deep water.
You have to depress the brake pedal more
firmly. Maintain a greater distance from the
vehicle in front.
After driving on a wet road or having the vehicle washed, brake firmly while paying attention to the traffic conditions. This will warm up
the brake discs, thereby drying them more
quickly and protecting them against corrosion.
Limited braking performance on salttreated roads
If you drive on salted roads, a layer of salt
residue may form on the brake discs and
brake pads. This can result in a significantly
longer braking distance.
RBrake occasionally to remove any possible
salt residue. Make sure that you do not
endanger other road users when doing so.
RCarefully depress the brake pedal and the
beginning and end of a journey.
RMaintain a greater distance to the vehicle
ahead.
Z
149
Driving and parking
Driving tips
150
Driving tips
Servicing the brakes
Driving and parking
! If the red brake warning lamp lights up in
the instrument cluster and you hear a warning tone while the engine is running, the
brake fluid level may be too low. Observe
additional warning messages in the multifunction display.
The brake fluid level may be too low due to
brake pad wear or leaking brake lines.
Have the brake system checked immediately. This work should be carried out at a
qualified specialist workshop.
! A function or performance test should
only be carried out on a 2-axle dynamometer. If you are planning to have the vehicle
tested on such a dynamometer, contact an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center to
obtain further information first. Otherwise,
you could damage the drive train or the
brake system.
! As the ESP® system operates automati-
cally, the engine and the ignition must be
switched off (the SmartKey must be in position 0 or 1 in the ignition lock) if:
vehicle which have been approved for
Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which correspond
to an equivalent quality standard. Brake
pads/linings which have not been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or which are not
of an equivalent quality could affect your vehicle's operating safety.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
use brake fluid that has been specially
approved for your vehicle by Mercedes-Benz,
or which corresponds to an equivalent quality
standard. Brake fluid which has not been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles or
which is not of an equivalent quality could
affect your vehicle's operating safety.
Checking brake lining thickness
You can measure the break pad/lining thickness using a test gage. Color-coding (green or
red) on the test gage allows you to determine
whether the brake pad/lining thickness is still
sufficient. The test gage is in the vehicle document wallet in the glove box.
Rthe
electric parking brake is tested on a
brake dynamometer (for a maximum of
ten seconds)
Rthe vehicle is towed with the front axle
raised.
Braking triggered automatically by ESP®
may seriously damage the brake system.
All checks and maintenance work on the
brake system must be carried out at a qualified specialist workshop. Consult a qualified
specialist workshop to arrange this.
Have brake pads installed and brake fluid
replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
If the brake system has only been subject to
moderate loads, you should test the functionality of your brakes at regular intervals.
You can find a description of Brake Assist
(BAS) on (Y page 63).
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only
have brake pads/linings installed on your
Front wheel
Driving tips
151
Driving on wet roads
If water has accumulated to a certain depth
on the road surface, there is a danger of
hydroplaning occurring, even if:
Ryou
drive at low speeds.
tires have adequate tread depth.
For this reason, in the event of heavy rain or in
conditions in which hydroplaning may occur,
you must drive in the following manner:
Rthe
Rlower
your speed.
ruts.
Rbrake carefully.
Ravoid
Rear wheel
Bring the vehicle and wheels into a suitable
position so that you can attach test gage
A.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 144).
X Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to P.
X Switch off the drive system.
X Place test gage A between the wheel's
spokes on brake pad/lining =.
X Hold test gage A vertically on brake
disc : and slide measuring pin ; onto
brake disc :.
X Check which color field ? the arrow on
measuring pin ; is pointing to.
Green: the brake pad/lining thickness is
sufficient.
Red: the brake pad/lining thickness is not
sufficient. Have the brake pads/lining
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
X
i To avoid an inaccurate measurement:
Rmake
ably
sure you position the wheels suit-
Rdo not put the measuring pin on a recess
in the brake disc
Driving on flooded roads
! Bear in mind that vehicles traveling in
front or in the opposite direction create
waves. This may cause the maximum permissible water depth to be exceeded.
Failure to observe these notes may result in
damage to the engine, electrical systems
and transmission.
! Do not drive through flooded areas.
Check the depth of any water before driving
through it. Drive slowly through standing
water. Otherwise, water could enter the
vehicle interior or the drive system.
These notes must be observed under all
circumstances. Otherwise, the drive system, electrical systems and transmission
could be damaged.
If you have to drive on stretches of road on
which water has collected, please bear in
mind that:
Rthe
maximum permissible fording depth in
still water is 10 in (25 cm)
Ryou should drive no faster than at a walking
pace
Z
Driving and parking
Hydroplaning
Driving systems
152
Winter driving
Driving and parking
General notes
G WARNING
If you increase the recuperation level on slippery road surfaces, the drive wheels may lose
their traction. There is an increased danger of
skidding and accidents.
Do not increase the recuperation level on slippery road surfaces.
At the onset of winter, have your vehicle winterized at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g.
at an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Drive particularly carefully on slippery road
surfaces. Avoid sudden acceleration, steering
and braking maneuvers. Do not use cruise
control.
If the vehicle threatens to skid or cannot be
stopped when moving at low speed:
X
Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to position
N.
The outside temperature indicator is not
designed to serve as an ice-warning device
and is therefore unsuitable for that purpose.
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Indicated temperatures just above the freezing point do not guarantee that the road surface is free of ice. The road may still be icy,
especially in wooded areas or on bridges. You
should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing
point.
For more information on driving with snow
chains, see (Y page 280).
For more information on driving with summer
tires, see (Y page 280).
Observe the notes in the "Winter operation"
section (Y page 280).
Driving systems
Cruise control
Important safety notes
Cruise control maintains a constant road
speed for you. In order to avoid exceeding the
set speed, it decelerates automatically.
If you fail to adapt your driving style, cruise
control can neither reduce the risk of an accident nor override the laws of physics. Cruise
control cannot take into account the road,
traffic and weather conditions. Cruise control
is only an aid. You are responsible for the distance to the vehicle in front, for vehicle speed,
for braking in good time and for staying in
your lane.
Use cruise control only if road and traffic conditions make it appropriate to maintain a
steady speed for a prolonged period. You can
set any road speed above 20 mph (30 km/h).
Do not use cruise control:
Rin
road and traffic conditions which do not
allow you to maintain a constant speed e.g.
in heavy traffic or on winding roads
Ron slippery road surfaces. Braking or accelerating could cause the drive wheels to lose
traction and the vehicle could then skid
Rwhen there is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog,
heavy rain or snow
If there is a change of drivers, advise the new
driver of the speed stored.
Cruise control lever
You can operate cruise control with the cruise
control lever.
Driving systems
Accelerate the vehicle to the desired
speed.
X Briefly press the cruise control lever up :
or down ;.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
Cruise control is activated. The vehicle
automatically maintains the stored speed.
153
i Cruise control may be unable to maintain
:
;
=
?
To activate or increase speed
To activate or reduce speed
To deactivate cruise control
To activate at the current speed/last
stored speed
When you activate cruise control, the stored
speed is shown in the multifunction display
for 5 seconds.
Activation conditions
To activate cruise control, all of the following
activation conditions must be fulfilled:
Rthe
electric parking brake must be
released.
Ryou are driving faster than 20 mph
(30 km/h).
RESP® must be active, but not intervening.
Rthe DIRECT SELECT lever must be in position D.
Storing, maintaining and calling up a
speed
Storing and maintaining the current
speed
You can store the current speed if you are
driving faster than 20 mph (30 km/h).
the stored speed on uphill gradients. The
stored speed is resumed when the gradient
evens out. Cruise control maintains the
stored speed on downhill gradients by
automatically decelerating the vehicle.
Storing the current speed or calling up the
last stored speed
G WARNING
If you call up the stored speed and it differs
from the current speed, the vehicle accelerates or decelerates. If you do not know the
stored speed, the vehicle could accelerate or
brake unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to the road and traffic conditions before calling up the stored speed. If you
do not know the stored speed, store the
desired speed again.
Briefly pull the cruise control lever towards
you ?.
X Remove your foot from the accelerator
pedal.
The first time cruise control is activated, it
stores the current speed or regulates the
speed of the vehicle to the previously
stored speed.
X
Setting a speed
Keep in mind that it may take a brief moment
until the vehicle has accelerated or braked to
the speed set.
Z
Driving and parking
X
Driving systems
154
Press the cruise control lever up : for a
higher speed or down ; for a lower speed.
X To adjust the set speed in 1 mph increments (1 km/h increments): briefly
press the cruise control lever up : or
down ; to the pressure point.
Every time the cruise control lever is
pressed up : or down ; the last speed
stored is increased or reduced.
X To adjust the set speed in 5 mph increments (10 km/h increments): briefly
press the cruise control lever up : or
down ; to the pressure point.
Every time the cruise control lever is
pressed up : or down ; the last speed
stored is increased or reduced.
Driving and parking
X
i Cruise control is not deactivated if you
depress the accelerator pedal. For example, if you accelerate briefly to overtake,
cruise control adjusts the vehicle's speed
to the last speed stored after you have finished overtaking.
Deactivating cruise control
There are several ways to deactivate cruise
control:
X
Briefly press the cruise control lever forwards = .
or
X
Brake.
Cruise control is automatically deactivated if:
Rthe
vehicle is secured with the electric
parking brake
Ryou are driving at less than 20 mph
(30 km/h)
RESP® intervenes or you deactivate ESP®
Ryou shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to position N while driving
If cruise control is deactivated, you will hear a
warning tone. You will see the Cruise Con‐
trol Off message in the multifunction display for approximately 5 seconds.
i The last speed stored is cleared when you
switch off the drive system.
HOLD function
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When leaving the vehicle, it can still roll away
despite being braked by the HOLD function if:
Rthere
is a malfunction in the system or in
the voltage supply.
Rthe HOLD function has been deactivated by
pressing the accelerator pedal or the brake
pedal, e.g. by a vehicle occupant.
Rthe electrical system in the engine compartment, the battery or the fuses have
been tampered with.
Rthe battery is disconnected
There is a risk of an accident.
If you wish to exit the vehicle, always turn off
the HOLD function and secure the vehicle
against rolling away.
! If the HOLD function is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle,
deactivate the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
Deactivating the HOLD function
(Y page 155).
General notes
The HOLD function can assist the driver in the
following situations:
Rwhen
pulling away, especially on steep
slopes
Rwhen maneuvering on steep slopes
Rwhen waiting in traffic
The vehicle is kept stationary without the
driver having to depress the brake pedal.
Driving systems
You can activate the HOLD function if:
i After a time, the electric parking brake
Rthe
vehicle is stationary
Rthe drive system is switched on
Rthe driver's door is closed or your seat belt
is fastened
Rthe electric parking brake is released
Rthe transmission position D, R or N is
engaged
Activating the HOLD function
Ryou
secures the vehicle and relieves the service
brake.
The electric parking brake automatically
secures the vehicle if the HOLD function is
activated and:
Rthe
driver's door is open and the driver's
seat belt is unfastened.
Rthe drive system is switched off.
Ra system malfunction occurs.
Rthe power supply is not sufficient.
If a malfunction occurs, then the transmission
may be shifted into position P automatically.
i If you do not deactivate the HOLD func-
Make sure that the activation conditions
are met.
X Depress the brake pedal.
X Quickly depress the brake pedal further
until : appears in the multifunction display.
The HOLD function is activated. You can
release the brake pedal.
X
i If depressing the brake pedal the first
time does not activate the HOLD function,
wait briefly and then try again.
Deactivating the HOLD function
The HOLD function is deactivated automatically if:
Ryou
accelerate and the transmission is in
position D or R.
Rthe transmission is in position P.
tion before you switch off the drive system,
you can no longer start the drive system.
Deactivate the HOLD function before you
switch off the drive system.
PARKTRONIC
Important safety notes
PARKTRONIC is an electronic parking aid with
ultrasonic sensors. It monitors the area
around your vehicle using six sensors in the
front bumper and four sensors in the rear
bumper. PARKTRONIC indicates visually and
audibly the distance between your vehicle
and an object.
PARKTRONIC is only an aid. It is not a replacement for your attention to your immediate
surroundings. You are always responsible for
safe maneuvering, parking and exiting a parking space. When maneuvering, parking or
pulling out of a parking space, make sure that
there are no persons, animals or objects in
the area in which you are maneuvering.
Z
Driving and parking
Activation conditions
depress the brake pedal again with a
certain amount of pressure until : disappears from the multifunction display.
Ryou secure the vehicle using the electric
parking brake.
The braking effect is canceled and the HOLD
function deactivated when you depress the
accelerator pedal to pull away.
155
156
Driving systems
Driving and parking
! When parking, pay particular attention to
objects above or below the sensors, such
as flower pots or trailer drawbars. PARKTRONIC does not detect such objects when
they are in the immediate vicinity of the
vehicle. You could damage the vehicle or
the objects.
The sensors may not detect snow and other
objects that absorb ultrasonic waves.
Ultrasonic sources such as an automatic
car wash, the compressed-air brakes on a
truck or a pneumatic drill could cause
PARKTRONIC to malfunction.
PARKTRONIC may not function correctly on
uneven terrain.
: Example: sensors in the front bumper,
right-hand side
PARKTRONIC is activated automatically when
you:
Rswitch
on the ignition
the transmission to position D, R or N
Rrelease the electric parking brake.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated at speeds above
11 mph (18 km/h). It is reactivated at lower
speeds.
Rshift
Side view
Range of the sensors
General notes
PARKTRONIC does not take objects into consideration that are:
Rbelow the detection range, e.g. people, ani-
mals or objects
the detection range, e.g. overhanging loads, truck overhangs or loading
ramps.
Rabove
Top view
The sensors must be free from dirt, ice or
slush. They can otherwise not function correctly. Clean the sensors regularly, taking
care not to scratch or damage them
(Y page 259).
Front sensors
Center
Approx. 40 in (approx.
100 cm)
Corners
Approx. 24 in (approx.
60 cm)
Rear sensors
Center
Approx. 48 in (approx.
120 cm)
Corners
Approx. 32 in (approx.
80 cm)
Minimum distance
Center
Approx. 8 in (approx.
20 cm)
Corners
Approx. 8 in (approx.
20 cm)
If there is an obstacle within this range, the
relevant warning displays light up and a warning tone sounds. If the distance falls below
the minimum, the distance may no longer be
shown.
Warning displays
The warning displays show the distance
between the sensors and the obstacle. The
warning display for the front area is located
on the dashboard above the center air vents.
The warning display for the rear area is located on the headliner in the rear compartment.
ments. PARKTRONIC is operational if yellow
segments showing operational readiness =
light up.
The selected transmission position and the
direction in which the vehicle is rolling determine which warning display is active when the
drive system is running.
Transmission
position
Warning display
D
Front area activated
R, N or the vehicle
is rolling backwards
Rear and front areas
activated
P
No areas activated
One or more segments light up as the vehicle
approaches an obstacle, depending on the
vehicle's distance from the obstacle.
From the:
Rsixth
segment onwards, you will hear an
intermittent warning tone for approximately 2 seconds
Rseventh segment onwards, you will hear a
warning tone for approximately 2 seconds.
This indicates that you have now reached
the minimum distance.
Deactivating/activating PARKTRONIC
Warning display for the front area
: Segments on the left-hand side of the
vehicle
; Segments on the right-hand side of the
vehicle
= Segments showing operational readiness
The warning display for each side of the vehicle is divided into five yellow and two red seg-
: Indicator lamp
; To deactivate/activate PARKTRONIC
If indicator lamp : lights up, PARKTRONIC is
deactivated.
Z
157
Driving and parking
Driving systems
158
Driving systems
i PARKTRONIC is automatically activated
Driving and parking
when you turn the key to position 2 in the
ignition lock.
Driving systems
159
Problems with PARKTRONIC
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Only the red segments PARKTRONIC has malfunctioned and has switched off.
in the PARKTRONIC
X If problems persist, have PARKTRONIC checked at a qualified
warning displays are lit.
specialist workshop.
You also hear a warning
tone for approximately
2 seconds.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approximately 5 seconds, and
the indicator lamp in
the PARKTRONIC button lights up.
Only the red segments The PARKTRONIC sensors are dirty or there is interference.
in the PARKTRONIC
X Clean the PARKTRONIC sensors (Y page 259).
warning displays are lit. X
Switch the ignition back on.
PARKTRONIC is deactivated after approxThe problem may be caused by an external source of radio or
imately 5 seconds.
ultrasound waves.
X See if PARKTRONIC functions in a different location.
Active Parking Assist
General notes
Active Parking Assist is an electronic parking
aid with ultrasound. It measures the road on
both sides of the vehicle. A parking symbol
indicates a suitable parking space. Active
steering intervention can assist you during
maneuvering and parking. You may also use
PARKTRONIC (Y page 155).
Important safety notes
Active Parking Assist is merely an aid. It is not
a replacement for your attention to your
immediate surroundings. You are always
responsible for safe maneuvering, parking
and exiting a parking space. Make sure that
no persons, animals or objects are in the
maneuvering range.
When PARKTRONIC is switched off, Active
Parking Assist is also unavailable.
G WARNING
The vehicle swings out when parking and in
doing so could cross into the opposite lane.
This could result in a collision with another
road user. There is a risk of an accident.
Pay attention to other road users when parking. Stop the vehicle if necessary or cancel the
Active Parking Assist parking procedure.
! If unavoidable, you should drive over
obstacles such as curbs slowly and not at a
sharp angle. Otherwise, you may damage
the wheels or tires.
Active Parking Assist may possibly indicate
parking spaces which are not suitable for
parking, for example:
Rwhere
parking or stopping is prohibited
Rin front of driveways or entrances and exits
Ron
unsuitable surfaces
Z
Driving and parking
Problem
160
Driving systems
Parking tips:
ROn narrow roads, drive as close to the park-
ing space as possible.
spaces that are littered or overgrown might be identified or measured
incorrectly.
RParking spaces that are partially occupied
by trailer drawbars might not be identified
as such or be measured incorrectly.
RSnowfall or heavy rain may lead to a parking
space being measured inaccurately.
RPay attention to the PARKTRONIC
(Y page 157) warning messages during the
parking procedure.
RYou can intervene in the steering procedure
to correct it at any time. Active Parking
Assist will then be canceled.
RWhen transporting a load which protrudes
from your vehicle, you should not use
Active Parking Assist.
RNever use Active Parking Assist when snow
chains are installed.
RMake sure that the tire pressures are
always correct. This has a direct influence
on the parking characteristics of the vehicle.
Use Active Parking Assist for parking spaces:
Driving and parking
RParking
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are on straight roads, not bends
Rthat are on the same level as the road, e.g.
not on the pavement
Rthat
Detecting parking spaces
Objects located above the height range of
Active Parking Assist will not be detected
when the parking space is measured. These
are not taken into account when the parking
procedure is calculated, e.g. overhanging
loads, tail sections or loading ramps of goods
vehicles.
G WARNING
If there are objects above the detection range,
Active Parking Assist may turn prematurely.
You may cause a collision as a result. There is
a risk of an accident.
If there are objects above the detection range,
stop and deactivate Active Parking Assist.
For further information on the detection
range (Y page 156).
Active Parking Assist does not support you
with parking spaces parallel to the direction
of travel if:
Rthe
parking space is on a curb
parking space is apparently blocked,
for example by foliage or grass paving
blocks
Rthe range of movement is too small
Rthe parking space is bordered by an obstacle which is not clearly defined such as a
tree or a trailer
Rthe
: Detected parking space on the left
; Parking symbol
= Detected parking space on the right
Active Parking Assist is automatically activated when driving forwards. The system is
operational at speeds of up to approximately
22 mph (35 km/h). While in operation, the
system independently locates and measures
parking spaces on both sides of the vehicle.
Active Parking Assist will only detect parking
spaces:
Rthat
are parallel to the direction of travel
are at least 59 in (1.5 m) wide
Rthat are at least 39 in (1 m) longer than your
vehicle
When driving at speeds below 19 mph
(30 km/h), you will see parking symbol as a
status indicator in the instrument cluster.
When a parking space has been detected, an
Rthat
Driving systems
Parking
G WARNING
Active Parking Assist merely aids you by intervening actively in the steering. If you do not
brake there is a risk of an accident.
Always apply the brakes yourself when
maneuvering and parking.
Stop the vehicle when the parking space
symbol shows the desired parking space in
the instrument cluster.
X Shift the transmission to position R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
X To park using Active Parking Assist:
press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel.
The Park Assist Active Accelerate
and Brake Observe Surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
X
Let go of the multifunction steering wheel.
Back up the vehicle, being ready to brake at
all times. Do not exceed a maximum speed
of approximately 5 mph (10 km/h) when
backing up. Otherwise Active Parking
Assist will be canceled.
i In tight parking spaces, you will achieve
the best parking results by backing up as
far as possible. When doing so, also
observe the PARKTRONIC messages.
X
Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
Maneuvering may be required in tight parking spaces.
The Park Assist Active Select D
Observe Surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
X Shift the transmission to position D while
the vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction.
The Park Assist Active Accelerate
and Brake Observe Surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
Drive forwards and be ready to brake at all
times.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
The Park Assist Active Select R
Observe Surroundings message appears in
the multifunction display.
Further transmission shifts may be necessary.
As soon as the parking procedure is complete, the Park Assist Finished message
appears in the multifunction display and you
will hear a tone.
Active Parking Assist no longer supports you
with steering interventions. When Active
Parking Assist is finished, you must steer
again yourself. PARKTRONIC is still available.
X Maneuver if necessary.
X Always observe the warning messages displayed by PARKTRONIC (Y page 157).
Parking tips:
RThe
way your vehicle is positioned in the
parking space after parking is dependent
Z
Driving and parking
arrow towards the right or the left also
appears. By default, Active Parking Assist
only displays parking spaces on the frontpassenger side. Parking spaces on the driver's side are displayed as soon as the turn
signal on the driver's side is activated. This
must remain switched on until you acknowledge the use of Active Parking Assist by
pressing the a button on the multifunction steering wheel.
A parking space is displayed while you are
driving past it, and until you are approximately 50 ft (15 m) away from it.
161
Driving and parking
162
Driving systems
on various factors. These include the position and shape of the vehicles parked in
front and behind it and the conditions of the
location. It may be the case that Active
Parking Assist guides you too far into a
parking space, or not far enough into it. In
some cases, it may also lead you across or
onto the curb. If necessary, you should cancel the parking procedure with Active Parking Assist.
RYou can also engage forward gear prematurely. The vehicle redirects and does not
drive as far into the parking space. Should a
gear be changed too early, the parking procedure will be canceled. A sensible parking
position can no longer be achieved from
this position.
Exiting a parking space
In order that Active Parking Assist can support you when you exit the parking space:
Rthe
border of the parking space must be
high enough. A curb is too small, for example.
Rthe border of the parking space must not be
too wide. Your vehicle can be maneuvered
into a position at a maximum of 45° to the
starting position in the parking space.
Ra maneuvering distance of at least 3.3 ft
(1.0 m) must be available.
Active Parking Assist can only assist you with
exiting a parking space if you have parked the
vehicle parallel to the direction of travel using
Active Parking Assist.
X Start the drive system.
X Switch on the turn signal in the direction
you will drive out of the parking space.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R.
The Start Park Assist? Yes: OK No:
% message appears in the multifunction
display.
X To cancel the procedure: press the %
button on the multifunction steering wheel
or pull away.
or
To exit a parking space using Active
Parking Assist: press the a button on
the multifunction steering wheel.
The Park Assist Active Accelerate
and Brake Observe Surroundings message appears in the multifunction display.
X Let go of the multifunction steering wheel.
X Reverse the vehicle or drive forwards, being
ready to brake at all times. Do not exceed a
maximum speed of approximately 6 mph
(10 km/h) when exiting a parking space.
Otherwise Active Parking Assist will be canceled.
X Stop when PARKTRONIC sounds the continuous warning tone, if not before.
X Shift the transmission to position D or R as
required while the vehicle is stationary.
Active Parking Assist immediately steers in
the other direction. The Park Assist
Active Accelerate and Brake
Observe Surroundings message appears
in the multifunction display.
i You will achieve the best results by waiting for the steering procedure to complete
before pulling away.
If you back up after activation, the steering
wheel is moved to the straight-ahead position.
X
Drive forwards and back up as prompted by
the PARKTRONIC warning displays, several
times if necessary.
X Stop as soon as PARKTRONIC sounds the
continuous warning tone, if not before.
X
Once you have exited the parking space completely, the steering wheel is moved to the
straight-ahead position. You hear a tone and
the Park Assist Finished message
appears in the multifunction display. You will
then have to steer and merge into traffic on
your own. PARKTRONIC is still available.
Driving systems
You can cancel Active Parking Assist at any
time.
X
Rear view camera
General notes
Stop the movement of the multifunction
steering wheel or steer yourself.
Active Parking Assist will be canceled at
once. The Park Assist Canceled message appears in the multifunction display.
or
X
Press the PARKTRONIC button on the center console (Y page 157).
PARKTRONIC is switched off and Active
Parking Assist is immediately canceled.
The Park Assist Canceled message
appears in the multifunction display.
Active Parking Assist is canceled automatically if:
Rthe
electric parking brake is engaged
position P is selected
Rparking using Active Parking Assist is no
longer possible
Ryou are driving faster than 6 mph (10 km/h)
Ra wheel spins, ESP® intervenes or fails. The
÷ warning lamp lights up in the instrument cluster.
A warning tone sounds. The parking symbol
goes out and the Park Assist Canceled
message appears in the multifunction display.
If Active Parking Assist is canceled, you must
steer again yourself.
Rtransmission
Rear view camera : is in the handle on the
tailgate.
The rear view camera is an optical parking and
maneuvering aid. It uses guide lines to show
the area behind your vehicle in the Audio/
COMAND display.
The area behind the vehicle is displayed as a
mirror image, as in the rear view mirror.
i The text shown in the COMAND display
depends on the language setting. The following are examples of rear view camera
messages in the COMAND display.
Observe the notes on cleaning (Y page 260).
Important safety notes
The rear view camera is only an aid. It is not a
replacement for your attention to your immediate surroundings. You are always responsible for safe maneuvering, parking and exiting
a parking space. When maneuvering or parking, make sure that there are no persons, animals or objects in the area in which you are
maneuvering.
Under the following circumstances, the rear
view camera will not function, or will function
in a limited manner:
Rif
the tailgate is open
there is heavy rain, snow or fog
Rat night or in very dark places
Rif the camera is exposed to very bright light
Rif
Z
Driving and parking
Canceling Active Parking Assist
163
Driving systems
164
Driving and parking
Rif
the area is lit by fluorescent light or LED
lighting (the display may flicker)
Rif there is a sudden change in temperature,
e.g. when driving into a heated garage from
the cold
Rif the camera lens is dirty or obstructed
Rif the rear of your vehicle is damaged. In this
case, have the camera position and setting
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
The field of vision and other functions of the
rear view camera may be restricted due to
additional accessories on the rear of the vehicle (e.g. license plate holder, bicycle rack).
Rthe
ball coupling of a trailer tow hitch
rear section of an HGV
Ra slanted post
Use the guidelines only for orientation.
Approach objects no further than the bottom-most guideline.
Rthe
Activating/deactivating the rear view
camera
To activate: make sure that the SmartKey
is in position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Make sure that the "Activation by R gear"
setting is active in the audio system/
COMAND (see the separate audio system/
COMAND operating instructions).
X Engage reverse gear.
Guide lines are used to show the area
behind the vehicle in the Audio/COMAND
display.
X
To deactivate: the rear view camera deactivates if you shift the transmission to P or after
driving forwards a short distance.
Lanes
: White guide line without turning the steer-
ing wheel, vehicle width including the
exterior mirrors (static)
; Yellow lane marking tires at current steering wheel angle, vehicle width to the outer
side of the wheels (dynamic)
= Red guide line for the vehicle width including the exterior mirrors, for current steering wheel angle (dynamic)
? Bumper
Displays in the Audio/COMAND display
The rear view camera may show a distorted
view of obstacles, show them incorrectly or
not at all. The rear view camera does not show
objects in the following positions:
Rvery
close to the rear bumper
Runder the rear bumper
Rin the area immediately above the tailgate
handle
! Objects not at ground level may appear to
be further away than they actually are, e.g.:
Rthe
Rthe
bumper of a parked vehicle
drawbar of a trailer
Guide lines
? Bumper
A Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 10 in (0.25 m) from the rear of the
vehicle
Driving systems
imately 13 ft (4.0 m) from the rear of the
vehicle
C Vehicle center axle (marker assistance)
D Yellow guide line at a distance of approximately 3 ft (1.0 m) from the rear of the
vehicle
Backing up straight into a parking space
without turning the steering wheel
The lanes and guide lines are only displayed if
you have engaged reverse gear.
The distance specifications only apply to
objects that are at ground level.
: White lane with steering wheel straight
; Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 3 ft (1.0 m) from the rear of the
vehicle
= Red guide line at a distance of approximately 10 in (0.25 m) from the rear of the
vehicle
Use white lane : to check whether the
vehicle will fit into the parking space.
X Using the white lane as a guide, carefully
back up until you reach the end position.
Red guide line = is then at the end of the
parking space. The vehicle is almost parallel in the parking space.
X
Additional displays on vehicles with PARKTRONIC
and COMAND
: Front warning display
; Additional PARKTRONIC measurement
operational readiness indicator
= Rear warning display
Vehicles with PARKTRONIC and COMAND:
when PARKTRONIC is operational, the additional measurement operational indicator
appears in the COMAND display. If the PARKTRONIC warning displays light up, warning
displays : and = in the COMAND display
are also active.
Reverse perpendicular parking with the
steering wheel at an angle
X Drive past the parking space and bring the
vehicle to a standstill.
"Reverse parking" function
X
Make sure that the rear view camera is
activated and the "Reverse parking" function is selected (see the separate operating
instructions for the audio system/
COMAND).
The lane and the guide lines are shown.
Z
Driving and parking
B Yellow guide line at a distance of approx-
165
Driving systems
Driving and parking
166
Turning the steering wheel
: Red lane indicating the route the vehicle
will take with the steering wheel in its current position
; Parking space marking
Driving to the final position
: White lane at current steering wheel angle
; Parking space marking
X
While the vehicle is at a standstill, turn the
steering wheel in the direction of the parking space until the red lane reaches parking
space marking ;.
X Keep the steering wheel in that position
and back up carefully.
Turn the steering wheel to the center position while the vehicle is stationary.
X
: Red guide line at a distance of approx-
imately 10 in (0.25 m) from the rear of the
vehicle
; White lane with steering wheel straight
= End of parking space
Backing up with the steering wheel turned
: Red lane indicating the route the vehicle
will take with the steering wheel in its current position
X
Stop the vehicle when it is almost exactly in
front of the parking space.
The white lane should be as close to parallel
with the parking space marking as possible.
X
Back up carefully until you have reached
the final position.
Red guide line : is then at end of parking
space =. The vehicle is almost parallel in
the parking space.
ATTENTION ASSIST
General notes
ATTENTION ASSIST helps you during long,
monotonous journeys, such as on highways.
It is active in the range between 50 mph
(80 km/h) and 112 mph (180 km/h).
If ATTENTION ASSIST detects typical indicators of fatigue or increasing lapses in concentration on the part of the driver, it suggests you take a break.
Important safety notes
ATTENTION ASSIST is only an aid to the
driver. It might not always recognize fatigue
or increasing inattentiveness in time or fail to
recognize them at all. The system is not a
substitute for a well-rested and attentive
driver.
ATTENTION ASSIST assesses your level of
fatigue or lapses in concentration by taking
the following criteria into account:
Ryour
personal driving style, e.g. steering
characteristics
Rjourney details, e.g. time of day and length
of journey
The functionality of ATTENTION ASSIST is
restricted and warnings may be delayed or
not occur at all:
Rif
the road condition is poor, e.g. if the surface is uneven or if there are potholes
Rif there is a strong side wind
Rif you have adopted a sporty driving style
with high cornering speeds or high rates of
acceleration
Rif you are predominantly driving slower
than 50 mph (80 km/h) or faster than
112 mph (180 km/h)
Rif you are currently using COMAND or making a telephone call with it
Rif the time has been set incorrectly
Rin active driving situations, such as when
you change lanes or change your speed
Warning and display messages in the
multifunction display
X
intermittent warning tone twice and the
Attention Assist: Take a Break!
message appears in the multifunction display.
X If necessary, take a break.
X Press the a or % button to confirm
the message.
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good
time to allow yourself to rest properly. If you
do not take a break, you will be warned again
after 15 minutes at the earliest. The precondition for this is that ATTENTION ASSIST still
detects typical indicators of fatigue or
increasing lapses in concentration.
ATTENTION ASSIST is reset when you continue your journey and starts assessing your
tiredness again if:
Ryou
switch off the drive system.
take off your seat belt and open the
driver's door, e.g. for a change of drivers or
to take a break.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated, the
é symbol appears in the multifunction
display in the assistance graphic display.
Ryou
Blind Spot Assist
General notes
Blind Spot Assist uses a radar sensor system
to monitor the areas on both sides of your
vehicle. It supports you from a speed of
approximately 20 mph (30 km/h). A warning
display in the exterior mirrors draws your
attention to vehicles detected in the monitored area. If you then switch on the corresponding turn signal to change lanes, you will
also receive a visual and audible collision
warning. For this purpose, Blind Spot Assist
uses sensors in the rear bumper.
Activate ATTENTION ASSIST using the onboard computer (Y page 184).
If ATTENTION ASSIST is active, you will be
warned no sooner than 20 minutes after
your journey has begun. You then hear an
Z
167
Driving and parking
Driving systems
168
Driving systems
Important safety notes
Driving and parking
G WARNING
Blind Spot Assist does not react to:
Vehicles in the monitoring range are then not
indicated.
Rvehicles
overtaken too closely on the side,
placing them in the blind spot area
Rvehicles which approach with a large speed
differential and overtake your vehicle
As a result, Blind Spot Assist may not give
warnings in such situations. There is a risk of
an accident.
Always observe the traffic conditions carefully, and maintain a safe lateral distance.
Blind Spot Assist is only an aid. It may fail to
detect some vehicles and is no substitute for
attentive driving.
i USA only:
This device has been approved by the FCC
as a "Vehicular Radar System". The radar
sensor is intended for use in an automotive
radar system only. Removing, tampering
with, or altering the device will void any
warranties, and is not permitted by the
FCC. Do not tamper with, alter, or use in
any non-approved way.
Any unauthorized modification to this
device could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
Monitoring range of the sensors
In particular, the detection of obstacles can
be impaired if:
Rthere is dirt on the sensors or anything else
covering the sensors
Rthere is poor visibility, e.g. due to fog, heavy
rain or snow
narrow vehicle traveling in front, e.g. a
motorbike or bicycle
Rthe road has very wide lanes
Rthe road has narrow lanes
Ryou are not driving in the middle of the lane
Rthere are barriers or similar lane borders
Ra
Blind Spot Assist monitors the area up to 10 ft
(3.0 m) behind your vehicle and directly next
to your vehicle, as shown in the diagram. For
this purpose, Blind Spot Assist uses radar
sensors in the rear bumper.
If the lanes are narrow, vehicles driving in the
lane beyond the lane next to your vehicle may
be indicated, especially if the vehicles are not
driving in the middle of their lane. This may be
the case as soon as the vehicles are driving on
the inner side of their lane.
Due to the nature of the system:
Rwarnings may be issued in error when driv-
ing close to crash barriers or similar solid
lane borders.
Rwarnings may be interrupted when driving
alongside particularly long vehicles, e.g.
trucks, for a prolonged time.
The two sensors for Blind Spot Assist are
integrated into the sides of the rear bumper.
Make sure that the bumper is free of dirt, ice
or slush in the vicinity of the sensors. For
example, the radar sensors must not be covered by bicycle racks or overhanging loads.
Following a severe impact or in the event of
damage to the bumpers, have the function of
the radar sensors checked at a qualified spe-
Driving systems
Warning and indicator lamps
Blind Spot Assist is not active at speeds below
approximately 20 mph (30 km/h). Vehicles in
the monitoring range are then not indicated.
the turn signal remains on, vehicles detected
are indicated by the flashing of red warning
lamp :. There are no further warning tones.
Switching on Blind Spot Assist
Make sure that Blind Spot Assist is activated in the on-board computer
(Y page 184).
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
Warning lamps : in the exterior mirrors
light up red for approximately 1.5 seconds
and then turn yellow.
X
: Red warning lamp/yellow indicator lamp
When Blind Spot Assist is activated, indicator
lamp : in the exterior mirrors lights up yellow at speeds of up to 20 mph (30 km/h). At
speeds above 20 mph (30 km/h), the indicator lamp goes out and Blind Spot Assist is
operational.
if a vehicle is detected at speeds of approximately 20 mph (30 km/h), warning lamp :
on the corresponding side lights up red. This
warning occurs when a vehicle enters the
blind spot monitoring range from behind or
from the side. When you overtake a vehicle,
the warning only occurs as long as the difference in speed is less than 7 mph (12 km/h).
The yellow indicator lamp goes out if reverse
gear is engaged. In this event, Blind Spot
Assist is no longer active.
The brightness of the warning/indicator
lamps is adjusted automatically according to
the ambient light.
Collision warning
If a vehicle is detected in the monitoring range
of Blind Spot Assist and you switch on the
corresponding turn signal, a double warning
tone sounds. Red warning lamp : flashes. If
Z
Driving and parking
cialist workshop. Blind Spot Assist may otherwise not work properly.
169
170
Useful information ............................ 172
Important safety notes .................... 172
Displays and operation .................... 172
Menus and submenus ...................... 176
Display messages ............................. 190
Warning and indicator lamps in the
instrument cluster ............................ 216
On-board computer and displays
171
On-board computer and displays
172
Displays and operation
Useful information
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you operate information systems and communication equipment integrated in the vehicle while driving, you will be distracted from
traffic conditions. You could also lose control
of the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate the equipment when the traffic
situation permits. If you are not sure that this
is possible, park the vehicle paying attention
to traffic conditions and operate the equipment when the vehicle is stationary.
G WARNING
If the instrument cluster has failed or malfunctioned, you may not recognize function
restrictions in systems relevant to safety. The
operating safety of your vehicle may be
impaired. There is a risk of an accident.
Drive on carefully. Have the vehicle checked
at a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
You must observe the legal requirements for
the country in which you are currently driving
when operating the on-board computer.
The on-board computer only shows messages
or warnings from certain systems in the multifunction display. You should therefore make
sure your vehicle is operating safely at all
times. Otherwise, a vehicle that is not operating safely may cause an accident.
If the operating safety of your vehicle is
impaired, pull over as soon as it is safe to do
so. Contact a qualified specialist workshop.
For an overview, see the instrument panel
illustration (Y page 31).
Displays and operation
Instrument cluster lighting
The lighting in the instrument cluster, in the
displays and the controls in the vehicle interior can be adjusted using the brightness control knob.
The brightness control knob is located on the
bottom left of the instrument cluster
(Y page 31).
X Turn the brightness control knob clockwise
or counter-clockwise.
If the light switch is set to Ã, T or
L, the brightness is dependent upon
the brightness of the ambient light.
i The light sensor in the instrument cluster
automatically controls the brightness of
the multifunction display.
In daylight, the displays in the instrument
cluster are not illuminated.
READY indicator
When the drive system is started and the
vehicle is ready to drive, READY indicator :
appears in the multifunction display. This indicates that the vehicle is operational.
Outside temperature display
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around freezing point.
Bear in mind that the outside temperature
display indicates the temperature measured
and does not record the road temperature.
The outside temperature display is in the multifunction display (Y page 176).
Changes in the outside temperature are displayed after a short delay.
Rvery
low condition of charge of the highvoltage battery
Ra malfunction in the drive system
The reduced power output can be improved
by charging the high-voltage battery
(Y page 134).
Power display
E-CELL display
Power display : contains two areas:
RArea
G WARNING
There is a risk of an accident if you accelerate
or overtake when the power output of the
drive system is reduced.
You should therefore adapt your driving style
and drive particularly carefully. Charge the
high-voltage battery at a charge station immediately.
X
Start the drive system (Y page 127).
E-CELL display : shows the available
power of the drive system.
Under normal operating conditions, E-CELL
display : is in the maximum range.
The power output available may deviate from
the maximum range in the event of:
Rvery
high or low outside temperatures
high performance requirements for a
longer period of time
Rvery
above 0
Here, the current amount of power that the
drive system is feeding to the wheels is displayed.
RArea below 0
Here, the vehicle's recuperative power in
overrun mode is displayed.
If the needle for the power display is in the
OFF position, the vehicle is not ready to drive
because:
Rthe
drive system has not yet started
charging cable is still connected to the
vehicle socket
Rthere is insufficient power available from
the high-voltage battery
Rthe vehicle's high-voltage electrical system
is malfunctioning
When the drive system is started, the needle
in the power display moves to position 0. The
display Ready appears in the lower multifunction display. The vehicle is ready to drive.
The boost area for maximum acceleration can
be reached using kickdown (Y page 131).
Rthe
Z
173
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation
On-board computer and displays
174
Displays and operation
The braking performance of the electric
motor using recuperative braking is, in some
operating modes, either reduced or not effective:
The braking performance of the electric
motor using recuperative braking is, in some
operating modes, either reduced or not effective:
Rwhen
Rwhen
the condition of charge of the highvoltage battery increases
Rif the high-voltage battery is not yet at a
normal operating temperature
Rwhen the vehicle is almost stationary
Rin transmission position N
Rduring and after ESP stability control
If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake
yourself.
Charge level display
the condition of charge of the highvoltage battery increases
Rif the high-voltage battery is not yet at a
normal operating temperature
Rwhen the vehicle is almost stationary
Rin transmission position N
Rduring and after ESP stability control
If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake
yourself.
Operating the on-board computer
Overview
Condition of charge display : shows the
condition of charge of the high-voltage battery. The charge values are shown as a percentage in the COMAND display (see the separate operating instructions).
The condition of charge of the high-voltage
battery has dropped into the reserve range if
the drive system is running and:
Rthe Drive
Battery Reserve Level message appears in the display
Rthe indicator lamp in the instrument cluster
lights up
i Charge the high-voltage battery from a
condition of charge of less than 20% at:
Ran
Ra
electrical outlet
charging station
: Multifunction display
; Switches on the Voice Control System
(see the separate operating instructions)
= Right control panel
? Left control panel
A Back button
X
To activate the on-board computer: turn
the SmartKey to position 1 in the ignition
lock.
You can control the multifunction display and
the settings in the on-board computer using
the buttons on the multifunction steering
wheel.
Left control panel
=
;
RCalls
9
:
a
~
RRejects
RExits
ory
6
or ends a call
phone book/redial mem-
RMakes
or accepts a call
to the redial memory
RSwitches
up the menu and menu bar
RAdjusts
Press briefly:
W
X
RScrolls
8
RMute
in lists
a submenu or function
RIn the Audio menu: selects a
stored station, an audio track or
a video scene
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
switches to the phone book and
selects a name or telephone
number
RSelects
9
:
Right control panel
Back button
%
Press briefly:
RBack
RSwitches
off the Voice Control
System (see the separate operating instructions)
RHides display messages/calls
up the last Trip menu function
used
RExits the telephone book/redial
memory
Press and hold:
the Audio menu: selects the
previous/next station or selects
an audio track or a video scene
using rapid scrolling
RIn the Tel (telephone) menu:
starts rapid scrolling through the
phone book
the volume
RIn
%
Press and hold:
RCalls
up the standard display in
the Trip menu
RConfirms
a selection/display
message
RIn the Tel (Telephone) menu:
switches to the telephone book
and starts dialing the selected
number
RIn the Audio menu: stops the
station search function at the
desired station
Z
175
On-board computer and displays
Displays and operation
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
176
Multifunction display
Menus and submenus
Menu overview
Operating the on-board computer
(Y page 174).
Depending on the equipment installed in the
vehicle, you can call up the following menus:
RTrip
menu (Y page 176)
menu (navigation instructions)
(Y page 179)
RAudio menu (Y page 180)
RTel menu (telephone) (Y page 181)
RDriveAssist menu (assistance)
(Y page 183)
RServ. menu (Y page 184)
RSett menu (Y page 185)
The Audio
Audio, Navi and Tel menus differ slightly
in vehicles with an audio system and in vehicles with COMAND. The examples given in
this Operator's Manual apply to vehicles
equipped with COMAND.
RNavi
Multifunction display
: Range
; Time
= Text field
? Menu bar
A Drive program
B Permanent display: outside temperature
or speed(Y page 187)
C Transmission position(Y page 129)
X
To show menu bar ?: press the =
or ; button on the steering wheel.
Trip menu
Standard display
Menu bar ? disappears after a few seconds.
Text field = shows the selected menu or
submenu as well as display messages.
i You can set the time using the Audio sys-
tem or COMAND (see the separate operating instructions).
The following messages may appear in the
multifunction display:
XjY
¯
CRUISE
ë
Active Parking Assist (Y page 159)
Cruise control (Y page 152)
Cruise control (Y page 152)
HOLD function (Y page 154)
Standard display
X
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
The Trip menu with trip odometer : and
odometer ; is shown.
Digital speedometer
The From Reset trip computer is automatically reset if the value exceeds 999 hours or
9999 miles.
Resetting values
Digital speedometer
: Digital speedometer
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
digital speedometer.
X
Trip computer "From Start" or "From
Reset"
"From Start" trip computer
: Distance
; Time
= Average speed
? Average electrical consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
From Start or From Reset.
Reset
X
The values in the From Start submenu are
calculated from the start of a journey whilst
the values in the From Reset submenu are
calculated from the last time the submenu
was reset (Y page 177).
The From Start trip computer is automatically reset when:
Rthe ignition has been switched off for more
than 4 hours.
R999 hours have been exceeded.
R9,999 miles have been exceeded.
Resetting the "From start" trip computer
You can reset the values of the following functions:
RTrip
odometer
Start" trip computer
R"From Reset" trip computer
RECO display
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
function that you wish to reset.
X Press the a button.
X Press the : button to select Yes and
press the a button to confirm.
R"From
i When you reset the values in the "ECO
display", the values in the trip computer
"From Start" are likewise reset. When you
reset the values in the trip computer "From
Start", the values in the "ECO display" are
likewise reset.
ECO display
ECO display
Z
177
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
178
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ECO DISPLAY.
DISPLAY
X
If the ignition remains switched off for longer
than 4 hours, the ECO display will be automatically reset.
Further information on the ECO display
(Y page 148).
Displaying the range and current consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Confirm by pressing a on the steering
wheel.
X Use : or 9 to select Energy Flow.
Flow
The active components are highlighted in
the energy flow display.
i The energy flow is indicated by arrows.
The arrows have a different color depending on the operating state:
X
RGreen:
energy recuperation
normal energy consumption
RRed: increased energy consumption
RWhite:
Drive system switched on when the vehicle is stationary or in overrun mode
Range and current consumption
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Trip menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to view the
approximate range and current consumption.
X
The approximate range depends on the condition of charge of the high-voltage battery
and your current driving style. If the high-voltage battery condition of charge is low, the
display shows a vehicle being charged
instead of the approximate range.
The specified values for range depend on the
driving program selected and may vary as a
result of:
The drive system is switched on while the
vehicle is stationary. Alternatively, the drive
system is switched on while the vehicle is in
transmission position D+ or N.
The arrows indicating energy flow are not
shown.
Drive system switched off and high-voltage battery being charged
Rhigher
and lower outside temperatures
style of driving
Ractivated electrical consumers
Rthe
Energy flow
The energy flow display can be displayed in
the multifunction display and in the COMAND
display (see separate operating instructions).
The drive system is switched off. The charging
cable is connected and the high-voltage battery is being charged.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
green.
Normal driving
Navigation system menu
Displaying navigation instructions
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
(see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Navi menu.
X
The drive system powers the vehicle.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
white.
Boost driving mode
In the Navi menu, the multifunction display
shows navigation instructions. You can find
further information in the separate operating
instructions.
Route guidance not active
The boost mode takes effect if you depress
the accelerator pedal quickly.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
red.
Route guidance not active
: Direction of travel
; Current road
Energy recuperation mode
Route guidance active
No change of direction announced
The kinetic energy of the vehicle is converted
into electrical energy. The high-voltage battery is being charged.
The arrows for the energy flow are shown in
green.
No change of direction announced
: Distance to the destination
; Distance to the next change of direction
= Current road
? "Follow the road's course" symbol
Z
179
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
180
Menus and submenus
Change of direction announced without a
lane recommendation
Lane recommendations are only displayed if
the relevant data is available on the digital
map.
Other status indicators of the navigation system
RO: you have reached the destination or an
Change of direction announced without a lane recommendation
: Road into which the change of direction
leads
; Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
= Change-of-direction symbol
When a change of direction is announced, you
will see symbol = for the change of direction
and distance graphic ;. The distance indicator shortens towards the top of the display
as you approach the point of the announced
change of direction.
intermediate destination.
Route... or Calculating Route:
Route
calculating a new route
ROff Map or Off Mapped Road
Road: the vehicle
position is outside the area of the digital
map (off-map position).
RNo Route:
Route no route could be calculated to
the selected destination.
RNew
Audio menu
Selecting a radio station
Change of direction announced with a
lane recommendation
Example: radio station (multifunction display)
: Waveband
; Channel frequency with memory position
Change of direction announced with a lane recommendation
: Road into which the change of direction
;
=
?
A
B
leads
Distance to change of direction and visual
distance display
New lane during a change of direction
Uninterrupted lane
Lane recommendation
Change-of-direction symbol
On multilane roads, the system can display
lane recommendation = for the next change
of direction. During the change of direction,
additional lanes may be displayed.
i The memory position is only displayed
along with station ; if this has been
stored.
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
and select Radio (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select a stored station: briefly press
the 9 or : button.
X
To select a station from the station list:
press and briefly hold the 9 or :
button.
If no station list is received:
X To select a station using the station
search: press and briefly hold the 9
or : button.
audio drives or data carriers support this
function.
X
i Information on how to switch wavebands
and store stations can be found in the separate operating instructions.
If track information is stored on the audio
device or medium, the multifunction display
will show the number and title of the track.
The current track does not appear in audio
AUX mode (Auxiliary audio mode: external
audio source connected).
Video DVD operation
i SIRIUS XM satellite radio functions like a
normal radio.
You can find further information on operating the satellite radio in the separate operating instructions.
Operating audio devices or media
Example: CD/DVD changer display (multifunction
display)
: Current scene
Switch on COMAND and select video DVD
(see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous scene:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a scene from the scene list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired scene : has
been reached.
X
Example: CD/DVD changer display (multifunction
display)
: Current title
Audio data from various audio devices or
media can be played, depending on the equipment installed in the vehicle.
Switch on the audio system or COMAND
and select audio CD, audio DVD or MP3
mode (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Audio menu.
X To select the next/previous track:
briefly press the 9 or : button.
X To select a track from the track list
(rapid scrolling): press and hold the 9
or : button until desired track : has
been reached.
If you press and hold 9 or :, the
rapid scrolling speed is increased. Not all
X
Telephone menu
Introduction
G WARNING
If you operate information systems and communication equipment integrated in the vehicle while driving, you will be distracted from
traffic conditions. You could also lose control
of the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
Only operate the equipment when the traffic
situation permits. If you are not sure that this
is possible, park the vehicle paying attention
Z
181
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
182
Menus and submenus
to traffic conditions and operate the equipment when the vehicle is stationary.
When telephoning, you must observe the
legal requirements for the country in which
you are currently driving.
X Switch on the mobile phone and audio system or COMAND (see the separate operating instructions).
X Establish a Bluetooth® connection to the
audio system or COMAND (see the separate operating instructions).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
You will see one of the following display messages in the multifunction display:
RPlease
Enter PIN
PIN: the mobile phone has
been placed in the mobile phone bracket
and the PIN has not been entered.
When you enter your PIN via the mobile
phone, the Voice Control System, the audio
system or COMAND, the mobile phone
searches for a network.
RPhone READY or the name of the network
provider: the mobile phone has found a
network and is ready to receive.
RPhone No Service:
Service there is no network
available or the mobile phone is searching
for a network.
i You can obtain further information about
suitable mobile phones and connecting
mobile phones via Bluetooth®:
Rfrom
your authorized Mercedes-Benz
Center
Ron the Internet at http://
www.mercedes-benz.com/connect
Accepting a call
Example: incoming call (multifunction display)
X
Press the 6 button on the steering
wheel to accept an incoming call.
If someone calls you when you are in the Tel
menu, a display message appears in the multifunction display.
You can accept a call even if you are not in the
Tel menu.
Rejecting or ending a call
X
Press the ~ button on the steering
wheel.
You can end or reject a call even if you are not
in the Tel menu.
Dialing a number from the phone book
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 9, : or a button to
switch to the phone book.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name.
To start scrolling rapidly, press and hold the
9 or : button for longer than one
second.
Rapid scrolling stops when you release the
button or reach the end of the list.
X If only one telephone number is stored
for a name: press the 6 or a button
to start dialing.
or
X If there is more than one number for a
particular name: press the 6 or a
button to display the numbers.
X
Press the 9 or : button to select the
number you want to dial.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialing.
or
X If you do not want to make a call: press
the ~ or % button.
X
Redialing
The on-board computer saves the last names
or numbers dialed in the redial memory.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Tel menu.
X Press the 6 button to switch to the
redial memory.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
desired name or number.
X Press the 6 or a button to start dialing.
or
X If you do not want to make a call: press
the ~ or % button.
X
RActivating/deactivating
ATTENTION
ASSIST (Y page 184)
RActivating/deactivating Blind Spot Assist
(Y page 184)
Displaying the assistance graphic
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the DriveAssist menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Assistance
graphic.
graphic
X Press the a button.
X
The assistance graphic can display the status
of and information from other driving systems
or driving safety systems.
The assistance graphic shows:
Rthe
è symbol, when the rear window
wiper (Y page 109) is activated.
Rthe é symbol when ATTENTION ASSIST
(Y page 166) is deactivated.
Deactivating/activating ESP®
i Observe the "Important safety notes" section in the description of ESP (Y page 67).
Assistance menu
Introduction
G WARNING
If you deactivate ESP®, ESP® no longer stabilizes the vehicle. There is an increased risk
of skidding and an accident.
Only deactivate ESP® in the situations described in the following.
It may be best to deactivate ESP® in the following situations:
Example: Assistance menu view options
In the DriveAssist menu, you have the following options:
RDisplaying the assistance graphic
(Y page 183)
RDeactivating/activating ESP®
(Y page 183)
RActivating/deactivating the distance warning system (Y page 184)
Rwhen
using snow chains
deep snow
Ron sand or gravel
For further information about ESP®, see
(Y page 66).
X Start the drive system.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the DriveAssist menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ESP.
ESP
Rin
Z
183
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
184
Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
When ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated,
the é symbol appears in the multifunction display in the assistance graphics display.
X
Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
ESP® is deactivated if the å warning
lamp in the instrument cluster lights up
continuously when the drive system is running.
X
If the ÷ warning lamp and the å warning lamp are lit continuously, ESP® is not
available due to a malfunction.
Observe the information on warning lamps
(Y page 221).
Observe the information on display messages
(Y page 191).
For further information about ATTENTION
ASSIST, see (Y page 166).
Activating/deactivating the distance
warning function
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the DriveAssist menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Distance
Warning.
Warning
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
If the distance warning function is activated, the multifunction display does not display a symbol.
When the distance warning function is
deactivated, the æ symbol appears in
the multifunction display in the assistance
graphics display.
X
Activating/deactivating Blind Spot
Assist
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the DriveAssist.
menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Blind Spot Assist.
Assist
X Press the a button.
The current selection is displayed.
X To activate/deactivate: press the a
button again.
X
For further information about Blind Spot
Assist, see (Y page 167).
When the Blind Spot Assist Sensors
Deactivated message is shown, the radar
sensor system is deactivated.
X Switch on the radar sensor system
(Y page 188).
Maintenance menu
Further information on the distance warning
function (Y page 64).
Activating/deactivating ATTENTION
ASSIST
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the DriveAssist menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
ATTENTION ASSIST.
ASSIST
X
Service menu view options
In the Serv. menu, you have the following
options:
RCalling
up display messages in message
memory (Y page 190)
RChecking the tire pressure electronically
(Y page 286)
RCalling up the service due date
(Y page 254)
Settings menu
Introduction
Press a to confirm.
You will see the selected setting.
X Press : or 9 to select A, B or C
Change.
Change
X Press = or ; to select Departure
Time Hours.
Hours
X Press the 9 or : button to set the
hour.
X Press = or ; to select Departure
Time Minutes.
Minutes
X Press 9 or : to set the minutes.
X Press a to confirm.
After changing from one menu to another,
the departure time setting is stored.
X
Selecting the departure time
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the 9 or : button on the steering wheel to select the E‑CELL menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Departure
Time.
Time
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select
one of the three departure times or Timer
Off (no timer active).
X Press a to confirm.
X
Example: settings menu view
In the Sett. menu, you have the following
options:
RChanging the E-CELL settings
RChanging the instrument cluster settings
RChanging the light settings
RChanging the vehicle settings
RRestoring the factory settings
E‑CELL menu
Departure time
In the E‑CELL menu you can choose to cool
down or heat the vehicle interior for a predefined departure time.
If you have selected Park P, the on-board
computer displays the expected battery
charge time or the RANGE PLUS condition of
charge for the departure time set.
Changing the departure time
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Press the 9 or : button on the steering wheel to select the E‑CELL menu.
X Press 9 or : to select Departure
Time.
Time
X
Charging with RANGE PLUS
If you have selected Park P, the on-board
computer displays the expected battery
charge time or the RANGE PLUS condition of
charge for the departure time set.
RANGE PLUS charges when:
Ryou
have activated RANGE PLUS via the
center console prior to charging and
Rthe high-voltage battery is fully charged.
If charging is not complete by departure time,
the maximum range will not be available.
Z
185
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
186
If a departure time is selected, the yellow
indicator lamp lights up on the auxiliary
heating button.
Example:
RSet
departure time: 6:41 a.m.
REnd time for standard high-voltage battery
charging: 6:00 a.m.
RRANGE PLUS condition of charge at
6:41 a.m.: 50%
RThe maximum additional range is
decreased by 50 percent.
Pre-entry climate control at time of departure
If you activate the "Rem. Climate Control at
departure time" function, the vehicle interior
is heated or cooled prior to a desired departure time.
i To heat or cool the vehicle interior for a
desired departure time, the high-voltage
battery must be sufficiently charged. Activate the climate control function primarily
when the high-voltage battery is being
charged. You must also set a departure
time using the E-CELL submenu
(Y page 185).
Switching "Pre-entry climate control at departure time" on/off
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Use 9 or : to select the E-CELL
submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press 9 or : to select Rem. Cli‐
mate Control At Departure Time.
Time
X Press a to activate or deactivate.
The vehicle interior will then be heated or
cooled prior to the predefined departure
time.
X
You can use the on-board computer to specify
up to three departure times in the E-CELL
submenu. One of the specified departure
times may be preselected (Y page 185).
Pre-entry climate control (via SmartKey)
Pre-entry climate control (via SmartKey) is
switched on temporarily when the vehicle is
unlocked using the SmartKey. In order to
switch on pre-entry climate control via the
SmartKey, the function has to be activated
using the on-board computer.
Activating/deactivating pre-entry climate
control (via SmartKey)
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Settings menu.
X Use 9 or : to select the E-CELL
submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press 9 or : to select Pre-Entry
Climate Cont. (Via Key).
Key)
X Press a to activate or deactivate.
If pre-entry climate control (via SmartKey)
is activated, pre-entry climate control (via
SmartKey) is switched on temporarily when
you unlock the vehicle.
X
Setting the maximum charge current
Before charging the high-voltage battery,
check the maximum permissible charge current for the relevant power socket.
You can set a maximum charge current in the
E‑CELL menu.
It is only necessary to select the maximum
charge current if there are no charge current
settings on the charging cable.
i The maximum charge current values in
the on-board computer may deviate from
the charging cable values.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Display Unit Speed-/Odometer function.
You will see the selected setting: km or
miles.
miles
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Example: changing the charge current
: Setting the maximum charge current
i This menu is not available in some coun-
tries. In this case, the maximum charge
current for the power socket is limited to a
fixed level, depending on the country concerned.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.
X Use 9 or : to select the E-CELL
submenu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Max. Charge Current.
Current
X Press a to confirm.
X Press 9 or : in the submenu to
select desired maximum charge current :.
X Press the a button on the multifunction
steering wheel to confirm.
The high-voltage battery is charged with
the selected maximum charge current.
X
Instrument cluster
Selecting the display unit
You can determine whether the multifunction
display shows some messages in miles or
kilometers.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument Cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X
The selected unit of measurement for distance applies to:
Rthe
digital speedometer in the Trip menu
odometer and the trip odometer
Rthe trip computer
Rthe current consumption and the range
Rnavigation instructions in the Navi menu
Rcruise control
RASSYST PLUS service interval display
Rthe
Selecting the permanent display function
You can determine whether the multifunction
display permanently shows your speed or the
outside temperature.
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Instrument Cluster submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Permanent Display: function.
You will see the selected setting: Outside
Temperature or Speedometer [km/h].
[km/h]
X Press the a button to save the setting.
X
Lights
Switching the daytime running lamps on/
off
Canada only: daytime running lamps are
required by law. You cannot set the Daytime
Running Lights function via the on-board
computer.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
Z
187
On-board computer and displays
Menus and submenus
Menus and submenus
On-board computer and displays
188
X
Vehicle
Further information on daytime running
lamps (Y page 98).
Activating/deactivating the automatic
door locking mechanism
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Automatic Door Lock function.
When the Automatic Door Lock function
is activated, the vehicle doors are displayed
in orange in the multifunction display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Press the : or 9 button to select the
Daytime Running Lights function.
If the Daytime Running Lights function
has been switched on, the cone of light and
the W symbol in the multifunction display are shown in orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Setting the brightness of the ambient
lighting
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Amb. Light +/- function.
X Press the a button to change the settings.
X Press the : or 9 button to adjust the
brightness to a level from Off to Level 5
(bright).
X Press the a or % button to save the
setting.
Activating/deactivating the interior lighting delayed switch-off
If you activate the Interior Lighting
Delay function, the interior lighting remains
on for 20 seconds after you remove the key
from the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Light submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Interior Lighting Delay function.
If the Interior Lighting Delay function
has been switched on, the vehicle interior is
displayed in orange in the multifunction
display.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
If you activate the Automatic Door Lock
function, the vehicle is centrally locked above
a speed of approximately 9 mph (15 km/h).
For further information on the automatic locking feature, see (Y page 78).
Activating/deactivating the acoustic
locking verification signal
If you switch on the Acoustic Lock Feed‐
back function, an acoustic signal sounds
when you lock the vehicle.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett. menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Acoustic Lock function.
If the Acoustic Lock function is activated,
the & symbol in the multifunction display lights up orange.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
Activating/deactivating the radar sensor
system
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Vehicle submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
Menus and submenus
Press the 9 or : button to select
Radar Sensor (See Oper. Manual):.
Manual):
You will see the selected setting: Enabled
or Disabled
Disabled.
X Press the a button to save the setting.
On-board computer and displays
X
189
If the radar sensor system is switched off,
Blind Spot Assist is deactivated (Y page 167).
Restoring the factory settings
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Sett menu.
X Press the : or 9 button to select the
Factory setting submenu.
X Press a to confirm.
The Reset All Settings? message
appears.
X Press the : or 9 button to select No
or Yes
Yes.
X Press a to confirm the selection.
If you have selected Yes
Yes, the multifunction
display shows a confirmation message.
X
For safety reasons, the Daytime Running
Lights function in the Light submenu is only
reset if the vehicle is stationary.
Z
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
190
Display messages
General notes
Display messages appear in the multifunction display.
Display messages with graphic displays may be shown in simplified form in the Operator's
Manual and may therefore differ from the multifunction display.
Please respond in accordance with the display messages and follow the additional notes in this
Operator's Manual.
Certain display messages are accompanied by an audible warning tone or a continuous tone.
When the ignition is switched off, all display messages are deleted, apart from some highpriority display messages. Once the causes of the high-priority display messages have been
rectified, the corresponding display messages are also deleted.
When you stop and park the vehicle, please observe the notes on the HOLD function
(Y page 154) and parking (Y page 144).
Hiding display messages
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel to hide the display message.
The display message is cleared.
The multifunction display shows high-priority display messages in red. Some high-priority display messages cannot be hidden.
The multifunction display shows these messages continuously until the causes for the messages have been remedied.
Message memory
The on-board computer saves certain display messages in the message memory. You can call
up the display messages:
Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Service menu.
If there are display messages, the multifunction display shows 2 Messages,
Messages for example.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the entry, e.g. 2 Messages.
Messages
X Press a to confirm.
X Press the 9 or : button to scroll through the display messages.
X
Safety systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!÷
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System), ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), BAS (Brake Assist), RBS (Recuperative Brake System), the
HOLD function and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, é, å and ! warning lamps light up
in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Possible causes are:
Currently Unavail‐
able See Opera‐
tor's Manual
Rself-diagnosis
Rthe
is not yet complete.
on-board voltage may be insufficient.
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Carefully drive a short distance on a suitable stretch of road,
making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph
(20 km/h).
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
!÷
Inoperative See
Operator's Manual
ABS, ESP®, BAS, RBS, the HOLD function and hill start assist are
not available due to a malfunction.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST may also have failed.
In addition, the J, é, ÷, å and ! warning lamps
light up in the instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Z
191
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
192
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP®, BAS, RBS, the HOLD function and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, é and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
The self-diagnosis function might not be complete, for example.
Currently Unavail‐
able See Opera‐
tor's Manual
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Carefully drive a short distance on a suitable stretch of road,
making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph
(20 km/h).
If the display message disappears, the functions mentioned
above are available again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
X
Drive on carefully.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
193
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
194
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷
ESP®, BAS, RBS, the HOLD function and hill start assist are not
available due to a malfunction.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷, é and å warning lamps light up in the
instrument cluster.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Inoperative See
Operator's Manual
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
T!
÷
EBD (electronic brake force distribution), ABS, ESP®, BAS, RBS,
the HOLD function and hill start assist are not available due to a
malfunction.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST may also have failed.
In addition, the ÷,é, å and ! warning lamps in the
instrument cluster light up and a warning tone sounds.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Inoperative See
Operator's Manual
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
é
Inoperative See
Operator's Manual
RBS (Recuperative Brake System) is unavailable due to a malfunction.
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
X Drive on taking extra care.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
195
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
196
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
F(USA
only)!(Canada
The red F (USA only)/! (Canada only) indicator lamp
flashes and a warning tone sounds. A condition for automatic
release of the electric parking brake is not fulfilled (Y page 145).
You are driving with the electric parking brake applied.
X Release the electric parking brake manually.
only)
Please Release
Parking Brake
F(USA
only)!(Canada
only)
Parking Brake See
Operator's Manual
The red F (USA only)/! (Canada only) indicator lamp
flashes and a warning tone sounds.
You are using the electric parking brake for emergency braking
(Y page 145).
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To apply:
Switch the ignition off.
Press the electric parking brake handle for at least 10 seconds.
X Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to P.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
The yellow ! warning lamp and the red F (USA only)/!
(Canada only) indicator lamp light up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
or
X
Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 145).
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
X
Do not drive on.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
The red F (USA only)/! (Canada only) indicator lamp
flashes and the yellow ! warning lamp lights up.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
To release:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Release the electric parking brake manually.
To apply:
X
X
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
Apply the electric parking brake manually.
If the red F (USA only)/! (Canada only) indicator lamp
continues to flash:
Do not drive on.
Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to P.
X Turn the front wheels towards the curb.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X
X
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red F (USA
only)/! (Canada only) indicator lamp flashes for about
10 seconds after the electric parking brake has been applied or
released. It then goes out or remains lit.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning.
X Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
If it is not possible to engage the electric parking brake:
X
X
Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to P.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If it is not possible to release the electric parking brake:
X
Release the electric parking brake automatically (Y page 145).
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
197
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
On-board computer and displays
198
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. If you manually apply or
release the electric parking brake, the red F (USA only)/!
(Canada only) indicator lamp flashes.
The electric parking brake is malfunctioning. It is not possible to
apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Shift the transmission to P.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
F(USA
only)!(Canada
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up. The red F (USA
only)/! (Canada only) indicator lamp flashes for about
10 seconds after the electric parking brake has been applied or
released. It then goes out or remains lit.
only)
Parking Brake Inop‐ The electric parking brake is malfunctioning, e.g. because of overvoltage or undervoltage.
erative
X Rectify the cause of the overvoltage or undervoltage, e.g. by
charging the battery or restarting the drive system.
X Engage or release the electric parking brake.
If it remains impossible to apply or release the electric parking
brake:
Switch off the ignition and turn it back on.
X Engage or release the electric parking brake.
X
If the electric parking brake still cannot be released:
X
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The display message is only shown while the vehicle is in motion.
The yellow ! warning lamp lights up and the red F (USA
only)/ ! (Canada only) indicator lamp flashes.
It is not possible to apply the electric parking brake manually.
X Shift the DIRECT SELECT lever to P.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
F(USA
only)!(Canada
only)
Turn On the Igni‐
tion to Release
the Parking Brake
The red F (USA only)/! (Canada only) indicator lamp lights
up.
You attempted to release the electric parking brake while the ignition was switched off.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 1 in the ignition lock.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
$(USA
only)J(Canada
There is not enough brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
In addition, the $ (USA only)/J (Canada only) warning
lamp lights up in the instrument cluster and a warning tone
sounds.
only)
Check Brake Fluid
Level
#
Check Brake Pad
Wear
G
Inoperative
G WARNING
The braking effect may be impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Do not add brake fluid. This does not correct the malfunction.
The brake pads/linings have reached their wear limit.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
One or more main features of the mbrace system are malfunctioning.
X Have the mbrace system checked immediately at a qualified
specialist workshop.
Z
199
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
200
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
PRE-SAFE
Functions Cur‐
rently Limited See
Operator's Manual
Adaptive Brake Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes
are:
Rthe
front bumper is dirty.
Rfunction is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
Rthe system is outside the operating temperature range.
Rthe on-board voltage is too low.
When the causes stated above no longer apply, the display message disappears.
Adaptive Brake Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 144).
X Clean the front bumper (Y page 259).
X Start the drive system again.
X
Adaptive Brake Assist is faulty. The distance warning signal may
PRE-SAFE
also have failed.
Functions Limited
See Operator's Man‐ X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
ual
6
SRS Malfunction
Service Required
The restraint system is faulty. The 6 warning lamp also lights
up in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be
triggered.
There is an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Further information on occupant safety (Y page 40).
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
The restraint system has malfunctioned at the front on the left or
right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument clusFront Left Malfunc‐ ter.
tion Service
G WARNING
Required or Front
Right Malfunction
The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be trigService Required
gered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be
triggered.
There is an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
6
Rear Left Malfunc‐
tion Service
Required or Rear
Right Malfunction
Service Required
6
Rear Center Mal‐
function Service
Required
6
Left Side Curtain
Airbag Malfunction
Service Required
or Right Side Cur‐
tain Airbag Mal‐
function Service
Required
The restraint system has malfunctioned at the rear on the left or
right. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be
triggered.
There is an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
The restraint system has malfunctioned at the rear center. The
6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument cluster.
G WARNING
The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be
triggered.
There is an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
There is a malfunction in the left-hand or right-hand window curtain air bag. The 6 warning lamp also lights up in the instrument
cluster.
G WARNING
The left or right window curtain air bag may either be triggered
unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be triggered.
There is an increased risk of injury.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
201
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
202
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The front-passenger air bag is deactivated during the journey, even
Front Passenger
though:
Airbag Disabled
See Operator's Man‐ Ran adult
ual
or
Ra person larger than a certain size is occupying the frontpassenger seat
If additional forces are applied to the seat, the system may interpret the occupant's weight as lower than it actually is.
G WARNING
The front-passenger air bag does not deploy during an accident.
There is an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Have the occupant get out of the vehicle.
X Keep the seat unoccupied, close the front-passenger door and
switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp in the
center console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Rthe
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must light up and
remain lit. If the indicator lamp is on, OCS has disabled the frontpassenger air bag (Y page 49).
Rthe Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See Operator's
Manual or Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See Oper‐
ator's Manual display messages must not appear in the multifunction display.
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are fulfilled, the front-passenger seat can be
occupied again. Whether the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit or goes out depends on how OCS classifies the
occupant.
If the conditions are not fulfilled, the system is not operating correctly.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
For further information about the Occupant Classification System,
see (Y page 49).
Front Passenger
Airbag Enabled See
Operator's Manual
The front-passenger air bag is enabled during the journey, even
though:
Ra
child, a small adult or an object weighing less than the system's weight threshold is located on the front-passenger seat
or
Rthe front-passenger seat is unoccupied
The system may detect objects or forces applying additional
weight on the seat.
G WARNING
The air bag may deploy unintentionally.
There is an increased risk of injury.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Switch the ignition off.
X Open the front-passenger door.
X Remove the child and the child restraint system from the frontpassenger seat.
X Make sure that there are no objects on the seat adding to the
weight.
The system may otherwise detect the additional weight and
interpret the seat occupant's weight as greater than it actually
is.
X Keep the seat unoccupied, close the front-passenger door and
switch on the ignition.
X Observe the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp in the
center console and the multifunction display and check the following:
Seat unoccupied and ignition switched on:
Rthe
PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp must light up and
remain lit. If the indicator lamp is on, OCS (Occupant Classification System) has disabled the front-passenger air bag
(Y page 49).
Rthe Front Passenger Airbag Enabled See Operator's
Manual or Front Passenger Airbag Disabled See Oper‐
ator's Manual display messages must appear in the multifunction display.
Z
203
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
204
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
X Wait for a period of at least 60 seconds until the necessary system checks have been completed.
X Make sure that the display messages do not appear in the multifunction display.
If these conditions are fulfilled, the front-passenger seat can be
occupied again. Whether the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator
lamp remains lit or goes out depends on how OCS classifies the
occupant.
If the conditions are not fulfilled, the system is not operating correctly.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
For further information about the Occupant Classification System,
see (Y page 49).
Lights
i Display messages about LEDs:
This display message will only appear if all LEDs have failed.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The left or right-hand cornering light is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand low-beam headlamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The rear left-hand or rear right-hand turn signal is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Left Corner‐
ing Light or Check
Right Cornering
Light
Check Left Low
Beam or Check
Right Low Beam
Check Rear Left
Turn Signal or
Check Rear Right
Turn Signal
Display messages
b
Check Front Left
Turn Signal or
Check Front Left
Turn Signal
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The front left-hand or front right-hand turn signal is defective.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The turn signal in the left-hand or right-hand exterior mirror is
defective.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The high-mounted brake lamp is faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand brake lamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp/brake lamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand high beam is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Left Mirror
Turn Signal or
Check Right Mirror
Turn Signal
Check Center Brake
Lamp
Check Left Brake
Lamp or Check
Right Brake Lamp
Check Left Tail
and Brake Lamps or
Check Right Tail
and Brake Lamps
Check Left High
Beam or Check
Right High Beam
b
License Plate Lamp
The left or right-hand license plate lamp is defective.
Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
205
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
206
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
b
The rear fog lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The front left or front right parking or standing lamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The backup lamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right-hand tail lamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The left or right front side marker lamp is defective.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
Left
Lamp or
Right
Lamp
The rear left or right side marker lamp is defective.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Check Left Daytime
Running Light or
Check Right Day‐
time Running Light
The left or right-hand daytime running lamp is faulty.
X Check whether you are permitted to replace the bulb yourself
(Y page 102).
or
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Rear Fog Lamp
Check Front Left
Parking Lamp or
Check Front Right
Parking Lamp
Backup Light
Check Left Tail
Lamp or Check
Right Tail Lamp
Check Front Left
Sidemarker Lamp or
Check Front Right
Sidemarker Lamp
Check Rear
Sidemarker
Check Rear
Sidemarker
b
Display messages
b
Malfunction See
Operator's Manual
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The exterior lighting is defective.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
b
The light sensor is defective.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
b
The lights are still switched on when you leave the vehicle. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Turn the light switch to Ã.
Auto Lamp Function
Inoperative
Switch Off Lights
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
Drive system
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
#
The 12 V battery is no longer being charged.
Do not drive on.
X Do not tow the vehicle.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X
X
+
Check Coolant
Level See Opera‐
tor's Manual
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
The coolant level is too low.
! Avoid making long journeys with too little coolant in the engine
cooling system. The engine will otherwise be damaged.
X
207
If the coolant needs topping up more often than usual, have the
cooling system checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Z
On-board computer and displays
208
Display messages
High-voltage battery
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Battery Reserve
Level
The charge level of the high-voltage battery has dropped into the
reserve range.
X Charge the high-voltage battery.
Û
The charge level of the high-voltage battery is so low that it is no
longer possible to drive the vehicle.
X Park the vehicle and charge the high-voltage battery.
ì
There are malfunctions in the drive system and/or the cooling
system.
X Visit an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Without starting
engine again, con‐
sult workshop
There is a malfunction in the high-voltage electrical system. A
warning tone also sounds.
X Do not switch off the drive system.
X Visit an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately.
ì
There is a serious malfunction in the drive system. A warning tone
also sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
under any circumstances.
X Do not tow the vehicle.
X Visit an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center immediately.
Battery Level Too
Low, Stop, Charge
Immediately
Malfunction Visit
Workshop
Stop Switch Engine
Off
Driving systems
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
À
Based on certain criteria, ATTENTION ASSIST has detected fatigue
or a lack of concentration on the part of the driver. A warning tone
also sounds.
X If necessary, take a break.
Attention Assist:
Take a Break!
On long journeys, take regular breaks in good time to allow yourself to rest.
À
Attention Assist
Inoperative
ATTENTION ASSIST is inoperative.
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ë
The HOLD function is deactivated. The vehicle is skidding.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Reactivate the HOLD function later (Y page 154).
Off
The HOLD function is deactivated. When the brake pedal is firmly
depressed, an activation condition is not fulfilled.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Check the activation conditions for the HOLD function
(Y page 154).
Radar Sensors Deac‐ The radar sensor system is deactivated.
tivated See Opera‐ X Switch on the radar sensor system (Y page 188).
tor's Manual
Blind Spot Assist
Currently Unavail‐
able See Opera‐
tor's Manual
Blind Spot Assist is temporarily inoperative. Possible causes are:
sensors are dirty.
Rfunction is impaired due to heavy rain or snow.
Rthe radar sensor system is outside the operating temperature
range.
Rthe radar sensor system is temporarily inoperative, e.g. due to
electromagnetic radiation emitted by nearby TV or radio stations or other sources of electromagnetic radiation.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
When the causes stated above no longer apply, the display message disappears.
Blind Spot Assist is operational again.
If the display message does not disappear:
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Clean the sensors (Y page 259).
X Start the drive system again.
Blind Spot Assist
Inoperative
Blind Spot Assist is defective.
The yellow 9 indicator lamps also light up in the exterior mirrors.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Rthe
Z
209
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
210
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Park Assist Can‐
celed
The driver's door is open and the driver's seat belt has not been
fastened.
X Repeat the parking process with the seat belt fastened and the
driver's door closed.
You have inadvertently touched the multifunction steering wheel
while steering intervention was active.
X While steering intervention is active, make sure that the multifunction steering wheel is not touched unintentionally.
The vehicle has started to skid and ESP® has intervened.
X Use Active Parking Assist again later (Y page 159).
Park Assist Inoper‐ You have just carried out a large number of turning or parking
maneuvers.
ative
Active Parking Assist will become available again after approximately 10(Y page 159).
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Switch off the drive system and start it again.
If the display message continues to be displayed:
X
Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
PARKTRONIC is defective.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise Control
Inoperative
Cruise control is faulty.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Cruise Control
- - - mph
A condition for activating cruise control has not been fulfilled.
You have tried to store a speed below 20 mph (30 km/h), for
example.
X If conditions permit, drive faster than 20 mph (30 km/h) and
store the speed.
X Check the activation conditions for cruise control (Y page 153).
Tires
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Check
Tires
The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped significantly.
The wheel position is shown in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
With tire pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Rthey
may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase.
Rthey may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly
impair tire traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Check the tires and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tire (Y page 264).
X Check the tire pressures and, if necessary, correct the tire pressure.
X
Warning
Tire Malfunction
The tire pressure in one or more tires has dropped suddenly. The
wheel position is shown in the multifunction display.
G WARNING
If you drive with a flat tire, there is a risk of the following hazards:
Ra
flat tire affects the ability to steer or brake the vehicle.
could lose control of the vehicle.
Rcontinued driving with a flat tire will cause excessive heat buildup and possibly a fire.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Check the tires and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tire (Y page 264).
Ryou
Z
211
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
212
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Tire Press. Monitor Due to a source of radio interference, no signals can be received
Currently Unavail‐ from the wheel sensors. The tire pressure monitor is temporarily
malfunctioning.
able
X Drive on.
The tire pressure monitor restarts automatically as soon as the
problem has been solved.
TirePress.
Sensor(s) Missing
There is no signal from the tire pressure sensor of one or several
wheels. The pressure of the affected tire is not displayed in the
multifunction display.
X Have the faulty tire pressure sensor replaced at a qualified specialist workshop.
Tire Pressure Mon‐
itor
Inoperative No
Wheel Sensors
The wheels mounted do not have a suitable tire pressure sensor.
The tire pressure monitor is deactivated.
X Mount wheels with suitable tire pressure sensors.
The tire pressure monitor is activated automatically after driving
for a few minutes.
Tire Press. Monitor The tire pressure monitor is faulty.
Inoperative
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Please Correct
Tire Pressure
The tire pressure is too low in at least one of the tires, or the tire
pressure difference between the wheels is too great.
X Check the tire pressures at the next opportunity (Y page 284).
X If necessary, correct the tire pressure.
X Restart the tire pressure monitor (Y page 287).
Vehicle
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Shift to 'P' or 'N' You have attempted to start the engine with the transmission in
position R or D.
to Start Engine
X Shift the transmission to position P or N.
Depress Brake to
Start Engine
You have attempted to start the drive system with the transmission in position N without depressing the brake pedal.
X
Depress the brake pedal.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
To Deselect P or N, You have attempted to shift the transmission to position R or D
without starting the drive system.
Depress Brake and
Start Engine
X Start the drive system.
X Depress the brake pedal.
i It is only possible to shift the transmission from position P to
the desired position if you depress the brake pedal. Only then
can the parking lock be deactivated. If you do not depress the
brake pedal, the DIRECT SELECT lever can still be moved but the
parking lock remains engaged.
Apply Brake to
Shift from 'P'
You have attempted to move the transmission selector lever to
position R, N or D without depressing the brake pedal.
X
Transmission Not
in P
Risk of Vehicle
Rolling Away
Service Required
Do Not Shift Gears
Visit Dealer
Depress the brake pedal.
G WARNING
The driver's door is open and the transmission is in position R, N or
D.
A warning tone also sounds.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
You cannot change the transmission position due to a malfunction.
A warning tone also sounds.
If transmission position D is selected:
X
Drive to a qualified specialist workshop without shifting the
transmission from position D.
If transmission position R, N or P is selected:
X
X
Do not tow the vehicle.
Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Only Shift
to 'P' when Vehi‐
cle is Stationary
The vehicle is moving.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
Reversing Not Pos‐
sible Service
Required
The transmission is malfunctioning. You cannot back up.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
A
The tailgate is open.
Close the tailgate.
X
Z
213
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
214
Display messages
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
?
The hood is not closed properly.
G WARNING
If the hood is not closed properly it may open and block your view
when the vehicle is in motion.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle immediately, paying attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Close the hood.
C
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all the doors.
Ð
Power assistance for steering is malfunctioning
A warning tone also sounds.
Phone No Service
Your vehicle is outside the network provider's transmitter/
receiver range.
X Wait until the mobile phone operational readiness symbol
appears in the multifunction display.
¥
The washer fluid level in the washer fluid reservoir has dropped
below the minimum.
Power Steering Mal‐
G WARNING
function See Oper‐
ator's Manual
You will need to use more force to steer.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Check whether you are able to apply the extra force required.
X If you are able to steer safely: carefully drive on to a qualified
specialist workshop.
X If you are unable to steer safely: do not drive on. Contact the
nearest qualified specialist workshop.
Check Washer Fluid
i If you do not mix antifreeze with the washer fluid in the winter
months, then the washer fluid could freeze in the washer fluid
reservoir. In this case, the Check Washer Fluid display message may appear in the multifunction display.
X
Wiper Malfunction‐
ing
Add washer fluid (Y page 254).
The windshield wipers are malfunctioning.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
Hazard Warning
Flashers Malfunc‐
tioning
The hazard warning lamps are faulty.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Charger Cable Con‐
nected
The charging cable is still connected to the vehicle socket.
X Remove the charging cable from vehicle socket.
SmartKey
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
The SmartKey batteries are discharged.
X Change the batteries (Y page 74).
+
The SmartKey is not in the vehicle. A warning tone also sounds.
When you switch off the ignition, you will be unable to start the
vehicle.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Locate the SmartKey.
Replace Key Battery
Key Not Detected
(red display message)
The SmartKey is not detected while driving because a powerful
radio transmitter is causing interference. A warning tone also
sounds.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
attention to road and traffic conditions.
X Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock and turn it to the
desired position (Y page 127).
+
Key Not Detected
(white display message)
You are in the vehicle and the SmartKey currently cannot be
detected by the vehicle.
X Change the location of the SmartKey in the vehicle.
If the SmartKey still cannot be detected:
X
+
Obtain a New Key
+
Key Does Not
Belong to Vehicle
Insert the SmartKey into the ignition lock and turn it to the
desired position (Y page 127).
The SmartKey needs to be replaced.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
You have put the wrong SmartKey in the ignition lock.
Use the correct SmartKey.
X
Z
215
On-board computer and displays
Display messages
On-board computer and displays
216
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Display messages
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
+
At least one door is open. A warning tone also sounds.
X Close all doors and lock the vehicle again.
+
The SmartKey is in the ignition lock.
X Remove the SmartKey.
Close Doors to
Lock Vehicle
Take Your Key
from Ignition
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Seat belts
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
After starting the drive
system, the red warning lamp lights up for
6 seconds.
The seat belt warning lamp reminds the driver and front passenger
to fasten their seat belts.
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
ü
The driver's seat belt is not fastened.
After starting the drive X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
system, the red seat
The warning tone ceases.
belt warning lamp lights
up. In addition, a warning tone sounds for up
to 6 seconds.
ü
The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt.
After you have started X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
the drive system, the
The warning lamp goes out.
red seat belt warning
lamp comes on as soon There are objects on the front-passenger seat.
as the driver's door or X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
the front-passenger
them in a secure place.
door is closed.
The warning lamp goes out.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
ü
The driver or front passenger has not fastened their seat belt. The
The red seat belt warn- vehicle is being driven faster than 15 mph (25 km/h) or has briefly
ing lamp flashes and an been driven faster than 15 mph (25 km/h).
intermittent audible
X Fasten your seat belt (Y page 42).
warning sounds.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
There are objects on the front-passenger seat. The vehicle is being
driven faster than 15 mph (25 km/h) or has briefly been driven
faster than 15 mph (25 km/h).
X Remove the objects from the front-passenger seat and stow
them in a secure place.
The warning lamp goes out and the intermittent warning tone
ceases.
Z
217
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
218
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Safety systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
$ (USA only)
There is not enough brake fluid in the brake fluid reservoir.
J (Canada only)
G WARNING
The red brake system
The braking effect may be impaired.
warning lamp is lit while
the drive system is run- There is a risk of an accident.
X Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon as possible, paying
ning. A warning tone
attention to road and traffic conditions. Do not continue driving
also sounds.
under any circumstances.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Do not add brake fluid. Adding more will not remedy the malfunction.
X Consult a qualified specialist workshop.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
!é
The yellow ABS and
RBS warning lamps are
on while the drive system is running.
ABS (Anti-lock Braking System) is deactivated due to a malfunction. Therefore, BAS (Brake Assist), COLLISION PREVENTION
ASSIST, ESP® (Electronic Stability Program), RBS, the HOLD function and hill start assist are also deactivated, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The wheels could therefore lock if you
brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If the ABS control unit is malfunctioning, other systems may also
not be available, e.g. the navigation system.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!é
The yellow ABS and
RBS warning lamps are
on while the drive system is running.
ABS is temporarily unavailable. BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION
ASSIST, ESP®, EBD (electronic brake force distribution), the HOLD
function and hill start assist are therefore also deactivated, for
example.
Possible causes are:
RSelf-diagnosis
is not yet complete.
RThe on-board voltage may be insufficient.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Carefully drive a suitable distance, making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h).
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
Z
219
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
220
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
!é
The yellow ABS and
RBS warning lamps are
on while the drive system is running. A warning tone also sounds.
EBD is malfunctioning. Therefore, ABS, BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST, ESP®, RBS, the HOLD function and hill start assist
are unavailable, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
$ (USA only)
J (Canada only)
÷å!é
The red brake warning
lamp, the yellow ESP®
and ESP® OFF warning
lamps, the yellow ABS
and RBS warning lamps
are lit while the drive
system is running.
ABS and ESP® are malfunctioning. Therefore, BAS, RBS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST, EBD, the HOLD function and hill start
assist are also unavailable, for example.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
The steerability and braking characteristics may be severely affected. The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
÷
ESP® or traction control has intervened because there is a risk of
®
skidding
or at least one wheel has started to spin.
The yellow ESP warning lamp flashes while Cruise control is deactivated.
the vehicle is in motion. X When pulling away, only depress the accelerator pedal as far as
necessary.
X Ease off the accelerator pedal while the vehicle is in motion.
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
X Do not deactivate ESP®.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 67).
Z
221
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
222
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
å
G WARNING
The yellow ESP® OFF
If ESP® is switched off, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
warning lamp is lit while
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
the drive system is runX Reactivate ESP®.
ning.
For exceptions, see: (Y page 67).
X Adapt your driving style to suit the road and weather conditions.
If ESP® cannot be activated:
X
Have ESP® checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
÷åé
ESP®, RBS, BAS, COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST, the HOLD
The yellow RBS, ESP® function and hill start assist are not available due to a malfunction.
and ESP® OFF warning ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
lamps are lit while the
G WARNING
drive system is running.
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
÷åé
The yellow RBS, ESP®
and ESP® OFF warning
lamps are lit while the
drive system is running.
ESP®, RBS, BAS, the HOLD function and hill start assist are temporarily unavailable.
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST may also have failed.
ATTENTION ASSIST is deactivated.
Self-diagnosis is not yet complete.
G WARNING
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above.
The braking distance in an emergency braking situation can thus
increase.
If ESP® is not operational, ESP® is unable to stabilize the vehicle.
There is an increased risk of skidding and an accident.
X Carefully drive a suitable distance, making slight steering movements at a speed above 12 mph (20 km/h).
The functions mentioned above are available again when the
warning lamp goes out.
If the warning lamp is still on:
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Drive on carefully.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
X
F (USA only)
! (Canada only)
The red indicator lamp
for the electric parking
brake flashes or lights
up and/or the yellow
warning lamp for the
electric parking brake
lights up.
X
Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
Z
223
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
224
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
6
The red restraint system warning lamp is lit
while the drive system
is running.
The restraint system is faulty.
G WARNING
The air bags or Emergency Tensioning Devices may either be triggered unintentionally or, in the event of an accident, may not be
triggered.
There is an increased risk of injury.
X Drive on carefully.
X Have the restraint system checked at a qualified specialist
workshop immediately.
For further information about the restraint system, see
(Y page 40).
é
RBS (Recuperative Brake System) is unavailable due to a malfuncThe yellow RBS warning tion.
lamp is lit while the
G WARNING
drive system is running.
The braking performance of the electric motor using recuperative
braking may be either reduced or not effective. If you do not make
an additional effort to apply the brake yourself, the braking effect
may not be sufficient. If necessary, counteract the reduced regenerative braking effect by applying the brake yourself.
The brake system continues to function normally, but without the
functions listed above. The front and rear wheels could therefore
lock if you brake hard, for example.
Braking efficiency may be impaired.
X Drive on taking extra care.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Drive system
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
The yellow bat- The charge level of the high-voltage battery has dropped into the
tery charge
reserve range.
warning lamp X Charge the high-voltage battery.
is on.
Driving systems
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
·
The distance to the vehicle in front is too small for the speed
The red distance warn- selected.
ing lamp lights up while X Increase the distance.
the vehicle is in motion.
·
You are approaching a vehicle or a stationary obstacle in your line
The red distance warn- of travel at too high a speed.
ing lamp lights up while X Be prepared to brake immediately.
the vehicle is in motion. X Pay careful attention to the traffic situation. You may have to
A warning tone also
brake or take evasive action.
sounds.
For further information about the distance warning function of
COLLISION PREVENTION ASSIST (Y page 64).
Z
225
On-board computer and displays
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
On-board computer and displays
226
Warning and indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
Tires
Problem
Possible causes/consequences and M Solutions
h
The tire pressure monitor has detected a loss of pressure in at
The yellow tire pressure least one of the tires.
monitor warning lamp
G WARNING
(pressure loss/
With tire pressures which are too low, there is a risk of the folmalfunction) is lit.
lowing hazards:
Rthey
may burst, especially as the load and vehicle speed
increase.
Rthey may wear excessively and/or unevenly, which may greatly
impair tire traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may
be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Stop the vehicle without making any sudden steering or braking
maneuvers. Pay attention to the traffic conditions as you do so.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away (Y page 300).
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Check the tires and, if necessary, follow the instructions for a
flat tire (Y page 264).
X Check the tire pressure (Y page 284).
X If necessary, correct the tire pressure.
h
The yellow tire pressure
monitor warning lamp
(pressure loss/
malfunction) flashes for
approximately one
minute and then
remains lit.
The tire pressure monitor is faulty.
G WARNING
The system is possibly unable to recognize or register low tire
pressure.
There is a risk of an accident.
X Observe the additional display messages in the multifunction
display.
X Visit a qualified specialist workshop.
227
Useful information ............................ 228
Loading guidelines ............................ 228
Stowage areas .................................. 228
Stowage and features
Features ............................................. 234
228
Stowage areas
Useful information
Stowage and features
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Loading guidelines
G WARNING
If objects, luggage or loads are not secured or
not secured sufficiently, they could slip, tip
over or be flung around and thereby hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, particularly in the event of sudden braking or a sudden change in direction.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping before the
journey.
The handling characteristics of a laden vehicle are dependent on the distribution of the
load within the vehicle. Observe the following
notes when transporting a load:
Rnever
exceed the maximum permissible
gross vehicle mass or the gross axle weight
rating for the vehicle (including occupants).
The values are specified on the vehicle
identification plate on the B-pillar of the
driver's door.
RThe cargo compartment is the preferred
place to carry objects.
RPosition heavy loads as far forwards as possible and as low down in the cargo compartment as possible.
RThe load must not protrude above the
upper edge of the seat backrests.
RAlways
place the load against the rear or
front seat backrests. Make sure that the
seat backrests are securely locked into
place.
RAlways place the load behind unoccupied
seats if possible.
RUse the cargo tie-down rings and the parcel
nets to transport loads and luggage.
RUse cargo tie-down rings and fastening
materials appropriate for the weight and
size of the load.
RHook in the cargo net when loading.
RThe maximum load capacity of the stowage
well under the cargo compartment floor is
55 lbs (25 kg).
RSecure the load with sufficiently strong and
wear-resistant tie-downs. Pad sharp edges
for protection.
! Do not position the load on one part of the
folding cargo compartment floor only. The
maximum load capacity of the folding cargo
compartment floor is 220 lbs (100 kg). Distribute the weight evenly to avoid damaging
the cargo compartment floor. Place a solid
board under the load if necessary. Please
note that the load on the cargo compartment floor will be increased when the load
is lashed down.
Stowage areas
Stowage spaces
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
Stowage areas
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, parcel nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces while
driving.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointy, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the cargo compartment.
229
Stowage compartment in front of the armrest
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 228).
Stowage compartments in the front
Glove box
Vehicles with DIRECT SELECT lever
X
To open: press the marking on cover :.
i You can remove the non-slip mat and the
insert for cleaning. When removing the
insert you will have to overcome some
slight resistance.
Stowage compartment/telephone compartment under the armrest
To open: pull handle : and open glove box
flap ;.
X To close: fold glove box flap ; upwards
until it engages.
X
i There is a pen holder at the top of the
glove box flap.
To open: on vehicles with moveable armrests, make sure that the armrest is in the
rearmost position.
X Press button : and fold the armrest up.
X
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment, a
USB connection and an AUX IN connection
or a Media Interface are installed in the
stowage compartment. A Media Interface
is a universal interface for portable audio
equipment, e.g. for an iPod® or MP3 player
(see the separate Audio or COMAND Operating Instructions).
Z
Stowage and features
RAlways
Stowage areas
230
Stowage and features
Stowage compartment under the driver's
seat and front-passenger seat
G WARNING
If you exceed the maximum load for the stowage compartment, the cover may not be able
to restrain the items. Items may be thrown out
of the stowage compartment and hit vehicle
occupants. There is a risk of injury, particularly in the event of sudden braking or a sudden change in direction.
Never exceed the maximum permissible load
for the stowage compartment. Stow and
secure heavy objects in the cargo compartment.
The maximum permissible load of the stowage compartment is 2.6 lbs (1.2 kg).
X
To open: pull down the top of stowage
compartment : by the edge of the handle.
i Depending on the vehicle's equipment,
there may be an open stowage space above
the stowage compartment.
Stowage nets
Stowage nets are located in the frontpassenger footwell and on the back of the
driver's and the front-passenger seat.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 228)
and the safety notes regarding stowage
spaces (Y page 228).
Cargo compartment enlargement
Important safety notes
G WARNING
X
To open: pull handle : up and fold
cover ; forwards.
Stowage space in the rear
Stowage compartment in the rear center
console
If the rear bench seat/rear seat and seat
backrest are not engaged they could fold forwards, e.g. when braking suddenly or in the
event of an accident.
RThe vehicle occupant would thereby be
pushed into the seat belt by the rear bench
seat/rear seat or by the seat backrest. The
seat belt can no longer offer the intended
level of protection and could even cause
injuries.
RObjects or loads in the trunk/cargo compartment cannot be restrained by the seat
backrest.
There is an increased risk of injury.
Before every trip, make sure that the seat
backrests and the rear bench seat/rear seat
are engaged.
! Before folding the backrest in the rear
compartment forwards, make sure that the
rear compartment armrest and the
cupholder are folded in. They may otherwise be damaged.
Observe the loading guidelines (Y page 228).
Stowage areas
Cargo compartment enlargement without EASY-VARIO-PLUS system
backrest back. Otherwise, it could be damaged.
X
Fold seat backrest : back until it engages.
Red lock status indicator ; is no longer
visible.
Adjust the head restraints if necessary
(Y page 90).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
Securing cargo
Cargo tie-down rings
Observe the following notes on securing
loads:
Fully insert the backrest head restraints
(Y page 90).
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
X Pull left-hand or right-hand release handle ; of the seat backrest forwards.
Corresponding seat backrest : is
released.
X Fold backrest : forwards.
X Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
back if necessary.
X
RObserve
the loading guidelines
(Y page 228).
RSecure the load using the cargo tie-down
rings.
RDistribute the load on the cargo tie-down
rings evenly.
RDo not use elastic straps or nets to secure
a load, as these are only intended as an
anti-slip protection for light loads.
RDo not route tie-downs across sharp edges
or corners.
RPad sharp edges for protection.
Folding the rear seat backrest back
: Cargo tie-down rings
X
Move the driver's or front-passenger seat
forward if necessary.
! Make sure that the seat belt does not
become trapped when folding the rear seat
Z
Stowage and features
Folding the rear seat backrest forward
The left-hand and right-hand rear seat backrests can be folded forwards separately to
increase the cargo compartment capacity.
231
232
Stowage areas
Bag hook
! When loading the vehicle, make sure that
you do not stack the load in the cargo compartment higher than the lower edge of the
side windows. Do not place heavy objects
on top of the cargo compartment cover.
Stowage and features
G WARNING
The bag hooks cannot restrain heavy objects
or items of luggage. Objects or items of luggage could be flung around and thereby hit
vehicle occupants when braking or abruptly
changing directions. There is a risk of injury.
Only hang light objects on the bag hooks.
Never hang hard, sharp-edged or fragile
objects on the bag hooks.
! The bag hook can bear a maximum load of
6.6lbs (3kg) and should not be used to
secure a load.
: Bag hook
Cargo compartment cover
Important safety notes
G WARNING
On its own, the cargo compartment cover
cannot secure or restrain heavy objects,
items of luggage and heavy loads. You could
be hit by an unsecured load during sudden
changes in direction, braking or in the event of
an accident. There is an increased risk of
injury or even fatal injury.
Always store objects so that they cannot be
flung around. Secure objects, luggage or
loads against slipping or tipping over, e.g. by
using tie downs, even if you are using the
cargo compartment cover.
! When removing and installing the cargo
compartment cover, ensure that its end
caps do not scrape the light-colored parts
of the vehicle.
The cargo compartment cover is located
behind the rear bench seat backrest.
Extending/retracting the cargo compartment cover
To extend: pull the cargo compartment
cover back by grab handle : and clip it into
retainers ; on the left and right.
X To retract: unhook the cargo compartment
cover from retainers ; on the left and right
and guide it forwards by grab handle :
until it is fully retracted.
X
Stowage areas
Installing/removing the cargo compartment cover
233
! The maximum load capacity of the stowage well under the cargo compartment
floor is 55 lbs (25 kg).
Opening/closing the cargo compartment floor
To remove: make sure that the cargo compartment cover is rolled up.
X Push in the end cap of cargo compartment
cover : in the direction of the arrow on the
right or left side using grip =.
X Push cargo compartment cover : into
opposite anchorage ;.
X Remove cargo compartment cover :
upwards.
X
To install: set cargo compartment
cover : on the right or left-hand side in
anchorage ;.
X Push in the opposite end cap of cargo compartment cover : in the direction of the
arrow and insert cargo compartment
cover : into opposite anchorage ;.
X
To open: open the tailgate.
X Holding ribbing ;, press handle : downwards.
Handle : folds up.
X Swing the cargo compartment floor
upwards using handle : until it rests
against the cargo compartment cover.
X
Stowage well under the cargo compartment floor
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you drive when the cargo compartment floor
is open, objects could be flung around, thus
striking vehicle occupants. There is a risk of
injury, particularly in the event of sudden
braking or a sudden change in direction.
Always close the cargo compartment floor
before a journey.
X
Fold out hook = on the underside of the
cargo compartment floor.
Z
Stowage and features
Under the trunk floor you can find a folding
box.
Features
234
To raise: using handle :, lift up cargo
compartment floor ; in the direction of
arrow = and pull it upwards.
X Lower cargo compartment floor ; again.
To do this, push the trunk floor away so that
it engages in the guide on the upper level.
Cargo compartment floor ; engages in
the upper position.
i Carry out this step using both hands.
X To lower: raise cargo compartment
floor ; slightly using handle : and pull it
towards you.
X Lower cargo compartment floor ; again
slowly. Whilst doing so, press the trunk
floor into the lower level.
Cargo compartment floor ; engages in
the lower position.
Stowage and features
X
X
Attach hook = to the cargo compartment's upper seal ?.
To close: detach hook = from seal ?.
X Fasten hook = to the bracket on the
underside of the cargo compartment floor.
X Fold the trunk floor down.
X Press the cargo compartment floor down
until it engages.
X
Setting the height of the cargo compartment floor
The stowage well under the cargo compartment floor can be increased or decreased in
size as necessary. To do this, you can lock the
floor at two different heights. The upper catch
gives a flat load surface when the rear bench
seat is folded forward.
Features
Cup holder
Important safety notes
G WARNING
The cup holder cannot hold a container secure
whilst traveling. If you use a cup holder whilst
traveling, the container may be flung around
and liquid may be spilled. The vehicle occupants may come into contact with the liquid
and if it is hot, they may be scalded. You may
be distracted from the traffic conditions and
you could lose control of the vehicle. There is
a risk of an accident and injury.
Only use the cup holder when the vehicle is
stationary. Only use the cup holder for containers of the right size. Always close the container, particularly if the liquid is hot.
G WARNING
If objects in the passenger compartment are
stowed incorrectly, they can slide or be
thrown around and hit vehicle occupants.
There is a risk of injury, particularly in the
event of sudden braking or a sudden change
in direction.
Features
235
RAlways stow objects so that they cannot be
thrown around in such situations.
make sure that objects do not protrude from stowage spaces, parcel nets or
stowage nets.
RClose the lockable stowage spaces while
driving.
RStow and secure objects that are heavy,
hard, pointy, sharp-edged, fragile or too
large in the cargo compartment.
! Only use the cup holders for containers of
the right size and which have lids. The
drinks could otherwise spill.
The stowage compartments in the doors provide space for bottles:
Rfront:
Rrear:
capacity up to 51 fl. oz. (1.5 l)
capacity up to 17 fl. oz. (0.5 l)
Cup holder in the front-compartment
center console
The cup holder and the rubber mat underneath can be removed for cleaning. Clean
them with clean, lukewarm water only.
To remove: carefully pull in upper sections
of cup holder : on the driver's and frontpassenger sides until they release.
X Lift the cup holder upwards ; until it can
be removed.
To install: insert cup holder into lateral
curved sections ; in the stowage compartment. Insert the cup holder so that the
wedge of the upper section of cup
holder : faces forwards.
X Press the cup holder downwards until it
engages on the right and left-hand sides.
X
Sun visors
Overview
G WARNING
If the mirror cover of the vanity mirror is folded
up when the vehicle is in motion, you could be
blinded by incident light. There is a risk of an
accident.
Always keep the mirror cover folded down
while driving.
X
: Mirror light
; Bracket
= Retaining clip, e.g. for a car park ticket
Z
Stowage and features
RAlways
Features
236
? Vanity mirror
A Mirror cover
Vanity mirror in the sun visor
Stowage and features
Mirror light : only functions if the sun visor
is clipped into retainer ; and mirror cover A
has been folded up.
i If you remove the ashtray insert, you can
use the resulting compartment for stowage.
Rear-compartment ashtray
Glare from the side
Fold down the sun visor.
Pull the sun visor out of retainer ;.
X Swing the sun visor to the side.
X Vehicles with mirror lights: slide the sun
visor horizontally as desired.
X
X
To open: pull cover = out by its top edge.
To remove: pull insert ; by recess : in
the direction of arrow ? until it audibly
releases.
X Lift insert ; up and out.
X To install the insert: install insert ; from
above into the holder and press down until
it engages.
X
Ashtray
Front ashtray
! The stowage space under the ashtray is
not heat resistant. Before placing lit cigarettes in the ashtray, make sure that the
ashtray is properly engaged. Otherwise, the
stowage space could be damaged.
X
Cigarette lighter
G WARNING
You can burn yourself if you touch the hot
heating element or the socket of the cigarette
lighter.
In addition, flammable materials can ignite if:
Rthe
hot cigarette lighter falls
child holds the hot cigarette lighter to
objects, for example
There is a risk of fire and injury.
Always hold the cigarette lighter by the knob.
Always make sure that the cigarette lighter is
out of reach of children. Never leave children
unsupervised in the vehicle.
Ra
Example: vehicles with a cover over the stowage
compartment
To open: push the lower section of
cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X To remove the insert: lift insert = up ;
and out.
X To re-install the insert: press insert =
into the holder until it engages.
X
Your attention must always be focused on the
traffic conditions. Only use the cigarette
Features
Socket in the rear-compartment center
console
Example: vehicles with a cover over the stowage
compartment
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X To open: push the lower section of
cover :.
The stowage compartment opens.
X Press in cigarette lighter ;.
Cigarette lighter ; will pop out automatically when the heating element is red-hot.
X
X
Stowage and features
lighter when road and traffic conditions permit.
Pull cover : out by its top edge.
Lift up the cover of socket ;.
Socket in the cargo compartment
12 V sockets
General notes
X
Turn the SmartKey to position 1 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
The sockets can be used for accessories with
a maximum draw of 180 W (15 A). Accessories include such items as bulbs or chargers
for mobile phones.
If the sockets are used for a very long time the
battery may discharge.
i An emergency cut-out ensures that the
on-board voltage does not drop too low. If
the on-board voltage is too low, the power
to the sockets is automatically cut.
X
237
Lift up the cover of socket :.
mbrace
General notes
You must have a license agreement to activate the mbrace service. Make sure that your
system is activated and operational. To log in,
press the ï MB Info call button. If any of
the steps mentioned are not carried out, the
system may not be activated.
If you have questions about the activation,
contact the following telephone assistance
service:
Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367
Z
Features
238
Shortly after successfully registering with the
service, a user ID and password will be sent to
you by post.
The system is available if:
The mbrace system
indicator lamp in one or more of the
following buttons continues to light up red
after the system self-diagnosis:
- SOS button
- F Roadside Assistance call button
- ï MB Info call button
RAfter the system self-diagnosis, the Inop‐
erative or Service Not Activated
message appears in the multifunction display.
If a malfunction is indicated as outlined
above, the system may not operate as expected. In the event of an emergency, help will
have to be summoned by other means.
Have the system checked at the nearest
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or call the
following telephone assistance service:
Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367
To adjust the volume during a call, proceed as
follows:
Emergency call
Rit
has been activated and is operational
Stowage and features
Rthe corresponding mobile phone network is
available for transmitting data to the Customer Center
Ra service subscription is available
Rthe starter battery is sufficiently charged
i Determining the location of the vehicle on
a map is only possible if:
RGPS
reception is available.
vehicle position can be forwarded to
the Customer Assistance Center.
Rthe
X
Press the W or X button on the multifunction steering wheel.
or
X
Use the volume controller of the audio system/COMAND.
The system offers various services, e.g.:
RAutomatic
and manual emergency call
RRoadside Assistance call
RMB Info call
System self-test
After you have switched on the ignition, the
system carries out a self-diagnosis.
A malfunction in the system has been detected if one of the following occurs:
RThe
indicator lamp in the SOS button does
not come on during the system self-test.
RThe indicator lamp in the F Roadside
Assistance button does not light up during
self-diagnosis of the system.
RThe indicator lamp in the ï MB Info call
button does not light up during self-diagnosis of the system.
RThe
Important safety notes
G WARNING
It can be dangerous to remain in the vehicle,
even if you have pressed the SOS button in an
emergency if:
Ryou see smoke inside or outside of the vehi-
cle, e.g. if there is a fire after an accident
vehicle is on a dangerous section of
road
Rthe vehicle is not visible or cannot easily be
seen by other road users, particularly when
dark or in poor visibility conditions
There is a risk of an accident and injury.
Leave the vehicle immediately in this or similar situations as soon as it is safe to do so.
Move to a safe location along with other vehicle occupants. In such situations, secure the
vehicle in accordance with national regulations, e. g. with a warning triangle.
Rthe
You must have a license agreement to activate the mbrace service. Make sure that your
system is activated and operational. To register, press the ï MB Info call button. If
Features
General notes
The emergency call is triggered automatically
if an air bag is deployed or an Emergency
Tensioning Device is triggered.
If, for example, the relevant mobile phone
network is not available then voice connection cannot be established. The indicator
lamp in the SOS button flashes continuously.
The Call Failed message appears in the
multifunction display and must be confirmed.
In this case, summon assistance by other
means.
Stowage and features
any of the steps mentioned are not carried
out, the system may not be activated.
If you have questions about the activation,
contact the following telephone assistance
service:
Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367
Making an emergency call
i You cannot end an automatically triggered emergency call yourself.
An emergency call can also be initiated manually.
As soon as the emergency call has been initiated, the indicator lamp in the SOS button
flashes. The multifunction display shows the
Connecting Call message.
The audio output is muted.
Once the connection has been made, the
Call Connected message appears in the
multifunction display.
All important information on the emergency is
transmitted, for example:
Rcurrent
location of the vehicle (as determined by the GPS system)
Rvehicle identification number
Rinformation on the severity of the accident
After the emergency call has been initiated, a
voice connection is automatically established
between the Customer Assistance Center
and the vehicle occupants.
RIf the vehicle occupants respond, the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center attempts to get more information on the
emergency.
RIf there is no response from the vehicle
occupants, an ambulance is immediately
sent to the vehicle.
If no voice connection can be established to
the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance
Center, the system has been unable to initiate
an emergency call.
239
To initiate an emergency call manually:
press cover : briefly to open.
X Press SOS button ; briefly.
The indicator lamp in SOS button ;
flashes until the emergency call is concluded.
X Wait for a voice connection to the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center.
X After the emergency call, close cover :.
X
i If the mobile phone network is unavaila-
ble, mbrace will not be able to make the
emergency call. If you leave the vehicle
immediately after pressing the SOS button,
you will not know whether mbrace placed
the emergency call. In this case, always
summon assistance by other means.
Z
Features
240
Stowage and features
Roadside Assistance button
Benz technician or makes arrangements for
your vehicle to be transported to the nearest
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
You may be charged for services such as
repair work and/or towing.
Further details are available in your mbrace
manual.
i If the system has not been able to initiate
a Roadside Assistance call:
Rthe
X
Press Roadside Assistance button :.
This initiates a call to the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Assistance Center.
The indicator lamp in Roadside Assistance
button : flashes while the call is active.
The multifunction display shows the Con‐
necting Call message. The audio output
is muted.
If a connection can be made, the Call Con‐
nected message appears in the multifunction
display.
If a mobile phone network and GPS reception
are available, the system transfers data to the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center,
for example:
Rcurrent
location of the vehicle
Rvehicle identification number
indicator lamp in Roadside Assistance call button : flashes continuously
Rit was not possible to establish a voice
connection to the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center.
This can occur if the relevant mobile phone
network is not available, for example.
The Call Failed message appears in the
multifunction display.
X
To end a call: press the ~ button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
or
X
Press the corresponding button for ending
a phone call on the audio system or on
COMAND.
MB Info call button
i The audio system or COMAND display
indicates that a call is active. During the
call, you can change to the navigation menu
by pressing the NAVI button on COMAND,
for example.
Voice output is not available.
A voice connection is established between
the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance
Center and the vehicle occupants.
From the remote fault diagnosis, the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center
can ascertain the nature of the problem
(Y page 243).
The Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance
Center either sends a qualified Mercedes-
X
Press MB Info call button :.
This initiates a call to the Mercedes-Benz
Customer Assistance Center.
The indicator lamp in MB Info call button :
flashes while the connection is being made.
The multifunction display shows the Con‐
Features
If a connection can be made, the Call Con‐
nected message appears in the multifunction
display.
If a mobile phone network and GPS reception
are available, the system transfers data to the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center,
for example:
Rcurrent
Rvehicle
location of the vehicle
identification number
i The audio system or COMAND display
Call priority
When service calls are active, e.g. Roadside
Assistance or MB Info calls, an emergency
call can still be initiated. In this case, an emergency call will take priority and override all
other active calls.
The indicator lamp of the respective button
flashes until the call is ended.
An emergency call can only be terminated by
the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance
Center.
All other calls can be ended by pressing:
indicates that a call is active. During the
call, you can change to the navigation menu
by pressing the NAVI button on COMAND,
for example.
Voice output is not available.
Rthe ~ button on the multifunction steer-
A voice connection is established between
the Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance
Center and the vehicle occupants.
You receive information about operating your
vehicle, about the nearest authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center and about other products and services from Mercedes-Benz.
i When a call is initiated, the audio system
i The system has not been able to initiate
an MB Info call, if:
Rthe
indicator lamp in MB Info call button : is flashing continuously.
Rno voice connection to the MercedesBenz Customer Assistance Center was
established.
This can occur if the relevant mobile phone
network is not available, for example.
The Call Failed message appears in the
multifunction display.
X
To end a call: press the ~ button on the
multifunction steering wheel.
or
X
Press the corresponding button for ending
a phone call on the audio system or on
COMAND.
ing wheel
Rthe corresponding button on the audio sys-
tem or on COMAND for ending a telephone
call
is muted. The mobile phone is no longer
connected to COMAND. However, if you
want to use your mobile phone, do so only
when the vehicle is stationary and in a safe
location.
Downloading destinations in COMAND
Downloading destinations
i The Destination Download function is
only possible when:
Rthe
relevant mobile phone network is
available and data transfer is possible.
Rthe vehicle is equipped with a navigation
system.
Downloading destinations gives you access
to a database with over 15 million points of
interest (POIs). These can be downloaded on
the navigation system in your vehicle. If you
know the destination, the address can be
downloaded. Alternatively, you can obtain
information on the location of points of interest (POIs)/important destinations in the
vicinity.
Furthermore, you can download routes with
up to 20 way points.
Z
Stowage and features
necting Call message. The audio system
is muted.
241
242
Features
You are prompted to confirm route guidance
to the address entered.
The system calculates the route and subsequently starts the route guidance with the
address entered.
No, the address can be saved
i If you select No
Stowage and features
in the address book.
Route Assistance
This service is part of the mbrace PLUS Package and cannot be purchased separately.
i You can use the route assistance function
even if the vehicle is not equipped with a
navigation system.
Within the framework of this service, you
receive a professional and reliable form of
navigation support without having to leave
your vehicle.
The customer service representative finds a
suitable route depending on your vehicle's
current position and the desired destination.
You will then be guided live through the current route section.
Search & Send
General notes
i To use "Search & Send", your vehicle
must be equipped with mbrace and a navigation system. Additionally, an mbrace service subscription must be completed.
"Search & Send" is a destination entry service. A destination address which is found on
Google Maps® can be transferred via mbrace
directly to your vehicle's navigation system.
Specifying and sending the destination
address
X Go to the website http://
www.maps.google.com and enter a destination address into the entry field.
X To send the destination address to the
e-mail address of your mbrace account:
click on the corresponding button on the
website.
i Example:
If you select "Send to vehicle" and then
"Mercedes-Benz", the destination address
will be sent to your vehicle.
When the "Send" dialog window appears:
Enter the e-mail address you specified
when setting up your mbrace account into
the corresponding field.
X Click "Send".
X
i Information on specific commands such
as "Address entry" or "Send" can be found
on the website.
Calling up destination addresses
X Switch on the ignition.
The destination address is loaded into the
vehicle's navigation system.
A display message appears, asking
whether navigation should be started.
X Select Yes by turning cVd or sliding XVY
the COMAND controller and press W to
confirm.
The system calculates the route and subsequently starts the route guidance with
the address entered.
No, the address can be saved
i If you select No
in the address book.
i If you have sent more than one destination address, each individual destination
must be confirmed separately.
i Destination addresses are loaded in the
same order as the order in which they were
sent.
If you own multiple Mercedes-Benz vehicles with mbrace and activated mbrace
accounts:
If multiple vehicles are registered under the
same e-mail address, the destination will
be sent to all the vehicles.
Features
You can use vehicle remote unlocking if you
have unintentionally locked your vehicle and
a replacement key is not available.
The vehicle can be opened by the MercedesBenz Customer Assistance Center.
The vehicle can be immediately remotely
unlocked within 4 days of the ignition being
turned off. After this time, the remote unlocking may be delayed by 15 to 60 minutes. After
30 days, the vehicle can no longer be opened
remotely.
X Contact the following telephone assistance
service:
Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367
You will be asked for your password.
X Return to your vehicle at the time agreed
upon with the Mercedes-Benz Customer
Assistance Center.
To do this, you will need your identification
number and password.
i Vehicle remote unlocking is only possible
if the relevant mobile phone network is
accessible.
Vehicle remote closing
The remote closing feature can be used when
you have forgotten to lock the vehicle and you
are no longer nearby.
The vehicle can then be locked by the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center.
The vehicle can be immediately remotely
locked within 4 days of the ignition being
turned off. After this time, remote closing may
be delayed by 15 to 60 minutes. After 30 days
the vehicle can no longer be locked remotely.
X Contact the following telephone assistance
service:
Customer Service at 1-888-923-8367
You will be asked for your password.
The next time you are inside the vehicle and
you switch on the ignition, the Doors
Locked Remotely message appears in the
multifunction display.
To do this, you will need your identification
number and password.
i The vehicle valet locking feature is only
available when the relevant mobile phone
network is accessible and a data connection is possible.
Stolen vehicle recovery service
If your vehicle has been stolen:
Notify the police.
The police will issue a numbered incident
report.
X This number will be forwarded to the
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center together with your PIN.
The Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance
Center then tries to locate the system. The
Mercedes-Benz Customer Assistance Center contacts you and the local law enforcement agency if the vehicle is located.
However, only the law enforcement agency
is informed of the location of the vehicle.
X
i If the anti-theft alarm system is activated
for longer than 30 seconds, the MercedesBenz Customer Assistance Center is automatically notified.
Vehicle remote malfunction diagnosis
With the remote fault diagnosis (Vehicle
Health Check), the Customer Assistance Center can provide improved support for problems with your vehicle. During an existing call,
vehicle data is transferred to the Customer
Assistance Center. The customer service representative can use the received data to
decide what kind of assistance is required.
You are then, for example, guided to the nearest authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or a
recovery vehicle is called.
Vehicle data transfer during an MB Info call or
Roadside Assistance call is initiated by the
Customer Assistance Center. You will see the
Roadside Assistance Connected message in the COMAND display. If the vehicle
Z
Stowage and features
Vehicle remote opening
243
Stowage and features
244
Features
remote fault diagnosis can be started, the
Request for vehicle diagnosis
received. Start vehicle diagnosis?
message appears in the display.
X Confirm the message with Yes
Yes.
X When the Vehicle diagnosis: Please
start ignition message appears, turn
the key to position 2 in the ignition lock
(Y page 127).
X When the Please follow the instruc‐
tions received by phone and move
your vehicle to a safe position
message appears, follow the customer service representative's instructions.
The message in the display disappears.
If you select Cancel the remote fault diagnosis is canceled completely.
The vehicle operating state check begins.
You will see the Vehicle diagnosis
activated. message.
When the diagnosis is completed, the Send
vehicle diagnostics data (Voice con‐
nection may be interrupted during
data transfer) message appears. The
vehicle data can now be sent to the Customer
Assistance center.
X Press OK to confirm the message.
The voice connection with the Customer
Assistance Center is terminated.
You will see the Vehicle Diagnosis:
Transferring data... message.
The vehicle data is sent to the Customer
Assistance Center.
Depending on what the customer service representative agreed with you, the voice connection is re-established after the transfer is
complete. If necessary, you will be contacted
at a later time by another means, e.g. by email or phone.
Another function of the remote fault diagnosis is the transfer of service data to the Customer Assistance Center. If a service is overdue, the COMAND display shows a message
about various special offers at your workshop.
Information on the data stored in the vehicle
(Y page 26).
Information on Roadside Assistance
(Y page 21).
Downloading routes
Downloading routes allows you to transfer
and save predefined routes in the navigation
system. To do this, an SD memory card must
be inserted into the COMAND system. If no
SD memory card is inserted, you must insert
the card into the card slot on the COMAND
system before saving.
A route can be prepared and sent either by a
customer service representative or via the
mbrace portal on the Internet.
Each route can include up to 20 way points.
Once a route has been received by the navigation system, you will see the has been saved to memory card.
Do you want to start route guidance?
message in the COMAND display. The route is
saved to the SD memory card.
X To start route guidance: select Yes
Yes.
An overview of the route is shown in the
display.
No, the saved route can be
i If you select No
called up later via the navigation menu.
X
Select Start
Start.
Route guidance is started.
i Downloaded and saved data can be called
up again in COMAND.
You can find further information in the separate COMAND Operating Instructions.
Speed alert
You can define the upper speed limit, which
must not be exceeded by the vehicle.
If this selected speed is exceeded by the vehicle, a message will be sent to the Customer
Assistance Center. The Customer Assistance
Center then forwards this information to you.
You can select the way in which you receive
this information beforehand. Possible options
Features
Rthe
location where the speed limit was
exceeded
Rthe time at which the speed limit was
exceeded
Rthe selected speed limit which was exceeded
Geo fencing
Geo fencing allows you to select areas which
the vehicle should not enter or leave. You will
be informed if the vehicle crosses the boundaries of the selected areas. You can select
the way in which you receive this information
beforehand. Possible options include text
message, e-mail or an automated call.
The area can be determined as either a circle
or a polygon with a maximum of ten corners.
You can specify up to ten areas simultaneously. Different settings are possible for each
area.
Alternatively, you can trigger an MB Info call
and inform the customer service representative that you wish to activate geo fencing.
Currently inactive areas can be activated by
text message.
Triggering the vehicle alarm
With this function, you can trigger the vehicle's panic alarm via text message. An alarm
sounds and the exterior lighting flashes.
Depending on the setting, the panic alarm
lasts 5 or 10 seconds. Afterwards, the alarm
switches off.
Garage door opener
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When you operate or program the garage door
with the integrated garage door opener, persons in the range of movement of the garage
door can become trapped or struck by the
garage door. There is a risk of injury.
When using the integrated garage door
opener, always make sure that nobody is
within the range of movement of the garage
door.
Programming
Programming buttons
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 245).
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Garage door remote control A is not part of
the integrated garage door opener.
X Before programing for the first time, clear
the integrated garage door opener memory
(Y page 248).
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Press and hold button ;, = or ? of the
integrated garage door opener.
After a short time, indicator lamp : lights
up yellow.
i Indicator lamp : lights up yellow as soon
as button ;, = or ? is programmed for
Z
Stowage and features
include text message, e-mail or an automated
call.
The data you receive contains the following
information:
245
Features
246
the first time. If the selected button has
already been programmed, indicator
lamp : lights up yellow after 10 seconds
have elapsed.
Release button ;, = or ?. Indicator
lamp : flashes yellow.
X Point garage door remote control A
towards buttons ;, = or ? on the rearview mirror at a distance of 2 to 8 inches (5
to 20 cm).
i The required distance between remote
control A and the integrated garage door
opener depends on the garage door drive
system. Several attempts might be necessary. You should test every position for at
least 25 seconds before trying another
position.
Stowage and features
X
Press and hold button B on remote control
A until indicator lamp : lights up green.
If indicator lamp : lights up green or
flashes, then programing was successful.
X Release button B of remote control A of
the garage door drive.
X If indicator lamp : lights up red: repeat the
programing procedure for the corresponding button on the rear-view mirror. When
doing so, vary the distance between remote
control A and the rear-view mirror.
X
i If the indicator lamp flashes green after
successful programing, the garage door
system is using a rolling code. After programing, you must synchronize the garage
door opener integrated in the rear-view mirror with the receiver of the garage door
system.
Synchronizing the rolling code
Pay attention to the "Important safety notes"
(Y page 245).
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Your vehicle must be within reach of the
garage door or gate opener drive. Make sure
that neither your vehicle nor any persons/
objects are present within the sweep of the
door or gate.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Press the programing button of the door or
gate drive (see the door or gate drive operating instructions, e.g. under "Programing
additional remote controls").
i Usually, you now have 30 seconds to initiate the next step.
X
Press previously programmed button ;,
= or ? of the integrated garage door
opener until the door closes.
The rolling code synchronization is then
complete.
Notes on programming the remote control
Canadian radio frequency laws require a
"break" (or interruption) of the transmission
signals after broadcasting for a few seconds.
Therefore, these signals may not last long
enough for the integrated garage door
opener. The signal is not recognized during
programming. Comparable with Canadian
law, some U.S. garage door openers also feature a "break".
Features
Proceed as follows:
247
Problems when programming
Rif
you live in Canada
you have difficulties programming the
garage door opener (regardless of where
you live) when using the programming
steps.
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Press and hold button ;, = or ? of the
integrated garage door opener.
After a short time, indicator lamp : lights
up yellow.
X Release the button.
Indicator lamp : flashes yellow.
X Press button B of remote control A for
2 seconds, then release it for 2 seconds.
X Press button B again and hold for
2 seconds.
X Repeat this sequence on button B of
remote control A until indicator lamp :
lights up green.
If indicator lamp : turns red, repeat the
process.
X Continue with the other programing steps
(see above).
X
If you are experiencing problems programing
the integrated garage door opener on the
rear-view mirror, take note of the following
instructions:
RCheck
the transmitter frequency of garage
door drive remote control A. This can usually be found on the back of the remote
control.
The integrated garage door opener is compatible with devices that have units which
operate in the frequency range of 280 to
433 MHz.
RReplace the batteries in garage door
remote control A. This increases the likelihood that garage door remote control A
will transmit a strong and precise signal to
the integrated garage door opener.
RWhen programming, hold remote control
A at varying distances and angles from the
button which you are programming. Try various angles at a distance between 2and
12 inches (5to 30 cm) or at the same angle
but at varying distances.
RIf another remote control is available for the
same garage door drive, repeat the same
programming steps with this remote control. Before performing these steps, make
sure that new batteries have been installed
in garage door drive remote control A.
RNote that some remote controls only transmit for a limited amount of time (the indicator lamp on the remote control goes out).
Z
Stowage and features
Rif
248
Features
Press button B on remote control A again
before transmission ends.
RAlign the antenna cable of the garage door
opener unit. This can improve signal reception/transmission.
Clearing the memory
Stowage and features
Opening/closing the garage door
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
Integrated garage door opener in the rear-view mirror
After it has been programmed, the integrated
garage door opener performs the function of
the garage door system remote control.
Please also read the operating instructions
for the garage door system.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Press button ;, = or ? which you have
programmed to operate the garage door.
Garage door system with a fixed code: indicator lamp : lights up green.
Garage door system with a rolling code:
indicator lamp : flashes green.
i The transmitter will transmit a signal as
long as the button is pressed. The transmission is halted after a maximum of
10 seconds and indicator lamp : lights up
yellow. Press button ;, = or ? again if
necessary.
Make sure that you clear the memory of the
integrated garage door opener before selling
the vehicle.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Press and hold buttons ; and ?.
The indicator lamp initially lights up yellow
and then green.
X Release buttons ; and ?.
The memory of the integrated garage door
opener in the rear-view mirror is cleared.
Compass
Calling up the compass
The compass displays in which compass
direction the vehicle is currently traveling: N,
NE, E, SE
NE
SE, S, SW
SW, W or NW
NW.
Features
Setting the compass
X
Determine your position using the following
zone maps.
Push a round pen into opening =
(Y page 248) for approximately 3 seconds.
The zone currently selected appears in
compass display ; (Y page 248).
X To select the zone: push a round pen into
opening = (Y page 248) until the desired
zone is selected.
If, after a few seconds, the display in compass display ; (Y page 248) changes
direction, the zone has been selected.
X
Calibrating the compass
Make sure that there is sufficient space for
you to drive in a circle without impeding
traffic.
In order to calibrate the compass correctly,
do the following:
X
Rcalibrate
North America zone map
the compass in the open and not
in the vicinity of steel structures or highvoltage transmission lines.
Rswitch off electrical consumers such as the
climate control, windshield wipers or rear
window defroster.
Rclose all doors and the tailgate.
X Switch on the ignition.
X Push a round pen into opening =
(Y page 248) for approximately 6 seconds,
until the C symbol is shown in compass display ; (Y page 248).
X Drive your vehicle in a full circle at approximately 3 mph (5 km/h) to 6 mph
(10 km/h).
When the calibration has successfully been
completed, the current direction is shown
in compass display ; (Y page 248).
Floormat on the driver's side
South America zone map
G WARNING
Objects in the driver's footwell can restrict the
pedal travel or obstruct a depressed pedal.
The operating and road safety of the vehicle is
jeopardized. There is a risk of an accident.
Z
Stowage and features
To receive a correct display in rear-view mirror :, the compass must be calibrated and
the magnetic field zone set.
249
Features
250
Stowage and features
Make sure that all objects in the vehicle are
stowed correctly, and that they cannot enter
the driver's footwell. Install the floormats
securely and as specified in order to ensure
sufficient clearance for the pedals. Do not use
loose floormats and do not place floormats on
top of one another.
Slide the seat backwards.
To install: place the floormat in the footwell.
X Press safety catch knobs : onto retainers ;.
X To remove: pull the floormat off retainers ;.
X Remove the floormat.
X
X
251
Useful information ............................ 252
Engine compartment ........................ 252
Maintenance ...................................... 254
Maintenance and care
Care .................................................... 256
252
Engine compartment
Useful information
i This Operator's Manual describes all
Maintenance and care
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Engine compartment
Hood
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If the hood is unlatched, it may open up when
the vehicle is in motion and block your view.
There is a risk of an accident.
Never unlatch the hood while driving.
G WARNING
When opening and closing the hood, it may
suddenly fall into the closed position. There is
a risk of injury to persons within range of
movement of the hood.
Open and close the hood only when no one is
within its range of movement.
G WARNING
Opening the hood when the engine is overheated or when there is a fire in the engine
compartment could expose you to hot gases
or other service products. There is a risk of
injury.
Let an overheated engine cool down before
opening the hood. If there is a fire in the
engine compartment, keep the hood closed
and contact the fire department.
G WARNING
The engine compartment contains moving
components. Certain components, such as
the radiator fan, may continue to run or start
again suddenly when the ignition is off. There
is a risk of injury.
If you need to do any work inside the engine
compartment:
Rswitch
off the ignition
reach into the area where there is a
risk of danger from moving components,
such as the fan rotation area
Rremove jewelry and watches
Rkeep items of clothing and hair, for example, away from moving parts
Rnever
Opening the hood
G WARNING
Certain components on the engine may be
very hot. When carrying out work on the
engine there is a risk of injury.
Where possible, let the engine cool down and
touch only the components described in the
following.
G WARNING
When the hood is open and the windshield
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windshield wipers and
the ignition before opening the hood.
! Make sure that the windshield wipers are
not folded away from the windshield. You
could otherwise damage the windshield
wipers or the hood.
Engine compartment
253
Closing the hood
Raise the hood slightly and, at the same
time, remove support strut ? from yellow
retaining clip =.
X Swing support strut ? down and press it
into bracket A until it engages.
X Lower the hood and let it fall from a height
of approximately 8 in (20 cm).
X Check that the hood has engaged properly.
If the hood can be raised slightly, it is not
properly engaged. Do not press the hood
closed. Open the hood again and close it
with a little more force.
Make sure that the windshield wipers are
switched off.
X Pull release lever : on the hood.
The hood is released.
X
Checking and adding other service
products
Checking coolant level
With your hand flat, palm facing down,
reach into the gap between the hood and
the radiator trim.
X Press the hood catch lever ; to the left.
X Raise the hood.
X
X
X
G WARNING
The engine cooling system is pressurized, particularly when the engine is warm. When
opening the cap, you could be scalded by hot
coolant spraying out. There is a risk of injury.
Let the engine cool down before opening the
cap. Wear eye and hand protection when
opening the cap. Open the cap slowly half a
turn to allow pressure to escape.
! The coolant may only be checked and cor-
rected when the engine is cool (coolant
temperature below 104 ‡ (40 †). Checking the coolant when the coolant temperature is above 104 ‡ (40 †) may result in
damage to the engine or to the engine cooling system.
Pull support strut ? out of bracket A.
Lift up support strut ? and insert it into
yellow retaining clip =.
Z
Maintenance and care
X
Maintenance
254
Where possible, let the engine cool down and
touch only the components described in the
following.
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
Example
Park the vehicle on a level surface.
Only check the coolant level when the vehicle is on a level surface and the drive system has cooled down.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Check the coolant temperature display in
the instrument cluster.
The coolant temperature must be below
104 ‡ (40 †).
X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Slowly turn cap : half a turn counterclockwise and allow excess pressure to
escape.
X Turn cap : further counter-clockwise and
remove it.
If the coolant is at the level of marker bar =
in the filler neck when cold, there is enough
coolant in coolant expansion tank ;.
X If necessary, add coolant that has been tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Replace cap : and turn it clockwise as far
as it will go.
Windshield washer concentrate is highly flammable. If it comes into contact with hot components in the front compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that no windshield washer concentrate is spilled next to the filler neck.
X
For further information on coolant, see
(Y page 309).
Windshield washer system
G WARNING
Certain components on the engine may be
very hot. When carrying out work on the
engine there is a risk of injury.
Example
To open: pull cap : upwards by the tab.
Add the premixed washer fluid.
X To close: press cap : onto the filler neck
until it engages.
X
X
The recommended minimum fluid level in the
washer fluid reservoir is 0.26 US gal (1 liter).
If the washer fluid level drops below the recommended minimum fluid level of 0.26 US gal
(1 liter), a message appears in the multifunction display prompting you to add washer fluid
(Y page 214).
Further information on windshield washer
fluid/antifreeze (Y page 310).
Maintenance
ASSYST PLUS
Service messages
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
informs you of the next service due date.
Maintenance
RService
A in .. Days
A Due
RService A Exceeded by .. Days
Depending on the operating conditions of the
vehicle, the remaining time or distance until
the next service due date is displayed.
The letter A or B, possibly in connection with a
number or another letter, indicates the type
of service. A stands for a minor service and B
for a major service.
You can obtain further information from an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
The ASSYST PLUS service interval display
does not take into account any periods of
time during which the battery is disconnected.
Maintaining the time-dependent service
schedule:
RService
X
Note down the service due date displayed
in the multifunction display before disconnecting the battery.
or
X
After reconnecting the battery, subtract
the battery disconnection periods from the
service date shown on the display.
Hiding a service message
X
Press the a or % button on the steering wheel.
Displaying service messages
Switch on the ignition.
Press the = or ; button to select the
Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select the
ASSYST PLUS submenu and confirm by
pressing the a button.
The service due date appears in the multifunction display.
X
X
Information about Service
Resetting the ASSYST PLUS service interval display
! If the ASSYST PLUS service interval display has been inadvertently reset, this setting can be corrected at a qualified specialist workshop.
Have service work carried out as described
in the Maintenance Booklet. This may otherwise lead to increased wear and damage
to the major assemblies or the vehicle.
A qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center, will reset
the ASSYST PLUS service interval display
after the service work has been carried out.
You can also obtain further information on
maintenance work, for example.
Special service requirements
The specified maintenance interval takes only
the normal operation of the vehicle into
account. Under arduous operating conditions
or increased load on the vehicle, maintenance work must be carried out more frequently, for example:
Rregular city driving with frequent intermedi-
ate stops
the vehicle is primarily used to travel
short distances
Ruse in mountainous terrain or on poor road
surfaces
Rif the engine is often left idling for long periods
Rif
Z
Maintenance and care
For information on the type of service and
service intervals, see the separate Maintenance Booklet.
You can obtain further information from an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center or at
http://www.mbusa.com (USA only).
The multifunction display shows a service
message for several seconds, e.g.:
255
Maintenance and care
256
Care
Under arduous operating conditions, the tires
must be checked more often. Further information can be obtained at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized MercedesBenz Center.
Use care products and cleaning agents recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Driving abroad
An extensive Mercedes-Benz Service network
is also available in other countries. You can
obtain further information from any authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Automatic car wash
Care
General notes
H Environmental note
Dispose of empty packaging and cleaning
cloths in an environmentally responsible manner.
! For cleaning your vehicle, do not use any
of the following:
Rdry,
rough or hard cloths
cleaning agents
Rsolvents
Rcleaning agents containing solvents
Do not scrub.
Do not touch the surfaces or protective
films with hard objects, e.g. a ring or ice
scraper. You could otherwise scratch or
damage the surfaces and protective film.
Rabrasive
! Do not park the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked.
Regular care of your vehicle is a condition for
retaining the quality in the long term.
Exterior care
G WARNING
Braking efficiency is reduced after washing
the vehicle. There is a risk of an accident.
After the vehicle has been washed, brake
carefully while paying attention to the traffic
conditions until full braking power is restored.
! Never clean your vehicle in a Touchless
Automatic Car Wash as these use special
cleaning agents. These cleaning agents can
damage the paintwork or plastic parts.
! When washing your vehicle in a tow-
through car wash, make sure that the selector lever is in position N, otherwise the
vehicle could be damaged.
! Make sure that:
Rthe
side windows are fully closed.
ventilation/heating is switched off
(the OFF button has been pressed/the
airflow control is set to position 0).
Rthe windshield wiper switch is at position
0.
The vehicle may otherwise be damaged.
Rthe
You can wash the vehicle in an automatic car
wash from the very start.
If the vehicle is very dirty, pre-wash it before
cleaning it in an automatic car wash.
After using an automatic car wash, wipe off
wax from the windshield and the wiper
blades. This will prevent smears and reduce
wiping noises caused by residue on the windshield.
Washing by hand
In some countries, washing by hand is only
allowed at specially equipped washing bays.
Care
Carefully remove all deposits of road salt as
soon as possible when driving in winter.
Power washers
G WARNING
The water jet from a circular jet nozzle (dirt
blasters) can cause invisible exterior damage
to the tires or chassis components. Components damaged in this way may fail unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use power washers with circular jet
nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged
tires or chassis components replaced immediately.
! Always maintain a distance of at least
11.8 in (30 cm) between the vehicle and the
power washer nozzle. Information about
the correct distance is available from the
equipment manufacturer.
Move the power washer nozzle around
when cleaning your vehicle.
Do not aim directly at any of the following:
Rtires
Rdoor
gaps, roof gaps, joints, etc.
components
Relectrical
Rbattery
Rconnectors
Rlights
Rseals
Rtrim
Rventilation
slots
Damaged seals or electrical components
can lead to leaks or failures.
Cleaning the paintwork
! Do not affix:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rmagnetic
plates or similar items
to painted surfaces. You could otherwise
damage the paintwork.
Remove dirt immediately, where possible,
while avoiding rubbing too hard.
X Soak insect remains with insect remover
and rinse off the treated areas afterwards.
X Soak bird droppings with water and rinse
off the treated areas afterwards.
X Remove coolant, brake fluid, tree resin, oils
and greases by rubbing gently with a cloth
soaked in petroleum ether or lighter fluid.
X Use tar remover to remove tar stains.
X Use silicone remover to remove wax.
X Use a suitable touch-up stick, e.g. MB
Touch-Up Stick, to repair slight damage to
the paintwork quickly and provisionally.
X
The following cannot always be completely
repaired:
Rscratches
Rcorrosive
deposits
affected by corrosion
Rdamage caused by inadequate care
In such cases, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
If water no longer forms "beads" on the paint
surface, use the paint care products recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
This is the case approximately every three to
Rareas
Z
Maintenance and care
Observe the legal requirements in each country.
X Do not use hot water and do not wash the
vehicle in direct sunlight.
X Use a soft sponge to clean.
X Use a mild cleaning agent, such as a car
shampoo approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X Thoroughly hose down the vehicle with a
gentle jet of water.
X Do not point the water jet directly towards
the air inlet.
X Use plenty of water and rinse out the
sponge frequently.
X Rinse the vehicle with clean water and dry
thoroughly with a chamois.
X Do not let the cleaning agent dry on the
paintwork.
257
258
Care
Maintenance and care
five months, depending on the climate conditions and the care product used.
If the dirt has penetrated the paint surface or
if the paintwork has become dull, then the
paintwork should be cleaned. Use the cleaning product Paint Cleaner, which has been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Do not use these care products in the sun or
on the hood while the hood is hot.
Matte finish care
! Never polish the vehicle or the light alloy
wheels. Polishing causes the finish to
shine.
! The following may cause the paint to
become shiny and thus reduce the matte
effect:
RVigorous
rubbing with unsuitable materials.
RFrequent use of car washes.
RWashing the vehicle in direct sunlight.
! Never use paint cleaner, buffing or pol-
ishing products, or gloss preserver, e.g.
wax. These products are only suitable for
high-gloss surfaces. Their use on vehicles
with matte finish leads to considerable surface damage (shiny, spotted areas).
Always have paintwork repairs carried out
at a qualified specialist workshop.
! Do not use wash programs with a hot wax
treatment under any circumstances.
Observe these notes if your vehicle has a
clear matte finish. This will help you to avoid
damage to the paintwork due to incorrect
treatment.
These notes also apply to light alloy wheels
with a clear matte finish.
i The vehicle should preferably be washed
by hand using a soft sponge, car shampoo
and plenty of water.
i Use only insect remover and car shampoo
from the range of recommended and
approved Mercedes-Benz care products.
Cleaning the wheels
G WARNING
The water jet from a circular jet nozzle (dirt
blasters) can cause invisible exterior damage
to the tires or chassis components. Components damaged in this way may fail unexpectedly. There is a risk of an accident.
Do not use power washers with circular jet
nozzles to clean the vehicle. Have damaged
tires or chassis components replaced immediately.
! Do not use acidic wheel cleaning products
to remove brake dust. This could damage
wheel bolts and brake components.
! Do not park the vehicle for an extended
period straight after cleaning it, particularly
after having cleaned the wheels with wheel
cleaner. Wheel cleaners could cause
increased corrosion of the brake discs and
brake pads/linings. For this reason, you
should drive for a few minutes after cleaning. Braking heats the brake discs and the
brake pads/linings, thus drying them. The
vehicle can then be parked.
Cleaning the windows
G WARNING
You could become trapped by the windshield
wipers if they start moving while cleaning the
windshield or wiper blades. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windshield wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windshield or
wiper blades.
! Only fold the windshield wipers away from
the windshield when vertical. Otherwise,
you will damage the hood.
! Do not use dry cloths, abrasive products,
solvents or cleaning agents containing solvents to clean the inside of the windows. Do
not touch the insides of the windows with
hard objects, e.g. an ice scraper or ring.
Care
! Clean the water drainage channels of the
windshield and the rear window at regular
intervals. Deposits such as leaves, petals
and pollen may under certain circumstances prevent water from draining away. This
can lead to corrosion damage and damage
to electronic components.
X
Clean the inside and outside of the windows with a damp cloth and a cleaning
product that is recommended and
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning the exterior lighting
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths which are suitable for plastic light
lenses. Unsuitable cleaning agents or
cleaning cloths could scratch or damage
the plastic light lenses.
X
Cleaning the mirror turn signals
! Only use cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths that are suitable for plastic lenses.
Unsuitable cleaning agents or cleaning
cloths could scratch or damage the plastic
lenses of the mirror turn signals.
Cleaning wiper blades
G WARNING
You could become trapped by the windshield
wipers if they start moving while cleaning the
windshield or wiper blades. There is a risk of
injury.
Always switch off the windshield wipers and
the ignition before cleaning the windshield or
wiper blades.
! Only fold the windshield wipers away from
the windshield when vertical. Otherwise,
you will damage the hood.
! Do not pull the wiper blade. Otherwise,
the wiper blade could be damaged.
! Do not clean wiper blades too often and
do not rub them too hard. Otherwise, the
graphite coating could be damaged. This
could cause wiper noise.
Clean the plastic lenses of the exterior
lighting using a wet sponge and a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz car
shampoo or cleaning cloths.
X
Clean the plastic lenses of the mirror turn
signals in the exterior mirror housing using
a wet sponge or cleaning cloth. Use a mild
cleaning agent, e.g. Mercedes-Benz
Autoshampoo.
Cleaning the sensors
! If you clean the sensors with a power
washer, make sure that you keep a distance of at least 11.8 in (30 cm) between
the vehicle and the power washer nozzle.
Information about the correct distance is
available from the equipment manufacturer.
Fold the windshield wiper arms away from
the windshield.
X Carefully clean the wiper blades with a
damp cloth.
X Fold the windshield wiper arms back again
before switching on the ignition.
X
! Hold the wiper arm securely when folding
back. The windshield could be damaged if
the wiper arm smacks against it suddenly.
Z
Maintenance and care
There is otherwise a risk of damaging the
windows.
259
Care
260
Interior care
Cleaning the display
! For cleaning, do not use any of the following:
Ralcohol-based
thinner or gasoline
cleaning agents
Rcommercially-available household cleaning agents
These may damage the display surface. Do
not put pressure on the display surface
when cleaning. This could lead to irreparable damage to the display.
Maintenance and care
Rabrasive
Before cleaning the display, make sure that
it is switched off and has cooled down.
X Clean the display surface using a commercially available microfiber cloth and
TFT/LCD display cleaner.
X Dry the display surface using a dry microfiber cloth.
X
X
Clean sensors : of the driving systems
with water, car shampoo and a soft cloth.
Cleaning the rear view camera
! Do not clean the camera lens and the area
around the rear view camera with a power
washer.
Cleaning the plastic trim
G WARNING
Care products and cleaning agents containing
solvents cause surfaces in the cockpit to
become porous. As a result, plastic parts may
come loose in the event of air bag deployment. There is a risk of injury.
Do not use any care products and cleaning
agents to clean the cockpit.
X
Use clear water and a soft cloth to clean
camera lens :.
! Do not affix the following to plastic surfaces:
Rstickers
Rfilms
Rscented
oil bottles or similar items
You can otherwise damage the plastic.
! Do not allow cosmetics, insect repellent
or sunscreen to come into contact with the
plastic trim. This maintains the high-quality
look of the surfaces.
Care
Cleaning the steering wheel and gear or
selector lever
X
Thoroughly wipe with a damp cloth or use
leather care agents that have been recommended and approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Cleaning genuine wood and trim elements
! Do not use solvent-based cleaning agents
such as tar remover, wheel cleaners, polishes or waxes. There is otherwise a risk of
damaging the surface.
! Do not use chrome polish on trim pieces.
The trim pieces have a chrome look but are
mostly made of anodized aluminum and
can lose their shine if chrome polish is
used. Use a damp, lint-free cloth instead
when cleaning the trim pieces.
If the chrome-plated trim pieces are very
dirty, you can use a chrome polish. If you
are unsure as to whether the trim pieces
are chrome-plated or not, consult an
authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
Wipe the wooden trim and trim pieces with
a damp, lint-free cloth, e.g. a microfiber
cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use care and cleaning products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
X
Cleaning the seat covers
General notes
! Do not use microfiber cloths to clean genuine leather, artificial leather or DINAMICA
covers. If used often, these can damage the
cover.
i Note that regular care is essential to
ensure that the appearance and comfort of
the covers is retained over time.
Genuine leather seat covers
Leather is a natural product.
It exhibits natural surface characteristics, for
example:
Rdifferences in the texture
Rsigns of stretching and marking
Rslight nuances of color
These are characteristics of leather and not
material defects.
! To retain the natural appearance of the
leather, observe the following cleaning
instructions:
RClean
genuine leather covers carefully
with a damp cloth and then wipe the covers down with a dry cloth.
RMake sure that the leather does not
become soaked. It may otherwise
become rough and cracked.
ROnly use leather care agents that have
been tested and approved by MercedesBenz. You can obtain these from a qualified specialist workshop.
Seat covers of other materials
! Observe the following when cleaning:
RClean artificial leather covers with a cloth
moistened with a solution containing 1%
detergent (e.g. dish washing liquid).
RClean cloth covers with a microfiber
cloth moistened with a solution containing 1% detergent (e.g. dish washing liquid). Rub carefully and always wipe entire
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines. Leave the seat to dry afterwards.
Cleaning results depend on the type of
dirt and how long it has been there.
RClean Alcantara® covers with a damp
cloth. Make sure that you wipe entire
Z
Maintenance and care
Wipe the plastic trim with a damp, lint-free
cloth, e.g. a microfiber cloth.
X Heavy soiling: use care and cleaning products recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
The surface may change color temporarily.
Wait until the surface is dry again.
X
261
Care
262
seat sections to avoid leaving visible
lines.
Cleaning the seat belts
Maintenance and care
G WARNING
Seat belts can become severely weakened if
bleached or dyed. This could cause the seat
belts to tear or fail, for instance, in the event of
an accident. This poses an increased risk of
injury or fatal injury.
Never bleach or dye the seat belts.
! Do not clean the seat belts using chemical
cleaning agents. Do not dry the seat belts
by heating at temperatures above 176 ‡
(80 †) or in direct sunlight.
X
Use clean, lukewarm water and soap solution.
Cleaning the headliner and carpets
X
Headliner: if it is very dirty, use a soft brush
or a cleaning agent recommended and
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
X
Carpets: use the carpet and textile cleaning agents recommended and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
263
Useful information ............................ 264
Where will I find...? ........................... 264
Flat tire .............................................. 264
12 V battery (vehicle) ....................... 265
Jump-starting .................................... 269
Towing ............................................... 271
Breakdown Assistance
Fuses .................................................. 274
264
Flat tire
Useful information
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
Breakdown Assistance
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Where will I find...?
Vehicle tool kit
General notes
i Apart from certain country-specific varia-
tions, the vehicles are not equipped with a
tire-change tool kit. Some tools for changing a wheel are specific to the vehicle. For
more information on which tire changing
tools are required and approved to perform
a wheel change on your vehicle, consult a
qualified specialist workshop.
Tools required for changing a wheel may
include, for example:
RJack
RWheel
RLug
chock
wrench
Flat tire
Preparing the vehicle
Your vehicle can be fitted with MOExtended
tires (tires with run-flat characteristics)
(Y page 264).
Check if your vehicle is fitted with
MOExtended tires. Vehicle preparation is not
necessary on vehicles with MOExtended tires
Information on changing/mounting a wheel
(Y page 300).
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground, as far away as possible from
traffic.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps.
X Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 144).
X If possible, bring the front wheels into the
straight-ahead position.
X Switch off the drive system.
X Remove the SmartKey from the ignition
lock.
X All occupants must get out of the vehicle.
Make sure that they are not endangered as
they do so.
X Make sure that no one is near the danger
area while a wheel is being changed. Anyone who is not directly assisting in the
wheel change should, for example, stand
behind the barrier.
X Get out of the vehicle. Pay attention to traffic conditions when doing so.
X Close the driver's door.
X
MOExtended tires (tires with run-flat
properties)
General notes
When using tires with run-flat characteristics,
you can continue to drive your vehicle even if
there is a total loss of pressure in one or more
tires. The affected tire must not show any
clearly visible damage.
You can recognize tires with run-flat characteristics by the MOExtended marking which
appears on the tire sidewall. You will find this
marking next to the tire size designation, the
load-bearing capacity and the speed index
(Y page 293).
Tires with run-flat characteristics may only be
used in conjunction with an active tire pressure monitor.
12 V battery (vehicle)
RObserve
the instructions in the display
messages (Y page 211).
RCheck the tire for damage.
RIf driving on, observe the following notes.
The maximum driving distance is approximately 50 miles (80 km) when the vehicle is
partially laden and approximately 18 miles
(30 km) when the vehicle is fully laden.
In addition to the vehicle load, the driving distance possible depends upon:
RSpeed
RRoad
condition
ROutside temperature
The driving distance possible in run-flat mode
may be reduced by extreme driving conditions/maneuvers, or it can be increased
through a moderate style of driving.
The maximum permissible distance which
can be driven in run-flat mode is counted from
the moment the tire pressure loss warning
appears in the multifunction display.
You must not exceed a maximum speed of
50 mph (80 km/h).
i When replacing one or all tires, make sure
that you use only tires:
Rof
the size specified for the vehicle and
"MOExtended"
If a tire has gone flat and cannot be
replaced with an MOExtended tire, a standard tire may be used as a temporary measure. Make sure that you use the proper size
and type (summer or winter tire).
Rmarked
Important safety notes
G WARNING
When driving in emergency mode, the driving
characteristics deteriorate, e.g. when cornering, accelerating quickly and when braking.
There is a risk of an accident.
Do not exceed the stated maximum speed.
Avoid abrupt steering and driving maneuvers,
and driving over obstacles (curbs, potholes,
off-road). This applies in particular to a laden
vehicle.
Stop driving in emergency mode if:
Ryou
hear banging noises.
vehicle starts to shake.
Ryou see smoke and smell rubber.
Rthe
RESP®
is intervening constantly.
are tears in the sidewalls of the tire.
After driving in emergency mode, have the
wheel rims checked at a qualified specialist
workshop with regard to their further use. The
defective tire must be replaced in every case.
Rthere
12 V battery (vehicle)
Important safety notes
Work on the 12 V battery, such as removal or
installation, requires specialist knowledge
and the use of special tools. You should therefore have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
i Vehicles featuring tires with run-flat char-
acteristics are not equipped with a TIREFIT
kit at the factory. It is therefore recommended that you additionally equip your vehicle
with a TIREFIT kit if you mount tires that do
not feature run-flat properties, e.g. winter
tires. A TIREFIT kit can be obtained from a
qualified specialist workshop.
Z
Breakdown Assistance
If the pressure loss warning message
appears in the multifunction display:
265
266
12 V battery (vehicle)
G WARNING
Work carried out incorrectly on the battery
can lead, for example, to a short circuit and
thus damage the vehicle electronics. This can
lead to function restrictions applying to
safety-relevant systems, e.g. the lighting system, ABS (anti-lock braking system) or ESP®
(Electronic Stability Program). The operating
safety of your vehicle may be restricted. You
could lose control of the vehicle, for example:
Rbraking
Breakdown Assistance
Rin
the event of abrupt steering maneuver
and/or when the vehicle's speed is not
adapted to the road conditions
There is a risk of an accident.
In the event of a short circuit or a similar incident, contact a qualified specialist workshop
immediately. Do not drive any further. You
should have all work involving the battery carried out at a qualified specialist workshop.
For further information about ABS and ESP®,
see (Y page 63) and (Y page 66).
G WARNING
Electrostatic build-up can lead to the creation
of sparks, which could ignite the highly explosive gases of a battery. There is a risk of an
explosion.
Before handling the battery, touch the vehicle
body to remove any existing electrostatic
build-up.
The highly flammable gas mixture forms when
charging the battery as well as when jumpstarting.
Always make sure that neither you nor the
battery is electrostatically charged. A buildup of electrostatic charge can be caused, for
example:
Rby
wearing clothing made from synthetic
fibers
Rdue to friction between clothing and seats
Rif you push or pull the battery across the
carpet or other synthetic materials
Rif you wipe the battery with a cloth
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or
sparks are created, the hydrogen gas can
ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a
connected battery does not come into contact with vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when
connecting and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the
battery poles with identical polarity are
connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the
described order when connecting and disconnecting the jumper cables.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery
terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
H Environmental note
Batteries contain dangerous
substances. It is against the
law to dispose of them with
the household rubbish. They
must be collected separately
and recycled to protect the
environment.
Dispose of batteries in an
environmentally friendly
manner. Take discharged
batteries to a qualified specialist workshop or a special
collection point for used batteries.
12 V battery (vehicle)
qualified specialist workshop.
Observe the service intervals in the Maintenance Booklet or contact a qualified specialist workshop for more information.
! You should have all work involving the
battery carried out at a qualified specialist
workshop. In the exceptional case that it is
necessary for you to disconnect the battery
yourself, make sure that:
Rengage gear P.
Ryou switch off the ignition and remove
the SmartKey. Make sure the ignition is
switched off. Check that all the indicator
lamps in the instrument cluster are off.
Otherwise, electronic components, such
as the alternator, may be damaged.
Ryou first remove the negative terminal
clamp and then the positive terminal
clamp. Never swap the terminal clamps.
Otherwise, the vehicle's electronic system may be damaged.
Rthe transmission is locked in position P
after disconnecting the battery. The vehicle is secured against rolling away. You
can then no longer move the vehicle.
The battery and the cover of the positive
terminal clamp must be installed securely
during operation.
Comply with safety precautions and take protective measures when handling batteries.
Risk of explosion.
Fire, open flames and smoking are
prohibited when handling the battery. Avoid creating sparks.
Battery acid is caustic. Avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing.
Wear suitable protective clothing,
especially gloves, apron and faceguard.
Rinse any acid spills immediately
with clear water. Contact a physician if necessary.
Wear eye protection.
Keep children away.
Observe this Operator's Manual.
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use batteries which have
been tested and approved for your vehicle by
Mercedes-Benz. These batteries provide
increased impact protection to prevent vehicle occupants from suffering acid burns
should the battery be damaged in the event of
an accident.
In order for the battery to achieve the maximum possible service life, it must always be
sufficiently charged.
Like other batteries, the vehicle battery may
discharge over time if you do not use the
vehicle. In this case, have the battery disconnected at a qualified specialist workshop. You
can also charge the battery with a charger
recommended by Mercedes-Benz. Contact a
qualified specialist workshop for further information.
Have the battery condition of charge checked
more frequently if you use the vehicle mainly
for short trips or if you leave it standing idle
for a lengthy period. Consult a qualified specialist workshop if you wish to leave your
vehicle parked for a long period of time.
Only replace a battery with a battery that has
been recommended by Mercedes-Benz.
i Remove the SmartKey if you park the
vehicle and do not require any electrical
consumers. The vehicle will then use very
little energy, thus conserving battery
power.
Z
Breakdown Assistance
! Have the battery checked regularly at a
267
268
12 V battery (vehicle)
i If the power supply has been interrupted,
e.g. if the battery was discharged, you will
have to:
Rset
the clock (see separate audio system/COMAND operating instructions)
Breakdown Assistance
Charging the battery
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive
gases can escape from the battery. There is a
risk of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, open flames, creating
sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient
ventilation while charging and jump-starting.
Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing.
Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean
over the battery. Keep children away from
batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with
water and seek medical attention.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the vehicle or charging the battery, gases
can escape from the battery. There is a risk of
an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before
charging it or jump-starting.
! Only use battery chargers with a maximum charging voltage of 14.8 V.
! Only charge the battery using the jumpstarting connection point.
The jump-starting connection point is in the
engine compartment (Y page 269).
X Open the hood.
X Connect the battery charger to the positive
terminal and ground point in the same
order as when connecting the donor bat-
tery in the jump-starting procedure
(Y page 269).
If, at low temperatures, the indicator lamps/
warning lamps in the instrument cluster do
not light up, it is highly likely that the discharged battery has frozen. In this case you
may neither jump-start the vehicle nor charge
the battery. The service life of a thawed-out
battery may be shorter. The starting characteristics can be impaired, particularly at low
temperatures. Have the thawed-out battery
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
Only charge the installed battery with a battery charger which has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. A battery
charger unit specially adapted for MercedesBenz vehicles and tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz is available as an accessory.
It permits the charging of the battery in its
installed position. Contact an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center for further information and availability. Read the battery charger's operating instructions before charging
the battery.
Jump-starting
269
Jump-starting
For the jump-starting procedure, use only the jump-starting connection point, consisting of a
positive terminal and an earth point, in the engine compartment.
G WARNING
G WARNING
During charging and jump-starting, explosive gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk
of an explosion.
Particularly avoid fire, open flames, creating sparks and smoking. Ensure there is sufficient ventilation while charging and jump-starting. Do not lean over a battery.
G WARNING
During the charging process, a battery produces hydrogen gas. If a short circuit occurs or sparks
are created, the hydrogen gas can ignite. There is a risk of an explosion.
RMake sure that the positive terminal of a connected battery does not come into contact with
vehicle parts.
RNever place metal objects or tools on a battery.
RIt is important that you observe the described order of the battery terminals when connecting
and disconnecting a battery.
RWhen jump-starting, make sure that the battery poles with identical polarity are connected.
RIt is particularly important to observe the described order when connecting and disconnecting
the jumper cables.
RNever connect or disconnect the battery terminals while the engine is running.
G WARNING
A discharged battery can freeze at temperatures below freezing point. When jump-starting the
vehicle or charging the battery, gases can escape from the battery. There is a risk of an explosion.
Allow the frozen battery to thaw out before charging it or jump-starting.
! Avoid repeated and lengthy starting attempts.
Do not use a rapid-charging device to start the engine.
If, at low temperatures, the indicator lamps/warning lamps in the instrument cluster do not
light up, it is highly likely that the discharged battery has frozen. In this case you may neither
jump-start the vehicle nor charge the battery. The service life of a thawed-out battery may be
shorter. The starting characteristics can be impaired, particularly at low temperatures. Have
the thawed-out battery checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
If the 12 V battery is discharged, or after the vehicle has been jump-started, the Service
Required Do Not Shift Gears Visit Dealer message appears. There is a malfunction in
the on-board voltage. Visit a qualified specialist workshop immediately.
Z
Breakdown Assistance
Battery acid is caustic. There is a risk of injury.
Avoid contact with the skin, eyes or clothing. Do not inhale any battery gases. Do not lean over the
battery. Keep children away from batteries. Wash battery acid immediately with water and seek
medical attention.
Jump-starting
Breakdown Assistance
270
The drive system cannot be started if the 12 V battery is discharged. This is not dependent on
whether the high-voltage battery is charged or not. The vehicle cannot be jump-started if the
high-voltage battery is discharged. The high-voltage battery must be charged first.
The drive system can be started using another vehicle.
ROnly use batteries with an equal nominal voltage (12 volts).
RMake sure that the battery of the donor vehicle does not have a significantly lower capacity
than the discharged battery.
RUse jumper cables with a sufficient cross-section and insulated terminal clamps from a
qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center.
RMake sure that the two vehicles do not touch.
RRoute the jumper cables so that they cannot be caught by rotating components in the engine
compartment.
RDo not disconnect the discharged battery from the vehicle's electrical system.
Switch off the engine of both vehicles.
Shift the transmission to position P.
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Remove the battery cover.
X Connect positive terminal ; on the vehicle with the flat battery to positive terminal = of the
donor vehicle using the red jumper cable. Begin with the flat battery.
X Connect negative terminal ? of the donor vehicle to negative terminal A of the vehicle with
the flat battery using the black jumper cable, beginning with donor vehicle's battery B.
X Start the engine of the donor vehicle and run it at idling speed.
X Switch on the ignition in the vehicle with the flat battery.
X If the traction drive cannot be activated immediately, wait for approximately 60 seconds
between starting attempts.
If the drive system does not start, call a breakdown service.
X
X
Towing
271
i Jumper cables and further information regarding jump-starting can be obtained at any
qualified specialist workshop.
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Functions relevant to safety are restricted or
no longer available if:
Rthe
ignition is switched off
brake system or the power steering is
malfunctioning
Rthere is a malfunction in the power supply
or the vehicle's electrical system
If your vehicle is being towed, much more
force may be necessary to steer or brake.
There is a risk of an accident.
In such cases, use a tow bar. Before towing,
make sure that the steering moves freely.
Rthe
G WARNING
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle
and its weight is greater than the permissible
gross weight of your vehicle, the:
Rthe
towing eye could detach itself
vehicle/trailer combination could rollover.
There is a risk of an accident.
When towing or tow-starting another vehicle,
its weight should not be greater than the permissible gross weight of your vehicle.
Rthe
Information on your vehicle's gross vehicle
mass rating can be found in the "Dimensions
and weights" section (Y page 311).
Make sure that no charging cable is plugged
in. The parking lock cannot be released if a
charging cable is plugged in.
! Observe the following points when towing
with a tow rope:
RSecure the tow rope on the same side on
both vehicles.
that the tow cable is not longer
than legally permitted. Mark the tow
cable in the middle, e.g. with a white
cloth (30 x 30 cm). This will make other
road users aware that the vehicle is being
towed.
ROnly secure the tow cable to the towing
eye.
RObserve the brake lamps of the towing
vehicle while driving. Always maintain a
distance so that the tow rope does not
sag.
RDo not use steel cables or chains to tow
your vehicle. You could otherwise damage the vehicle.
REnsure
! Do not use the towing eyes for recovery
purposes as this could damage the vehicle.
If in doubt, recover the vehicle with a crane.
! If the HOLD function is activated, the vehicle brakes automatically in certain situations. To prevent damage to the vehicle,
deactivate the HOLD function in the following or other similar situations:
Rwhen
Rin
towing the vehicle
the car wash
! Make sure that the electric parking brake
is released. If the electric parking brake is
faulty, visit a qualified specialist workshop.
Mercedes-Benz recommends that you use
an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for
this purpose.
! When towing, pull away slowly and
smoothly. If the tractive power is too high,
the vehicles could be damaged.
Z
Breakdown Assistance
Towing
272
Towing
! The vehicle can be towed a maximum of
30 miles (50km). The towing speed of
30 mph (50 km/h) must not be exceeded.
If the vehicle has to be towed more than
30 miles (50km), the entire vehicle must be
raised and transported.
! Do not tow with sling-type equipment.
Breakdown Assistance
This could damage the vehicle.
Observe the legal requirements for the relevant countries when towing.
If the vehicle can no longer be driven because
of an accident or breakdown, you have the
following options:
the vehicle
As a rule, you should have the vehicle transported.
Rtowing the vehicle with a tow rope or tow
bar
Only tow the vehicle in exceptional cases.
Observe the following notes.
The vehicle may not be towed and must
always be transported if:
i The function of the electric parking brake
and the parking lock is dependent on the
on-board voltage. If the on-board voltage is
low or there is a malfunction in the system,
it may not be possible to apply the released
parking brake or shift the transmission to
position P.
i Switch off non-essential consumers, e.g.
the radio.
i Disarm the automatic locking feature
before the vehicle is towed (Y page 188).
You could otherwise be locked out when
pushing or towing the vehicle.
Rtransporting
Rthe
Installing/removing the towing eye
Installing the towing eye
multifunction display is not working
Rone of more of the following warning lamps
is lit up:
- Drive system
- 12 V battery
Rone or both of the following display messages have appeared:
- Stop Switch Engine Off
- Service Required Do Not Shift
Gears Visit Dealer
Rthe brake pedal begins to pulsate as the
towing procedure commences.
Ryou have to tow the vehicle over a longer
distance than 30 miles (50 km).
The battery must be connected and charged.
Otherwise, you:
Rcannot
turn the SmartKey to position 2 in
the ignition lock
Rcannot release the electric parking brake
Rcannot shift the transmission to position N
Example: towing eye mounting covers
Remove the towing eye from the stowage
space.
The towing eye is located in the stowage
well under the trunk floor.
Vehicles with the TIREFIT kit: the towing
eye is beneath the tire inflation compressor.
X Press the mark on cover : inwards in the
direction of the arrow.
X
Towing
X
Take cover : off the opening.
Screw in the towing eye clockwise as far as
it will go and tighten it.
Removing the towing eye
Unscrew the towing eye counter-clockwise.
X Attach cover : to the bumper and press
until it engages.
X Place the towing eye in the stowage well
under the trunk floor.
X
Towing a vehicle with both axles on
the ground
Observe the important safety instructions
when towing your vehicle with both axles on
the ground (Y page 271).
i In order to signal a change of direction
when towing with the hazard warning lamps
switched on, use the combination switch as
usual. In this case, only the indicator lamps
for the direction of travel flash. After resetting the combination switch, the hazard
warning lamp starts flashing again.
The transmission automatically shifts to position P when you open the driver's or frontpassenger door or when you remove the
SmartKey from the ignition lock. In order to
ensure that the transmission stays in position
N when towing the vehicle, you must observe
the following points:
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 100).
X Leave the SmartKey in position 2 in the
ignition lock.
X
If the 12 V battery indicator lamp lights up,
you must observe the following points:
Pull over and stop the vehicle safely as soon
as possible, paying attention to road and
traffic conditions.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X
Towing the vehicle with the front axle
raised
Observe the important safety notes when
towing your vehicle with the front axle raised
(Y page 271).
! The ignition must be switched off if the
vehicle is being towed with the front axle
raised. Otherwise, ESP® may intervene and
damage the brake system.
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Release the electric parking brake.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 100).
X Turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to
position 0 and leave the SmartKey in the
ignition lock.
X
X
Towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised
When towing your vehicle with the rear axle
raised, it is important that you observe the
safety instructions (Y page 271).
! The ignition must be switched off if you
are towing the vehicle with the rear axle
raised. Intervention by ESP® could otherwise damage the brake system.
Z
Breakdown Assistance
X
273
Fuses
274
The transmission automatically shifts to position P when you open the driver's or frontpassenger door or when you remove the
SmartKey from the ignition lock. In order to
ensure that the transmission stays in position
N when towing the vehicle, you must observe
the following points:
Make sure that the vehicle is stationary.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X Depress and hold the brake pedal.
X Shift the transmission to position N.
X Release the brake pedal.
X Apply the electric parking brake.
X Position the front wheels in the straightahead position.
X Switch on the hazard warning lamps
(Y page 100).
X Turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to
position 0 and leave the SmartKey in the
ignition lock.
Breakdown Assistance
X
Transporting the vehicle
The towing eye can be used to pull the vehicle
onto a trailer or transporter for transporting
purposes.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 2 in the ignition lock.
X When the vehicle is stationary, depress the
brake pedal and keep it depressed.
X Shift the transmission to position N.
axle or steering components. Otherwise,
the vehicle could be damaged.
Fuses
Important safety notes
G WARNING
If you manipulate or bridge a faulty fuse or if
you replace it with a fuse with a higher amperage, the electric cables could be overloaded.
This could result in a fire. There is a risk of an
accident and injury.
Always replace faulty fuses with the specified
new fuses having the correct amperage.
! Only use fuses that have been approved
for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and which
have the correct fuse rating for the system
concerned. Only use fuses marked with an
"S". Otherwise, components or systems
could be damaged.
The fuses in your vehicle serve to close down
faulty circuits. If a fuse blows, all the components on the circuit and their functions stop
operating.
Blown fuses must be replaced with fuses of
the same rating, which you can recognize by
the color and value. The fuse ratings are listed
in the fuse allocation chart.
If a newly inserted fuse also blows, have the
cause traced and rectified at a qualified specialist workshop, e.g. an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
As soon as the vehicle has been loaded:
Prevent the vehicle from rolling away by
applying the electric parking brake.
X Shift the transmission to position P.
X Turn the SmartKey in the ignition lock to
position 0 and remove the SmartKey from
the ignition lock.
X Secure the vehicle.
X
! You may only secure the vehicle by the
wheels, not by parts of the vehicle such as
Before changing a fuse
Secure the vehicle against rolling away
(Y page 144).
X Switch off all electrical consumers.
X Turn the SmartKey to position 0 in the ignition lock and remove it (Y page 127). All
indicator lamps in the instrument cluster
must be off.
X
Fuses
275
The fuses are located in various fuse boxes:
RFuse box in the engine compartment on the
left-hand side of the vehicle, when viewed
in the direction of travel
RFuse box in the front-passenger footwell
The fuse allocation chart is on the fuse box in
the front-passenger footwell (Y page 275).
Fuse box in the engine compartment
When the hood is open and the windshield
wipers are set in motion, you can be injured by
the wiper linkage. There is a risk of injury.
Always switch off the windshield wipers and
the ignition before opening the hood.
! Make sure that no moisture can enter the
fuse box when the cover is open.
! When closing the cover, make sure that it
is lying correctly on the fuse box. Moisture
seeping in or dirt could otherwise impair
the operation of the fuses.
To close: check whether the seal is seated
correctly in cover :.
X Insert cover : at the back into openings
A on the fuse box.
X Slide hood release cable ? to the side and
hold if necessary.
X Fold down cover :.
X Clip hood release cable ? into bracket =.
X Hook clamps ; into the fuse box and
close.
X Close the hood.
X
Fuse box in the front-passenger footwell
Open the hood.
Use a dry cloth to remove any moisture
from the fuse box.
X To open: unclip hood release cable ? from
the bracket =.
X Open retaining clamps ;.
X Fold up cover : in the direction of the
arrow and remove it.
X
X
To open: remove the floormat from the
front-passenger side.
X Fold out perforated floor covering : in the
direction of the arrow.
X
Z
Breakdown Assistance
G WARNING
Fuses
276
To release cover =, press retaining
clamp ;.
X Fold out cover = in the direction of the
arrow to the catch.
X Remove cover = forwards.
Breakdown Assistance
X
i Fuse allocation chart ? is located on the
lower right-hand side of cover =.
To close: insert cover = on the left-hand
side of the fuse box into the retainer.
Cover = engages in the retainers.
X Fold down cover = until clamps ; lock
audibly.
X Fold back perforated floor covering :.
X
277
Useful information ............................ 278
Important safety notes .................... 278
Operation ........................................... 278
Winter operation ............................... 280
Tire pressure ..................................... 281
Loading the vehicle .......................... 288
Maximum load rating ....................... 291
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Standards .......................................... 291
Tire labeling ....................................... 293
Definition of terms for tires and
loading ............................................... 296
Changing a wheel ............................. 299
Wheels and tires
Wheel and tire combinations ........... 303
278
Operation
Useful information
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Tires with run-flat characteristics:
Rpay
attention to the information and warning notices on MOExtended tires (tires with
run-flat characteristics).
Accessories that are not approved for your
vehicle by Mercedes-Benz or are not being
used correctly can impair the operating
safety.
Before purchasing and using non-approved
accessories, visit a qualified specialist workshop and ask about:
Rsuitability
Rlegal
Important safety notes
Wheels and tires
G WARNING
If wheels and tires of the wrong size are used,
the wheel brakes or suspension components
may be damaged. There is a risk of an accident.
Always replace wheels and tires with those
that fulfill the specifications of the original
part.
When replacing wheels, make sure to use the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmodel
When replacing tires, make sure to use the
correct:
Rdesignation
Rmanufacturer
Rmodel
G WARNING
A flat tire severely impairs the driving, steering and braking characteristics of the vehicle.
There is a risk of accident.
Tires without run-flat characteristics:
Rdo
not drive with a flat tire.
replace the flat tire with your
emergency spare wheel or spare wheel, or
consult a qualified specialist workshop.
Rimmediately
stipulations
recommendations
Information on dimensions and types of
wheels and tires for your vehicle can be found
(Y page 303).
Information on air pressure for the tires on
your vehicle can be found:
Rfactory
Ron
the vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar
Ron the tire pressure label on the charge
socket flap (Y page 281)
Runder "Tire pressure" (Y page 281)
i Further information on wheels and tires
can be obtained at any qualified specialist
workshop.
Operation
Information on driving
RIf
the vehicle is heavily loaded, check the
tire pressures and correct them if necessary.
RWhile driving, pay attention to vibrations,
noises and unusual handling characteristics, e.g. pulling to one side. This may indicate that the wheels or tires are damaged.
If you suspect that a tire is defective,
reduce your speed immediately. Stop the
vehicle as soon as possible to check the
wheels and tires for damage. Hidden tire
damage could also be causing the unusual
Operation
Regular checking of wheels and tires
G WARNING
Damaged tires can cause tire inflation pressure loss. As a result, you could lose control of
your vehicle. There is a risk of accident.
Check the tires regularly for signs of damage
and replace any damaged tires immediately.
Check the wheels and tires of your vehicle for
damage at least once a month, as well as after
driving off-road or on rough roads. Damaged
wheels can cause a loss of tire pressure. Pay
particular attention to damage such as:
Rcuts
in the tires
Rpunctures
Rtears in the tires
Rbulges on tires
Rdeformation or severe corrosion on wheels
Regularly check the tire tread depth and the
condition of the tread across the whole width
of the tire (Y page 279). If necessary, turn the
front wheels to full lock in order to inspect the
inner side of the tire surface.
All wheels must have a valve cap to protect
the valve against dirt and moisture. Do not
mount anything onto the valve other than the
standard valve cap or other valve caps
approved by Mercedes-Benz for your vehicle.
Do not use any other valve caps or systems,
e.g. tire pressure monitoring systems.
Regularly check the pressure of all the tires
particularly prior to long trips. Adjust the tire
pressure as necessary (Y page 281).
The service life of tires depends, among other
things, on the following factors:
Rdriving
style
pressure
Rdistance covered
Rtire
Important safety notes on the tire
tread
G WARNING
Insufficient tire tread will reduce tire traction.
The tire is no longer able to dissipate water.
This means that on wet road surfaces, the risk
of hydroplaning increases, in particular where
speed is not adapted to suit the driving conditions. There is a risk of accident.
If the tire pressure is too high or too low, tires
may exhibit different levels of wear at different locations on the tire tread. Thus, you
should regularly check the tread depth and
the condition of the tread across the entire
width of all tires.
Minimum tire tread depth for:
RSummer
tires: â in (3 mm)
tires: ã in (4 mm)
For safety reasons, replace the tires before
the legally prescribed limit for the minimum
tire tread depth is reached.
RM+S
Bar indicator : for tread wear is integrated
into the tire tread.
Treadwear indicators (TWI) are required by
law. Six indicators are positioned on the tire
tread. They are visible once the tread depth is
Z
Wheels and tires
handling characteristics. If you find no
signs of damage, have the tires and wheels
checked at a qualified specialist workshop.
RWhen parking your vehicle, make sure that
the tires do not get deformed by the curb or
other obstacles. If it is necessary to drive
over curbs, speed humps or similar elevations, try to do so slowly and at an obtuse
angle. Otherwise, the tires, particularly the
sidewalls, may be damaged.
279
280
Winter operation
approximately á in (1.6 mm). If this is the
case, the tire is so worn that it must be
replaced.
Selecting, mounting and replacing
tires
Wheels and tires
ROnly
mount tires and wheels of the same
type and make.
Exception: it is permissible to install a different type or make in the event of a flat
tire. Observe the "Tires with run-flat characteristics" section (Y page 264).
ROnly mount tires of the correct size onto
the wheels.
RBreak in new tires at moderate speeds for
the first 60 miles (100 km). The tires only
reach their full performance after this distance.
RDo not drive with tires which have too little
tread depth, as this significantly reduces
the traction on wet roads (hydroplaning).
RReplace the tires after six years at the latest, regardless of wear.
Winter operation
General notes
Have your vehicle winterproofed at a qualified
specialist workshop at the onset of winter.
Observe the notes in the "Changing a wheel"
section (Y page 299).
Driving with summer tires
At temperatures below 45 ‡ (+7 †), summer
tires lose elasticity and therefore traction and
braking power. Change the tires on your vehicle to M+S tires. Using summer tires at very
cold temperatures could cause cracks to
form, thereby damaging the tires permanently. Mercedes-Benz cannot accept
responsibility for this type of damage.
M+S tires
G WARNING
M+S tires with a tire tread depth of less than
ã in (4 mm) are not suitable for use in winter
and do not provide sufficient traction. There is
a risk of an accident.
M+S tires with a tread depth of less than ã in
(4 mm) must be replaced immediately.
At temperatures below 45 ‡ (+7 †), use winter tires or all-season tires. Both types of tire
are identified by the M+S marking.
Only winter tires bearing the i snowflake
symbol in addition to the M+S marking provide the best possible grip in wintry road conditions. Only these tires will allow driving
safety systems such as ABS and ESP® to
function optimally in winter. These tires have
been developed specifically for driving in
snow.
Use M+S tires of the same make and tread on
all wheels to maintain safe handling characteristics.
Always observe the maximum permissible
speed specified for the M+S tires you have
mounted.
Once the winter tires are mounted:
X
X
Check the tire pressures (Y page 284).
Restart the tire pressure monitor
(Y page 287).
Snow chains
G WARNING
If snow chains are mounted on the rear
wheels, the snow chains could cause abrasion
to the vehicle body or to chassis components.
This could cause damage to the vehicle or the
tires. There is a risk of an accident.
Tire pressure
To avoid hazardous situations:
Tire pressure
Rnever
Tire pressure specifications
! On some tire sizes there is not enough
space for snow chains. To avoid damage to
the vehicle or tires, observe the "Wheel and
tire combinations" section under "Tires and
wheels".
For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you only use snow chains that
have been specially approved for your vehicle
by Mercedes-Benz, or are of a corresponding
standard of quality.
If you intend to mount snow chains, please
bear the following points in mind:
RSnow
chains may not be mounted on all
wheel/tire combinations. Permissible
wheel-tire combinations (Y page 303).
ROnly use snow chains when driving on
roads completely covered by snow.
Remove the snow chains as soon as possible when you come to a road that is not
snow-covered.
RLocal regulations may restrict the use of
snow chains. Observe the appropriate regulations if you wish to mount snow chains.
RDo not exceed the maximum permissible
speed of 30 mph (50 km/h).
RWhen snow chains are installed, never use
Active Parking Assist (Y page 159).
i You may wish to deactivate ESP®
(Y page 67) when pulling away with snow
chains installed. You can thereby allow the
wheels to spin in a controlled manner, achieving an increased driving force (cutting
action).
G WARNING
Underinflated or overinflated tires pose the
following risks:
Rthe
tires may burst, especially as the load
and vehicle speed increase.
Rthe tires may wear excessively and/or
unevenly, which may greatly impair tire
traction.
Rthe driving characteristics, as well as steering and braking, may be greatly impaired.
There is a risk of an accident.
Follow recommended tire inflation pressures
and check the pressure of all the tires including the spare wheel:
Rmonthly,
at least
the load changes
Rbefore beginning a long journey
Runder different operating conditions, e.g.
off-road driving
If necessary, correct the tire pressure.
Rif
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the
tire pressure. The outer appearance of a tire
does not permit any reliable conclusion about
the tire pressure. On vehicles equipped with
the electronic tire pressure monitor, the tire
pressure can be checked in the on-board
computer.
The recommended tire pressures for the tires
mounted at the factory can be found on the
labels described here.
1.) Tire and Loading Information placard
on the B-pillar on the driver's side of the vehicle (Y page 288).
The Tire and Loading Information placard contains the recommended tire pressures for
cold tires. The recommended tire pressures
are valid for the maximum permissible load
and up to the maximum permissible vehicle
speed.
Z
Wheels and tires
mount snow chains on the rear
wheels
Ronly mount snow chains in pairs on the
front wheels.
281
Wheels and tires
282
Tire pressure
: Recommended tire pressures
Example: tire pressure table with tire dimensions
2.) Tire pressure table on the inside of the
charge socket flap.
The tire pressure table contains the recommended pressures for cold tires for various
operating conditions, i.e. differing load and
speed conditions.
Some tire pressure tables show only the rim
diameters instead of the full tire size, e.g.
R18. Rim diameter is part of the tire size and
can be found on the tire sidewall
(Y page 293).
i Specifications shown in the examples of
tire pressure tables are for illustration purposes only. Tire pressure specifications are
vehicle-specific and may deviate from the
data shown here. Tire pressure specifications applicable to your vehicle are located
in your vehicle's tire pressure table.
If the tire pressure have been set for light
loads and/or low speeds, set them to the
higher values:
Rif
you want to drive with an increased load
and/or
Rif you want to drive at higher road speeds
i The tire pressures for increased loads
Example: tire pressure table for all tires permitted
for this vehicle by the factory
If a tire size precedes a tire pressure, the tire
pressure information following is only valid
for that tire size. The load conditions "partially
laden" and "fully laden" are defined in the
table for different numbers of occupants and
amounts of luggage. The actual number of
seats may differ.
and/or higher road speeds, shown in the
tire pressure table, may have a negative
effect on driving comfort.
If the tire pressure is not set correctly, this
can lead to an excessive build up of heat and
a sudden loss of pressure.
For more information, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
Tire pressure
G WARNING
If the tire pressure drops repeatedly, the
wheel, valve or tire may be damaged. Tire
pressure that is too low may result in a tire
blow-out. There is a risk of an accident.
RCheck the tire for foreign objects.
RCheck whether the wheel is losing air or the
valve is leaking.
If you are unable to rectify the damage, contact a qualified specialist workshop.
G WARNING
If you fit unsuitable accessories onto tire
valves, the tire valves may be overloaded and
malfunction, which can cause tire pressure
loss. Due to their design, retrofitted tire pressure monitors keep the tire valve open. This
can also result in tire pressure loss. There is a
risk of an accident.
Only screw the standard valve cap or other
valve caps approved by Mercedes-Benz for
your vehicle onto the tire valve.
Use a suitable pressure gauge to check the
tire pressure. The outer appearance of a tire
does not permit any reliable conclusion about
the tire pressure.
The tire temperature and pressure increase
when the vehicle is in motion. This is dependent on the driving speed and the load.
Therefore, you should only correct tire pressures when the tires are cold.
The tires are cold:
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tires
out of direct sunlight for at least 3 hours
and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further
than 1 mile (1.6 km)
The tire temperature changes depending on
the outside temperature, the vehicle speed
and the tire load. If the tire temperature
changes by 18 ‡ (10 †), the tire pressure
changes by approximately 10 kPa (0.1 bar/
1.5 psi). Take this into account when check-
ing the pressure of warm tires. Only correct
the tire pressure if it is too low for the current
operating conditions. If you check the tire
pressure when the tires are warm, the resulting value will be higher than if the tires were
cold. This is normal. Do not reduce the tire
pressure to the value specified for cold tires.
The tire pressure would otherwise be too low.
Observe the recommended tire pressures for
cold tires:
Ron the Tire and Loading Information placard
on the B-pillar on the driver's side
Rin the tire pressure table on the inside of the
fuel filler flap
Underinflated or overinflated tires
Underinflated tires
G WARNING
Tires with pressure that is too low can overheat and burst as a consequence. In addition,
they also suffer from excessive and/or irregular wear, which can severely impair the braking properties and the driving characteristics.
There is a risk of an accident.
Avoid tire pressures that are too low in all the
tires, including the spare wheel.
Underinflated tires may:
Rwear
excessively and/or unevenly
Rhave an adverse effect on energy consump-
tion
Roverheat,
leading to tire defects
Rhave an adverse effect on handling charac-
teristics
Overinflated tires
G WARNING
Tires with excessively high pressure can burst
because they are damaged more easily by
road debris, potholes etc. In addition, they
also suffer from irregular wear, which can
severely impair the braking properties and the
Z
Wheels and tires
Important notes on tire pressure
283
284
Tire pressure
driving characteristics. There is a risk of an
accident.
Avoid tire pressures that are too high in all the
tires, including the spare wheel.
Overinflated tires may:
Radversely
affect handling
excessively and/or unevenly
Rbe more likely to become damaged
Rhave an adverse effect on ride comfort
Rincrease the braking distance
Rwear
Wheels and tires
Maximum tire pressures
Do not exceed the maximum permissible tire
inflation pressure. Always observe the recommended tire pressure for your vehicle
when adjusting the tire pressure
(Y page 281).
: Example: maximum permissible tire pres-
Information on air pressure for the tires on
your vehicle can be found:
Ron
the vehicle's Tire and Loading Information placard on the B-pillar
Ron the tire pressure label on the fuel filler
flap
Rin the "Tire pressure information" section
Checking tire pressures manually
To determine and set the correct tire pressure, proceed as follows:
Remove the valve cap of the tire that is to
be checked.
X Press the tire pressure gauge securely onto
the valve.
X Read the tire pressure and compare it with
the recommended value on the Tire and
Loading Information placard. The loading
information table is on the B-pillar on the
driver's side of your vehicle.
X If necessary, increase the tire pressure to
the recommended value (Y page 281).
X If the tire pressure is too high, release air by
pressing down the metal pin in the valve
using the tip of a pen, for example. Then,
check the tire pressure again using the tire
pressure gauge.
X Screw the valve cap onto the valve.
X Repeat these steps for the other tires.
X
sure
i The actual values for tires are vehicle-
specific and may deviate from the values in
the illustration.
Checking the tire pressures
Important safety notes
Observe the "Tire pressure information" section (Y page 281).
Tire pressure monitor
General notes
If a tire pressure monitor is installed, the vehicle's wheels have sensors that monitor the
tire pressures in all four tires. The tire pressure monitor warns you if the pressure drops
in one or more of the tires. The tire pressure
monitor only functions if the correct sensors
are installed on all wheels.
Information on tire pressures is displayed in
the multifunction display. After a few minutes
of driving, the current tire pressure of each
tire is shown in the Serv. menu of the multifunction display.
Example: current tire pressure display
For information on the message display, refer
to the "Checking the tire pressure electronically" section (Y page 286).
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
should be checked at least once every two
weeks when cold and inflated to the pressure
recommended by the vehicle manufacturer
on the Tire and Loading Information placard
on the driver's door B-pillar or the tire pressure label on the inside of the fuel filler flap. If
your vehicle has tires of a different size than
the size indicated on the Tire and Loading
Information placard or, if available, the tire
pressure label, you should determine the
proper tire pressure for those tires.
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has
been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring
system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when one or more of your tires
are significantly underinflated. Accordingly,
when the low tire pressure telltale lights up,
you should stop and check your tires as soon
as possible, and inflate them to the proper
pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can
lead to tire failure.
Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency
and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's
handling and stopping ability. Please note that
the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if
underinflation has not reached the level to
trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate when
the system is not operating properly. The
TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with
the low tire pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the warning lamp
will flash for approximately a minute and then
remain continuously illuminated. This
sequence will be repeated every time the vehicle is started as long as the malfunction
exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect
or signal low tire pressure as intended.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of
reasons, including the installation of incompatible replacement or alternate tires or
wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS
from functioning properly. Always check the
TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one
or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to
ensure that the replacement or alternate Tires
and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to
function properly.
It is the driver's responsibility to set the tire
pressure to that recommended for cold tires
which is suitable for the operating situation
(Y page 281). Note that the correct tire pressure for the current operating situation must
first be taught-in to the tire pressure monitor.
If there is a substantial loss of pressure, the
warning threshold for the warning message is
aligned to the reference values taught-in.
Restart the tire pressure monitor after adjusting the pressure of the cold tires
(Y page 287). The current pressures are
saved as new reference values. As a result, a
warning message will appear if the tire pressure drops significantly.
The tire pressure monitor does not warn you
of an incorrectly set tire pressure. Observe
the notes on the recommended tire pressure
(Y page 281).
The tire pressure monitor is not able to warn
you of a sudden loss of pressure, e.g. if the
Z
285
Wheels and tires
Tire pressure
286
Tire pressure
tire is penetrated by a foreign object. In the
event of a sudden loss of pressure, bring the
vehicle to a halt by braking carefully. Avoid
sudden steering movements.
The tire pressure monitor has a yellow warning lamp in the instrument cluster for indicating a pressure loss or malfunction. Whether
the warning lamp flashes or lights up indicates whether a tire pressure is too low or the
tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning:
the warning lamp is lit continuously, the
tire pressure on one or more tires is significantly too low. The tire pressure monitor is
not malfunctioning.
Rif the warning lamp flashes for around a
minute and then remains lit constantly, the
tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning.
Wheels and tires
Rif
i In addition to the warning lamp, a mes-
sage appears in the multifunction display.
Further information can be found on
(Y page 211).
If the tire pressure monitor is malfunctioning,
it may take more than 10 minutes for the tire
pressure warning lamp to inform you of the
malfunction. When the malfunction has been
rectified, the tire pressure warning lamp goes
out after a few minutes of driving.
The tire pressure values indicated by the onboard computer may differ from those measured at a gas station with a pressure gauge.
The tire pressures shown by the on-board
computer refer to those measured at sea
level. At high altitudes, the tire pressure values indicated by a pressure gauge are higher
than those shown by the on-board computer.
In this case, do not reduce the tire pressures.
The operation of the tire pressure monitor can
be affected by interference from radio transmitting equipment (e.g. radio headphones,
two-way radios) that may be being operated
in or near the vehicle.
Checking the tire pressure electronically
Make sure that the SmartKey is in position
2 in the ignition lock (Y page 127).
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tire Pressure.
Pressure
X Press the a button.
The current tire pressure of each tire is
shown in the multifunction display.
X
If the vehicle has been parked for over
20 minutes, the Tire pressure will be
displayed after driving a few
minutes message appears.
After a teach-in process, the tire pressure
monitor automatically detects new wheels or
new sensors. As long as a clear allocation of
the tire pressure value to the individual
wheels is not possible, the Tire Pressure
Monitor Active message is shown instead
of the tire pressure display. The tire pressures
are already being monitored.
Tire pressure monitor warning messages
If the tire pressure monitor detects a pressure
loss in a tire, a warning message is shown in
the multifunction display and the yellow tire
pressure monitor warning lamp comes on.
RIf
the Please Correct Tire Pressure
message appears in the multifunction display, the tire pressure in at least one tire is
too low. Correct the tire pressure at the
next opportunity.
RIf the Check Tires message appears in the
multifunction display, the tire pressure in at
least one tire has dropped significantly.
Check the tires.
RIf the Warning Tire Malfunction message appears in the multifunction display,
the tire pressure in at least one tire has
dropped suddenly. Check the tires.
Tire pressure
i If the wheel positions are rotated, the tire
pressure may be displayed for the wrong
positions. This is rectified after a few
minutes of driving, and the tire pressures
are displayed for the correct positions.
after driving a few minutes message.
X Press the : button.
The Use Current Pressures as New
Reference Values message appears in
the multifunction display.
If you wish to confirm the restart:
X
Restarting the tire pressure monitor
When you restart the tire pressure monitor, all
existing warning messages are deleted and
the warning lamps go out. The monitor uses
the currently set tire pressures as the reference values for monitoring. In most cases, the
tire pressure monitor will automatically
detect the new reference values after you
have changed the tire pressure. However, you
can also define reference values manually as
described here. The tire pressure monitor
then monitors the new tire pressure values.
X Set the tire pressure to the value recommended for the corresponding driving situation on the Tire and Loading Information
placard on the driver's side
B-pillar (Y page 281).
Additional tire pressure values for different
operating conditions can also be found on
the tire pressure table on the inside of the
charge socket flap (Y page 281).
X Make sure that the tire pressure is correct
on all four wheels.
X Make sure that the SmartKey is in position
2 in the ignition lock.
X Press the = or ; button on the steering wheel to select the Serv. menu.
X Press the 9 or : button to select
Tire Pressure.
Pressure
X Press the a button.
The multifunction display shows the current tire pressure for the individual tires or
the Tire pressure will be displayed
Press the a button.
The Tire Press. Monitor Restarted
message appears in the multifunction display.
After driving for a few minutes, the system
checks whether the current tire pressures
are within the specified range. The new tire
pressures are then accepted as reference
values and monitored.
If you wish to cancel the restart:
X
Press the % button.
The tire pressure values stored at the last
restart will continue to be monitored.
Radio type approval for the tire pressure monitor
Country
Radio type approval number
Brazil
1489-10-4415
Model: MRXMERCTX1
Dubai
TRA, Registered NO
0016161/08
TRA, Registered NO
ER0076990/11
Dealer NO: DA0047074/10
Morocco
MR5526 ANRT 2010/
27/04/2010
MR6706 ANRT 2011/
17/11/2011
Philippines
ESD-1105558C
Serbia
И 011 12
Z
Wheels and tires
Observe the instructions and safety notes in
the display messages in the "Tires" section
(Y page 211).
287
288
Loading the vehicle
Country
Radio type approval number
Singapore
Compliance with IDA Standard
N0140-09
South
Africa
TA-2008/1068
TA-2011/1370
gross vehicle weight rating. It is made up
of the vehicle weight, all vehicle occupants and the load. You can also find
information about the maximum gross
axle weight rating on the front and rear
axle.
The maximum gross axle weight rating is
the maximum weight that can be carried
by one axle (front or rear axle). Do not
exceed the maximum gross vehicle
weight or the maximum gross axle weight
rating for the front or rear axle.
Loading the vehicle
Wheels and tires
Instruction labels for tires and loads
G WARNING
Overloaded tires can overheat, causing a
blowout. Overloaded tires can also impair the
steering and driving characteristics and lead
to brake failure. There is a risk of accident.
Observe the load rating of the tires. The load
rating must be at least half of the GAWR of
your vehicle. Never overload the tires by
exceeding the maximum load.
Maximum permissible mass.
X
: B-pillar, driver's side
Two instruction labels on your vehicle show
the maximum possible load.
(1) The Tire and Loading Information placard
is on B-pillar : on the driver's side. The
Tire and Loading Information placard
shows the maximum permissible number
of occupants and the maximum permissible vehicle load. It also contains details
of the tire sizes and corresponding pressures for tires mounted at the factory.
(2) The vehicle identification plate is on the
B-pillar on the driver's side. The vehicle
identification plate informs you of the
Specification for maximum permissible
weight : is listed on the Tire and Loading
Information placard: "The combined weight
of occupants and cargo should never
exceed XXX kilograms or XXX lbs."
The gross weight of all vehicle occupants,
load and luggage must not exceed the specified value.
i The specifications shown on the Tire and
Loading Information placard in the illustration are examples. The maximum permissible load is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data shown here. The maximum permissible load that applies for your
vehicle can be found on your vehicle's Tire
and Loading Information placard.
Loading the vehicle
Number of seats
Maximum number of seats : indicates the
maximum number of occupants allowed to
travel in the vehicle. This information can be
found on the Tire and Loading Information
placard.
289
Step 4: The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and luggage load
capacity. For example, if the "XXX" amount
equals 1400 lbs and there will be five
150-lb passengers in your vehicle, the
amount of available cargo and luggage load
capacity is 650 lbs (1400 Ò 750 (5 x 150) =
650 lbs).
X Step 5: Determine the combined weight of
luggage and cargo being loaded on the
vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed
the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.
X
i The specifications shown on the Tire and
Wheels and tires
Loading Information placard in the illustration are examples. The number of seats is
vehicle-specific and can differ from the
details shown. The number of seats in your
vehicle can be found on the Tire and Loading Information placard.
Determining the correct load limit
Step-by-step instructions
The following steps have been developed as
required of all manufacturers under Title 49,
Code of U.S. Federal Regulations, Part 575
pursuant to the "National Traffic and Motor
Vehicle Safety Act of 1966".
Step 1: Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo
should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on
your vehicle's Tire and Loading Information
placard.
X Step 2: Determine the combined weight of
the driver and passengers that will be riding
in your vehicle.
X Step 3: Subtract the combined weight of
the driver and passengers from XXX kilograms or XXX lbs.
X
Z
290
Loading the vehicle
Example: steps 1 to 3
The following table shows examples of how to calculate total and cargo load capacities with
varying seating configurations and different numbers of occupants. The following examples
use a maximum load of 1,500 lbs (680 kg). This is for illustration purposes only. Make sure
you are using the actual load limit for your vehicle stated on your vehicle's Tire and Loading
Information placard (Y page 289).
The greater the combined weight of the occupants, the lower the maximum luggage load.
Step 1
Wheels and tires
Step 2
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
1500 lbs
(680 kg)
1500 lbs
(680 kg)
1500 lbs
(680 kg)
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
Number of people in
the vehicle (driver
and occupants)
5
3
1
Distribution of the
occupants
Front: 2
Rear: 3
Front: 1
Rear: 2
Front: 1
Weight of the occupants
Occupant 1:
150 lbs (68 kg)
Occupant 2:
180 lbs (82 kg)
Occupant 3:
160 lbs (73 kg)
Occupant 4:
140 lbs (63 kg)
Occupant 5:
120 lbs (54 kg)
Occupant 1:
200 lbs (91 kg)
Occupant 2:
190 lbs (86 kg)
Occupant 3:
150 lbs (68 kg)
Occupant 1:
150 lbs (68 kg)
Gross weight of all
occupants
750 lbs (340 kg) 540 lbs (245 kg) 150 lbs (68 kg)
Combined maximum
weight of occupants
and load (data from
the Tire and Loading
Information placard)
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards
Step 3
Permissible load
(maximum gross
vehicle weight rating
from the Tire and
Loading Information
placard minus the
gross weight of all
occupants)
Example 1
Example 2
Example 3
1500 lbs
(680 kg) Ò
750 lbs (340 kg)
= 750 lbs
(340 kg)
1500 lbs
(680 kg) Ò
540 lbs (245 kg)
=960 lbs
(435 kg)
1500 lbs
(680 kg) Ò
150 lbs (68 kg) =
1350 lbs
(612 kg)
291
When you have calculated the total load, you
should make sure that the gross vehicle
weight rating and the gross axle weight rating
are not exceeded. Details can be found on the
vehicle identification plate on the B-pillar on
the driver's side of the vehicle (Y page 288).
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating: the gross
weight of the vehicle, all passengers and the
load must not exceed the permissible gross
vehicle weight rating.
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR): the
maximum permissible weight that can be carried by one axle (front or rear axle).
To ensure that your vehicle does not exceed
the maximum permissible values, have your
loaded vehicle (including driver, occupants,
load) weighed on a vehicle weighbridge.
Maximum load rating
Maximum tire load : is the maximum permissible weight for which the tire is approved.
i The actual values for tires are vehicle-
specific and may deviate from the values in
the illustration.
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards
Overview of Tire Quality Grading
Standards
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit. The maximum permissible load can be found on the vehicle's Tire and
Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on
the driver's side (Y page 288).
Z
Wheels and tires
Vehicle identification plate
292
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards are
U.S. government specifications. Their purpose is to provide drivers with uniform reliable information on tire performance data. tire
manufacturers have to grade tires using three
performance factors: tread wear :, tire traction ; and heat resistance =. These regulations do not apply to Canada. Nevertheless,
all tires sold in North America are provided
with the corresponding quality grading markings on the sidewall of the tire.
All passenger car tires must conform to the
statutory safety requirements in addition to
these grades.
Quality grades can be found, where applicable, on the tire sidewall between the tread
shoulder and maximum tire width.
Wheels and tires
i The actual values for tires are vehicle-
specific and may deviate from the values in
the illustration.
For example:
Treadwear
Traction
Temperature
200
AA
A
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested
under controlled conditions on a specified
U.S. government course. For example, a tire
graded 150 would wear one and one-half
times as well on the government course as a
tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires depends
upon the actual conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate conditions.
Traction
G WARNING
The traction grade assigned to this tire is
based on straight-ahead braking traction
tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak traction characteristics.
The traction grades – from highest to lowest –
are AA, A, B and C. Those grades represent
the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as
measured under controlled conditions on
specified government test surfaces of asphalt
and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor
traction performance.
The safe speed on a wet, snow covered or icy
road is always lower than on dry road surfaces.
You should pay special attention to road conditions when temperatures are around the
freezing point.
Mercedes-Benz recommends a minimum
tread depth of ã in (4 mm) for all four winter
tires (Y page 280) to maintain normal driving
characteristics in winter. Winter tires can
reduce the braking distance on snow-covered
surfaces in comparison with summer tires.
The braking distance is still much further than
on surfaces that are not icy or covered with
snow. Take appropriate care when driving.
! Avoid wheelspin. This can lead to damage
to the drive train.
Temperature
G WARNING
The temperature grade for this tire is established for a tire that is properly inflated and
not overloaded. Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or
in combination, can cause excessive heat
build-up and possible tire failure.
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B,
and C. They represent the tire's resistance to
Tire labeling
the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test
wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause
the material of the tire to degenerate and
reduce tire life, and excessive temperature
can lead to sudden tire failure. The grade C
corresponds to a level of performance which
all passenger car tires must meet under the
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No.
109. Grades B and A represent higher levels
of performance on the laboratory test wheel
than the minimum required by law.
293
D Load index (Y page 295)
E Tire name
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.
Tire size designation, load-bearing
capacity and speed rating
Tire labeling
:
;
=
?
A
B
Tire width
Nominal aspect ratio in %
Tire code
Rim diameter
Load bearing index
Speed rating
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.
The following markings are on the tire in addition to
the tire name (sales designation) and the manufacturer's name:
: Uniform tire Quality Grading Standard
(Y page 297)
; DOT tire Identification Number
=
?
A
B
C
(Y page 295)
Maximum tire load (Y page 291)
Maximum tire pressures (Y page 284)
Manufacturer
Tire material (Y page 296)
Tire size designation, load-bearing capacity and speed rating (Y page 293)
General: depending on the manufacturer's
standards, the size imprinted in the tire wall
may not contain any letters or may contain
one letter that precedes the size description.
If there is no letter preceding the size description (as shown above): these are passenger
vehicle tires according to European manufacturing standards.
If "P" precedes the size description: these are
passenger vehicle tires according to U.S.
manufacturing standards.
If "LT" precedes the size description: these
are light truck tires according to U.S. manufacturing standards.
If "T" precedes the size description: compact
emergency wheels with high tire pressure
Z
Wheels and tires
Overview of tire labeling
Wheels and tires
294
Tire labeling
that are only designed for temporary use in an
emergency.
Tire width: tire width : shows the nominal
tire width in millimeters.
Height-width ratio: aspect ratio ; is the
size ratio between the tire height and tire
width and is shown in percent. The aspect
ratio is calculated by dividing the tire width by
the tire height.
Tire code: tire code = specifies the tire type.
"R" represents radial tires; "D" represents
diagonal tires; "B" represents diagonal radial
tires.
Optionally, tires with a maximum speed of
over 149 mph (240 km/h) may have "ZR" in
the size description, depending on the manufacturer (e.g. 245/40 ZR 18).
Rim diameter: rim diameter ? is the diameter of the bead seat, not the diameter of the
rim flange. The rim diameter is specified in
inches (in).
Load-bearing index: load-bearing index A
is a numerical code that specifies the maximum load-bearing capacity of a tire.
Do not overload the tires by exceeding the
specified load limit. The maximum permissible load can be found on the vehicle's Tire and
Loading Information placard on the B-pillar on
the driver's side (Y page 288).
Example:
Load-bearing index 91 indicates a maximum
load of 1,356 lb (615 kg) that the tires can
bear. For further information on the maximum
tire load in kilograms and pounds, see
(Y page 291).
For further information on the load-bearing
index, see "Load index" (Y page 295).
Speed rating: speed rating B specifies the
approved maximum speed of the tire.
G WARNING
Exceeding the stated tire load-bearing capacity and the approved maximum speed could
lead to tire damage or the tire bursting. There
is a risk of accident.
Therefore, only use tire types and sizes
approved for your vehicle model. Observe the
tire load rating and speed rating required for
your vehicle.
Regardless of the speed rating, always
observe the speed limits. Drive carefully and
adapt your driving style to the traffic conditions.
Summer tires
Index
Speed rating
Q
up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
R
up to 106 mph (170 km/h)
S
up to 112 mph (180 km/h)
T
up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
H
up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
V
up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
W
up to 168 mph (270 km/h)
Y
up to 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR...Y
up to 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR...(..Y)
over 186 mph (300 km/h)
ZR
over 149 mph (240 km/h)
RTires
with a maximum speed of over
149 mph (240 km/h) may have "ZR" in the
size description, depending on the manufacturer (e.g. 245/40 ZR18).
The service specification is made up of
load-bearing index A and speed rating B.
RIf the size description of your tire includes
"ZR" and there are no service specifications, ask the tire manufacturer in order to
find out the maximum speed.
If a service specification is available, the
maximum speed is limited according to the
speed rating in the service specification.
Example: 245/40 ZR18 97 Y. In this example, "97 Y" is the service specification. The
letter "Y" represents the speed rating. The
Tire labeling
All-weather tires and winter tires
Index
Speed rating
Q M+S4
up to 100 mph (160 km/h)
T M+S4
up to 118 mph (190 km/h)
H M+S4
up to 130 mph (210 km/h)
V M+S4
up to 149 mph (240 km/h)
i Not all tires with the M+S marking provide
the driving characteristics of winter tires. In
addition to the M+S marking, winter tires
also have the i snowflake symbol on
the tire wall. Tires with this marking fulfill
the requirements of the Rubber Manufacturers Association (RMA) and the Rubber
Association of Canada (RAC) regarding the
tire traction on snow. They have been especially developed for driving on snow.
An electronic speed limiter prevents your
vehicle from exceeding a speed of 100mph
(160km/h).
The speed rating of tires mounted at the factory may be higher than the maximum speed
that the electronic speed limiter permits.
Make sure that your tires have the required
speed rating, e.g. when buying new tires. The
required speed rating for your vehicle can be
found in the "Tires" section (Y page 303).
Further information about reading tire data
can be obtained from any qualified specialist
workshop.
4
Load index
In addition to the load bearing index, load
index : may be imprinted after the letters
that identify speed index B on the sidewall of
the tire (Y page 293).
RIf no specification is given: no text (as in the
example above), represents a standard
load (SL) tire
RXL or Extra Load: represents a reinforced
tire
RLight Load: represents a light load tire
RC, D, E: represents a load range that
depends on the maximum load that the tire
can carry at a certain pressure
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.
DOT, Tire Identification Number (TIN)
Canadian tire regulations prescribe that every
manufacturer of new tires or retreader has to
imprint a TIN in or on the sidewall.
Or M+S i for winter tires.
Z
Wheels and tires
maximum speed of the tire is limited to
186 mph (300 km/h).
RThe size description for all tires with maximum speeds of over 186 mph (300 km/h)
must include "ZR". The service specification must be given in brackets. Example:
275/40 ZR 18 (99 Y). Speed rating "(Y)"
indicates that the maximum speed of the
tire is over 186 mph (300 km/h). Ask the
tire manufacturer about the maximum
speed.
295
Wheels and tires
296
Definition of terms for tires and loading
The TIN is a unique identification number. The
TIN enables the tire manufacturers or retreaders to inform purchasers of recalls and other
safety-relevant matters. It makes it possible
for the purchaser to easily identify the affected tires.
The TIN is made up of manufacturer identification code ;, tire size =, tire type code ?
and manufacturing date A.
DOT (Department of Transportation): tire
symbol : indicates that the tire complies
with the requirements of the Canadian transport ministry.
Manufacturer identification code: manufacturer identification code ; provides
details on the tire manufacturer. New tires
have a code with two symbols. Retreaded
tires have a code with four symbols.
For further information about retreaded tires,
see (Y page 278).
Tire size: identifier = describes the tire size.
Tire type code: tire type code ? can be used
by the manufacturer as a code to describe
specific characteristics of the tire.
Date of manufacture: date of manufacture
A provides information about the age of a
tire. The first and second positions represent
the week of manufacture, starting with "01"
for the first calendar week. Positions three
and four represent the year of manufacture.
For example, a tire that is marked with
"3208", was manufactured in week 32 in
2008.
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may devi-
Tire characteristics
This information describes the type of tire
cord and the number of layers in sidewall :
and under tire tread ;.
i Tire data is vehicle-specific and may deviate from the data in the example.
Definition of terms for tires and loading
Tire ply composition and material
used
Describes the number of plies or the number
of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire
tread and sidewall. These are made of steel,
nylon, polyester and other materials.
Bar
Metric unit for tire pressure. 14.5038 pounds
per square inch (psi) and 100 kilopascals
(kPa) are the equivalent of 1 bar.
ate from the data in the example.
DOT (Department of Transportation)
DOT marked tires fulfill the requirements of
the Canadian Transport Ministry.
Normal occupant weight
The number of occupants for which the vehicle is designed multiplied by 68 kilograms
(150 lbs).
Definition of terms for tires and loading 297
A uniform standard to grade the quality of
tires with regards to tread quality, tire traction
and temperature characteristics. The quality
grading assessment is made by the manufacturer following specifications from the US
government. The ratings are molded into the
sidewall of the tire.
Recommended tire pressures
The recommended tire pressure applies to
the tires mounted at the factory.
The Tire and Loading Information placard contains the recommended tire pressure for cold
tires, the maximum permissible load and the
maximum permissible vehicle speed.
The tire pressure table contains the recommended pressures for cold tires for various
operating conditions, i.e. differing load and
speed conditions.
Increased vehicle weight due to
optional equipment
The combined weight of all standard and
optional equipment available for the vehicle,
regardless of whether it is actually installed
on the vehicle or not.
Rim
This is the part of the wheel on which the tire
is mounted.
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating)
The GAWR is the maximum gross axle weight
rating. The actual load on an axle must not
exceed the gross axle weight rating. The maximum gross axle weight rating can be found
on the vehicle identification plate on the Bpillar on the driver's side.
Speed rating
The speed rating is part of the tire identification. It specifies the speed range for which the
tire is approved.
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight)
The gross vehicle weight comprises the
weight of the vehicle including tools, accessories installed, occupants and luggage. The
gross vehicle weight must not exceed the
gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR) as specified on the vehicle identification plate on the
B-pillar on the driver's side.
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating)
The GVWR is the maximum permitted gross
weight of the fully laden vehicle (weight of the
vehicle including all accessories, occupants
and luggage). The gross vehicle weight rating
is specified on the vehicle identification plate
on the B-pillar on the driver's side.
Maximum loaded vehicle weight
The maximum weight is the sum of:
Rthe
curb weight of the vehicle
weight of the accessories
Rthe load limit
Rthe weight of the factory installed optional
equipment
Rthe
Kilopascal (kPa)
Metric unit for tire pressure. 6.9 kPa corresponds to 1 psi. Another unit for tire pressure
is bar. 100 kilopascals (kPa) are the equivalent of 1 bar.
Load index
In addition to the load-bearing index, the load
index may also be imprinted on the sidewall of
Z
Wheels and tires
Uniform Tire Quality Grading Standards
298
Definition of terms for tires and loading
the tire. This specifies the load-bearing capacity more precisely.
Curb weight
The weight of a vehicle with standard equipment but without passengers and luggage.
Maximum load rating
Maximum tire load is the maximum permissible weight for which the tire is approved.
Maximum permissible tire pressure
Wheels and tires
Maximum permissible tire pressure for one
tire.
Maximum load on one tire
Maximum load on one tire. This is calculated
by dividing the maximum axle load of one axle
by two.
Tire pressure of cold tires
The tires are cold:
Rif the vehicle has been parked with the tires
out of direct sunlight for at least 3 hours
and
Rif the vehicle has not been driven further
than 1 mile (1.6 km)
Tread
The part of the tire that comes into contact
with the road.
Bead
The tire bead ensures that the tire sits
securely on the wheel. There are several steel
wires in the bead to prevent the tire from
coming loose from the wheel rim.
Sidewall
The part of the tire between the tread and the
bead.
PSI (pounds per square inch)
A standard unit of measure for tire pressure.
Aspect ratio
Relationship between tire height and tire
width in percent.
Tire pressure
This is pressure inside the tire applying an
outward force to each square inch of the tire's
surface. The tire pressure is specified in
pounds per square inch (psi), in kilopascal
(kPa) or in bar. The tire pressure should only
be corrected when the tires are cold.
Weight of optional extras
The combined weight of those optional extras
that weigh more than the replaced standard
parts and more than 2.3 kg (5 lbs). These
optional extras, such as high-performance
brakes, level control, a roof rack or a highvoltage battery, are not included in the curb
weight and the weight of the accessories.
TIN (Tire Identification Number)
This is a unique identifier which can be used
by a tire manufacturer to identify tires, for
example for a product recall, and thus identify
the purchasers. The TIN is made up of the
manufacturer's identity code, tire size, tire
type code and the manufacturing date.
Changing a wheel
The load bearing index is a code that contains
the maximum load bearing capacity of a tire.
Traction
Traction is the result of friction between the
tires and the road surface.
Treadwear indicators
Narrow bars (tread wear bars) that are distributed over the tire tread. If the tire tread is
level with the bars, the wear limit of 1/16 in
(1.6 mm) has been reached.
Occupant distribution
The distribution of occupants in a vehicle at
their designated seating positions.
Total load limit
Nominal load and luggage load plus 68 kg
(150 lbs) multiplied by the number of seats in
the vehicle.
Changing a wheel
Flat tire
You can find information on what to do in the
event of a flat tire in the "Flat tire" section
(Y page 264). Information on driving with tires
with run-flat characteristics in the event of a
flat tire can be found under "Tires with run-flat
characteristics" (Y page 264).
Rotating the wheels
G WARNING
Interchanging the front and rear wheels may
severely impair the driving characteristics if
the wheels or tires have different dimensions.
The wheel brakes or suspension components
may also be damaged. There is a risk of accident.
Rotate front and rear wheels only if the wheels
and tires are of the same dimensions.
! On vehicles equipped with a tire pressure
monitor, electronic components are located in the wheel.
Tire-mounting tools should not be used
near the valve. This could damage the electronic components.
Only have tires changed at a qualified specialist workshop.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notes when changing a wheel
(Y page 299).
The wear patterns on the front and rear tires
differ, depending on the operating conditions.
Rotate the wheels before a clear wear pattern
has formed on the tires. Front tires typically
wear more on the shoulders and the rear tires
in the center.
If your vehicle's tire configuration allows, you
can rotate the wheels according to the intervals in the tire manufacturer's warranty book
in your vehicle documents. If no warranty
book is available, the tires should be rotated
every 3,000 to 6,000 miles (5,000 to
10,000 km), or earlier if tire wear requires. Do
not change the direction of wheel rotation.
Clean the contact surfaces of the wheel and
the brake disc thoroughly every time a wheel
is rotated. Check the tire pressure and reactivate the tire pressure monitor if necessary.
Direction of rotation
Tires with a specified direction of rotation
have additional benefits, e.g. if there is a risk
of hydroplaning. You will only gain these benefits if the correct direction of rotation is
observed.
An arrow on the sidewall of the tire indicates
its correct direction of rotation.
Z
Wheels and tires
Load bearing index
299
Changing a wheel
300
Storing wheels
Store wheels that are not being used in a cool,
dry and preferably dark place. Protect the
tires against oil and grease.
Mounting a wheel
rolling away, for example when changing a
wheel.
X Fold both plates upwards :.
X Fold out lower plate ;.
X Guide the lugs on the lower plate fully into
the openings in base plate =.
Preparing the vehicle
Stop the vehicle on solid, non-slippery and
level ground.
X Apply the electric parking brake manually
(Y page 145).
X Bring the front wheels into the straightahead position.
X Move the DIRECT SELECT lever to P.
X Switch off the drive system.
X Remove the SmartKey from the ignition
lock.
X If included in the vehicle equipment,
remove the tire-change tool kit from the
vehicle.
Wheels and tires
X
X
Securing the vehicle on level ground
X
On level ground: place chocks or other
suitable items under the front and rear of
the wheel that is diagonally opposite the
wheel you wish to change.
Secure the vehicle to prevent it from rolling
away.
Securing the vehicle to prevent it from
rolling away
Securing the vehicle on slight downhill gradients
X
If your vehicle is equipped with a wheel chock,
it can be found in the tire-change tool kit
(Y page 264).
The folding wheel chock is an additional
safety measure to prevent the vehicle from
On light downhill gradients: place
chocks or other suitable items in front of
the wheels of the front and rear axle.
Raising the vehicle
G WARNING
If you do not position the jack correctly at the
appropriate jacking point of the vehicle, the
jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
There is a risk of injury.
Changing a wheel
! Position a suitable jack correctly on the
intended jacking points. If you fail to position the jack correctly, the vehicle may be
damaged.
The jacking points are recesses in the lower
door sill. They can only be seen from underneath. There is one located behind each of
the front wheel arches and in front of the
rear wheel arches.
Position the jack in the jacking points so
that when viewed from the side, the jack is
in the vertical position.
! Position a suitable jack only on the jack-
ing points intended for this purpose.
Never position the jack on the high-voltage
battery. Do not jack up the vehicle on the
high-voltage battery. There is otherwise a
risk of damaging the high-voltage battery.
Also observe the notes in the "Changing a
wheel" section.
Rthe
jack must be placed on a firm, flat and
non-slip surface. On a loose surface, a
large, load-bearing underlay must be used.
On a slippery surface, a non-slip underlay
must be used, e.g. rubber mats.
Rdo not use wooden blocks or similar
objects as a jack underlay. Otherwise, the
jack will not be able to achieve its loadbearing capacity due to the restricted
height.
Rmake sure that the distance between the
underside of the tires and the ground does
not exceed 1.2 in (3 cm).
Rdo not place your hands or feet under the
raised vehicle.
Rdo not lie under the vehicle.
Rdo not start the electric motor when the
vehicle is raised.
Rdo not open or close the doors or the tailgate when the vehicle is raised.
Rmake sure that no persons are present in
the vehicle when the vehicle is raised.
Observe the following when raising the
vehicle:
Rto
raise the vehicle, only use the vehiclespecific jack that has been tested and
approved by Mercedes-Benz. If used incorrectly, the jack could tip over with the vehicle raised.
Rthe jack is designed only to raise and hold
the vehicle for a short time while a wheel
is being changed. It is not suited for performing maintenance work under the vehicle.
Ravoid changing the wheel on uphill and
downhill slopes.
Rbefore raising the vehicle, secure it from
rolling away by applying the parking brake
and inserting wheel chocks. Do not disengage the parking brake while the vehicle is
raised.
X
Using lug wrench :, loosen the bolts on
the wheel you wish to change by about one
full turn. Do not unscrew the bolts completely.
Z
Wheels and tires
Only position the jack at the appropriate jacking point of the vehicle. The base of the jack
must be positioned vertically, directly under
the jacking point of the vehicle.
301
Changing a wheel
302
Removing a wheel
! Do not place wheel bolts in sand or on a
dirty surface. The bolt and wheel hub
threads could otherwise be damaged when
you screw them in.
X
X
Unscrew the wheel bolts.
Remove the wheel.
Mounting a new wheel
Wheels and tires
The jacking points are located just behind the
wheel housings of the front wheels and just in
front of the wheel housings of the rear wheels
(arrows).
X
X
Position jack = at jacking point ;.
Make sure the foot of the jack is directly
beneath the jacking point.
Turn ratchet wrench ? until jack = sits
completely on jacking point ; and the
base of the jack lies evenly on the ground.
X Turn ratchet wrench ? until the tire is
raised a maximum of 1.2 in (3 cm) from the
ground.
X
G WARNING
Oiled or greased wheel bolts or damaged
wheel bolts/hub threads can cause the wheel
bolts to come loose. As a result, you could
lose a wheel while driving. There is a risk of
accident.
Never oil or grease wheel bolts. In the event of
damage to the threads, contact a qualified
specialist workshop immediately. Have the
damaged wheel bolts or hub threads
replaced/renewed. Do not continue driving.
G WARNING
If you tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is raised, the jack could tip
over. There is a risk of injury.
Only tighten the wheel bolts or wheel nuts
when the vehicle is on the ground.
Always pay attention to the instructions and
safety notes in the "Changing a wheel" section (Y page 299).
Only use wheel bolts that have been designed
for the wheel and the vehicle. For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz recommends that you
only use wheel bolts which have been
approved for Mercedes-Benz vehicles and the
respective wheel.
! To prevent damage to the paintwork, hold
the wheel securely against the wheel hub
while screwing in the first wheel bolt.
Wheel and tire combinations
X
303
Tighten the wheel bolts evenly in a crosswise pattern in the sequence indicated (:
to A). The specified tightening torque is
96 lb-ft (130 Nm).
Turn the jack back to its initial position.
Stow the jack and the rest of the vehicle
tools in the vehicle again.
X Check the tire pressure of the newly mounted wheel and adjust it if necessary.
Observe the recommended tire pressure
(Y page 281).
i Vehicles with tire pressure monitor: all
wheels mounted must be equipped with
functioning sensors.
X
X
Lowering the vehicle
G WARNING
The wheels could work loose if the wheel nuts
and bolts are not tightened to the specified
tightening torque. There is a risk of accident.
Have the tightening torque immediately
checked at a qualified specialist workshop
after a wheel is changed.
Wheel and tire combinations
General notes
! For safety reasons, Mercedes-Benz rec-
ommends that you only use tires and
wheels which have been approved by
Mercedes-Benz specifically for your vehicle.
These tires have been specially adapted for
use with the control systems, such as ABS
or ESP®, and are marked as follows:
RMO
= Mercedes-Benz Original
RMOE = Mercedes-Benz Original Extended
(tires featuring run-flat characteristics)
RMO1 = Mercedes-Benz Original (only cer-
Place the ratchet wrench onto the hexagon
nut of the jack so that the letters AB are
visible.
X Turn the ratchet wrench until the vehicle is
once again standing firmly on the ground.
X Place the jack to one side.
X
tain AMG tires)
Mercedes-Benz Original Extended tires
may only be used on wheels that have been
specifically approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Only use tires, wheels or accessories tested and approved by Mercedes-Benz. Certain characteristics, e.g. handling, vehicle
noise emissions or fuel consumption, may
otherwise be adversely affected. In addition, when driving with a load, tire dimension variations could cause the tires to
come into contact with the bodywork and
axle components. This could result in damage to the tires or the vehicle.
Z
Wheels and tires
Clean the wheel and wheel hub contact
surfaces.
X Place the new wheel on the wheel hub and
push it on.
X Tighten the wheel bolts until they are finger-tight.
X
304
Wheel and tire combinations
Mercedes-Benz accepts no liability for
damage resulting from the use of tires,
wheels or accessories other than those tested and approved.
Information on tires, wheels and approved
combinations can be obtained from any
qualified specialist workshop.
! Retreaded tires are neither tested nor recommended by Mercedes-Benz, since previous damage cannot always be detected
on retreaded tires. As a result, MercedesBenz cannot guarantee vehicle safety if
retreaded tires are mounted. Do not mount
used tires if you have no information about
their previous usage.
Wheels and tires
Overview of abbreviations used in the following tire tables:
RBA:
both axles
front axle
RRA: rear axle
The recommended pressures for various
operating conditions can be found:
RFA:
Ron the Tire and Loading Information placard
with the recommended tire pressures on
the B-pillar on the driver's side
Rin the tire pressure table on the inside of the
charge socket flap
Observe the notes on recommended tire
pressures under various operating conditions
(Y page 281).
Check tire pressures regularly, and only when
the tires are cold. Comply with the maintenance recommendations of the tire manufacturer in the vehicle document wallet.
Notes on the vehicle equipment – always
equip the vehicle with:
Rtires
of the same size on a given axle (left/
right)
Rwith tires of the same type (summer tires,
tires with run-flat characteristics, winter
tires)
Exception: it is permissible to install a different type or make in the event of a flat
tire. Observe the "Tires with run-flat characteristics" section (Y page 264).
i The following pages contain information
on approved wheel rim and tire sizes for
equipping your vehicle with winter tires.
Winter tires are not available at the factory
as standard equipment or optional extras.
If you want to equip your vehicle with
approved winter tires, it may be necessary
to obtain wheel rims in the corresponding
size. The size of the approved winter tires
may differ from the standard tires. This is
dependent on the model and the equipment installed at the factory.
The tires and wheel rims, as well as further
information, can be obtained at a qualified
specialist workshop.
i Not all wheel and tire combinations are
available at the factory for all countries.
Wheel and tire combinations
305
Tires
B-Class Electric Drive
Alloy wheels
BA
225/50 R17 94 H5
7 J x 17 H2 ET 48.5
BA
225/45 R18 95 H5, 6
7.5 J x 18 H2 ET 44
Wheels and tires
All-weather tires
5
6
Available as MOExtended tires.
Use of snow chains not permitted. Observe the notes in the "Snow chains" section.
Z
306
307
Useful information ............................ 308
Information regarding technical
data .................................................... 308
Identification plates ......................... 308
Service products and filling capacities ..................................................... 309
Technical data
Vehicle data ...................................... 311
Identification plates
308
Useful information
i This Operator's Manual describes all
models and all standard and optional equipment of your vehicle available at the time of
publication of the Operator's Manual.
Country-specific differences are possible.
Bear in mind that your vehicle may not feature all functions described here. This also
applies to safety-relevant systems and
functions.
i Read the information on qualified specialist workshops: (Y page 24).
Information regarding technical data
Example: vehicle identification plate
; VIN
= Paint code
i The data shown on the vehicle identification plate is used only as an example. This
data is different for every vehicle and can
deviate from the data shown here. You can
find the data applicable to your vehicle on
the vehicle identification plate.
General information
Technical data
i The data stated here specifically refers to
a vehicle with standard equipment. Consult
an authorized Mercedes-Benz Center for
the data for all vehicle variants and trim
levels.
VIN
Identification plates
Vehicle identification plate with vehicle identification number (VIN)
Slide the right-hand front seat to its rearmost position.
X Fold up floor covering : in front of the
right-hand front seat.
You will see VIN ;.
X
X
Open the driver's door.
You will see vehicle identification plate :.
The VIN can also be found on the vehicle
identification plate (Y page 308).
Electric motor number
The electric motor number can be found at
the bottom of the electric motor. More infor-
Service products and filling capacities
Service products and filling capacities
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Service products may be poisonous and hazardous to health. There is a risk of injury.
Comply with instructions on the use, storage
and disposal of service products on the labels
of the respective original containers. Always
store service products sealed in their original
containers. Always keep service products out
of the reach of children.
MB 229.5). They have not necessarily been
approved by Mercedes-Benz.
Brake fluid
G WARNING
The brake fluid constantly absorbs moisture
from the air. This lowers the boiling point of
the brake fluid. If the boiling point of the brake
fluid is too low, vapor pockets may form in the
brake system when the brakes are applied
hard. This would impair braking efficiency.
There is a risk of an accident.
You should have the brake fluid renewed at
the specified intervals.
RWindshield
When handling brake fluid, observe the
important safety notes on service products
(Y page 309).
The brake fluid change intervals can be found
in the Maintenance Booklet.
Only use brake fluid approved by MercedesBenz according to MB Approval 331.0.
Information about approved brake fluid can
be obtained at any qualified specialist workshop or on the Internet at:
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
RClimate
i Have the brake fluid regularly replaced at
H Environmental note
Dispose of service products in an environmentally responsible manner.
Service products include the following:
RLubricants (e.g. engine oil, transmission oil)
RCoolant
RBrake
fluid
washer fluid
control system refrigerant
Components and service products must be
matched. You should therefore only use products that have been tested and approved by
Mercedes-Benz.
Information about tested and approved products can be obtained from an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center or on the Internet at
http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
You can recognize service products approved
by Mercedes-Benz by the following inscription on the containers:
RMB-Freigabe
(e.g. MB-Freigabe 229.51)
RMB Approval (e.g. MB Approval 229.51)
Other designations or recommendations indicate a level of quality or a specification in
accordance with an MB Sheet number (e.g.
a qualified specialist workshop and the
replacement confirmed in the Maintenance
Booklet.
Coolant
Important safety notes
The coolant is a mixture of water and antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor. It performs the
following tasks:
Rcorrosion
protection
protection
Rraising the boiling point
Rantifreeze
i When the vehicle is first delivered, it is filled with a coolant mixture that ensures
Z
Technical data
mation can be obtained from any authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
309
310
Service products and filling capacities
adequate antifreeze and corrosion protection.
! Only add coolant that has been premixed
with the desired antifreeze protection. You
could otherwise damage the engine.
Further information on coolants can be
found in the Mercedes-Benz Specifications
for Service Products, MB Specifications for
Service Products 310.1, e.g. on the Internet at http://bevo.mercedes-benz.com.
Or contact a qualified specialist workshop.
! Always use a suitable coolant mixture,
Technical data
even in countries where high temperatures
prevail.
Otherwise, the engine cooling system is not
sufficiently protected from corrosion and
overheating.
If antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor is present in
the correct concentration, the boiling point of
the coolant will be around 266 ‡ (130 †).
The antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor concentration in the engine cooling system should:
Rbe at least 50%. This will protect the engine
cooling system against freezing down to
approximately -35 ‡ (-37 †).
Rnot exceed 55% (antifreeze protection
down to -49 ‡ (-45 †)). Heat will otherwise
not be dissipated as effectively.
If the vehicle has lost coolant, add equal
amounts of water and antifreeze/corrosion
inhibitor. Mercedes-Benz recommends an
anticorrosion/antifreeze which has been
approved for Mercedes-Benz.
! The warranty is only valid if you add an
antifreeze/corrosion inhibitor which has
been approved by Mercedes-Benz and if
the recommended mixture ratio is
observed.
Washer fluid
Important safety notes
G WARNING
Windshield washer concentrate is highly flammable. If it comes into contact with hot components in the front compartment, it may
ignite. There is a risk of fire and injury.
Make sure that no windshield washer concentrate is spilled next to the filler neck.
! Only use washer fluid that is suitable for
plastic lamp lenses, e.g. MB SummerFit or
MB WinterFit. Unsuitable washer fluid
could damage the plastic lenses of the
headlamps.
! Do not add distilled or de-ionized water to
the washer fluid container. Otherwise, the
level sensor may be damaged.
! Only MB SummerFit and MB WinterFit
washer fluid should be mixed together. The
spray nozzles may otherwise become
blocked.
When handling washer fluid, observe the
important safety notes on service products
(Y page 309).
At temperatures above freezing:
X
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and windshield washer fluid, e.g.
MB SummerFit.
Add 1 part MB SummerFit to 100 parts water.
At temperatures below freezing:
Fill the washer fluid reservoir with a mixture
of water and washer fluid, e.g. MB WinterFit.
Adapt the mixing ratio to the outside temperature.
X
RDown
to 14 ‡ (Ò10 †): mix 1 part MB WinterFit to 2 parts water.
RDown to Ò4 ‡ (Ò20 †): mix 1 part MB WinterFit to 1 part water.
RDown to Ò20.2 ‡ (Ò29 †): mix 2 parts MB
WinterFit to 1 part water.
Vehicle data
SummerFit or MB WinterFit, to the washer
fluid all year round.
Climate control system refrigerant
Important safety notes
The climate control system of your vehicle is
filled with refrigerant R‑134a.
The instruction label regarding the refrigerant
type used can be found on the radiator cross
member.
! Only the refrigerant R‑134a and the PAG
oil approved by Mercedes-Benz may be
used. The approved PAG oil may not be
mixed with any other PAG oil that is not
approved for R-134a refrigerant. Otherwise, the climate control system may be
damaged.
Service work, such as topping-up refrigerant
or replacing components, may only be carried
out by a qualified specialist workshop. All
applicable regulations, as well as SAE standard J639, must be adhered to.
Always have all work on the climate control
system carried out at an authorized
Mercedes-Benz Center.
Refrigerant instruction label
? PAG oil part number
A Type of refrigerant
Warning symbol : advises you about:
Rpossible
dangers
service work carried out at a qualified specialist workshop
Rhaving
Filling capacities
All models
Capacity
Refrigerant
22.9 ± 0.4 oz
(650 ± 10 g)
PAG oil
4.2 oz
(120 g)
Vehicle data
General notes
Please note that for the specified vehicle
data:
Rthe heights specified may vary as a result of
tires
load
- condition of the suspension
- optional equipment
Roptional equipment reduces the maximum
payload.
-
Dimensions and weights
Example: refrigerant instruction label
: Warning symbol
; Refrigerant filling capacity
= Applicable standards
Z
Technical data
i Add windshield washer fluid, e.g. MB
311
312
Vehicle data
Opening dimensions
High-voltage battery
: Maximum headroom
75.3 in (1912 mm)
Charge time with
240 V (32 A)
approx. 5 h
; Opening height
79.5 in (2021 mm)
Charge time with
240 V (40 A)
approx. 4 h
Vehicle dimensions
Vehicle length
171.6 in
(4358 mm)
Vehicle height
63.1 in (1604 mm)
Vehicle width
including exterior
mirrors
79.1 in (2010 mm)
Vehicle width with- 71.3 in (1812 mm)
out exterior mirrors
Technical data
Wheelbase
Turning radius
106.3 in
(2699 mm)
36.1 ft (11.0 m)
Vehicle weights
Maximum allowable gross mass
4784 lb (2170 kg)
Maximum trunk
load
220 lb (100 kg)
Maximum roof load
165 lb (75 kg)
High-voltage battery
Model
Energy content
Range (according to
EPA)
Charge time with
110-120 V (12 A)
Lithium-ion
28.0 kWh
approx. 82 miles
(132 km)
approx. 28 h
The specified values for range depend on the
driving program selected and may vary as a
result of:
Rhigher
and lower outside temperatures
style of driving
Ractivated electrical consumers
Rthe